Support tail-glob in headers_remove. Bug 159
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.93"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2019
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "website"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455 .cindex "wiki"
456 .cindex "FAQ"
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496 .cindex "bug reports"
497 .cindex "reporting bugs"
498 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506 .cindex "FTP site"
507 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
510 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511 .display
512 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513 .endd
514 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524 here are top-level directories.
525
526 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 .display
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537 .endd
538 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541 most portable to old systems.
542
543 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
545 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 .endd
566 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 .display
575 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 .endd
580 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .ilist
586 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
587 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .next
594 .cindex "domainless addresses"
595 .cindex "address" "without domain"
596 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 arrival.
601 .next
602 .cindex "transport" "external"
603 .cindex "external transports"
604 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 .next
611 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 other means.
615 .next
616 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620 a number of common scanners are provided.
621 .endlist
622
623
624 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
641 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653 .cindex "terminology definitions"
654 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657 below) by a blank line.
658
659 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666 rise to further bounce messages.
667
668 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 otherwise.
672
673 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 until a later time.
677
678 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
683 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
684 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
693 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 line.
698
699 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
700 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
701 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
713 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 message's envelope.
715
716 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
717 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744 .cindex "incorporated code"
745 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 .cindex "PCRE"
747 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
748 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750 .ilist
751 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .next
758 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763 following statements:
764
765 .blockquote
766 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 version.
772 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776 restrictions applied to it).
777 .endblockquote
778 .next
779 .cindex "SPA authentication"
780 .cindex "Samba project"
781 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785 under the Gnu GPL.
786 .next
787 .cindex "Cyrus"
788 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793 conditions expressed therein.
794
795 .blockquote
796 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800 are met:
801
802 .olist
803 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 .next
806 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 distribution.
810 .next
811 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814 details, please contact
815 .display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 .endd
823 .next
824 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 acknowledgment:
826
827 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837 .endlist
838 .endblockquote
839
840 .next
841 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 .cindex "X-windows"
843 .cindex "Athena"
844 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849 .blockquote
850 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853 All Rights Reserved
854
855 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861 software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869 SOFTWARE.
870 .endblockquote
871
872 .next
873 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878 source code.
879
880 .next
881 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884 .endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898 .cindex "design philosophy"
899 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
909 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915 .ilist
916 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 error code.
926 .next
927 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 .next
930 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 .next
935 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 .next
941 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 .next
945 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947 runs at the start of every delivery process.
948 .endlist
949
950
951
952 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
953 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
954 .cindex "Sieve filter"
955 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960 of filtering are available:
961
962 .ilist
963 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 by RFC 3028.
965 .next
966 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 .endlist
969
970 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976 .cindex "format" "of message id"
977 .cindex "id of message"
978 .cindex "base62"
979 .cindex "base36"
980 .cindex "Darwin"
981 .cindex "Cygwin"
982 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989 not always case-sensitive.
990
991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997 somewhat eccentric:
998
999 .ilist
1000 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 .next
1005 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006 received the message.
1007 .next
1008 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .olist
1010 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 .next
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018 (1/100) of a second.
1019 .endlist
1020 .endlist
1021
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1036
1037 .ilist
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 .next
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 .next
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 .next
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059 .endlist
1060
1061
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1114
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 to be sent.
1152
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 systems.
1170
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1209
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 to be bounced.
1215
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 configuration.
1234
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1244
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290 the following:
1291
1292 .ilist
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 end of routing.
1302
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 .next
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 .next
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 .next
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 .next
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 .next
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 .endlist
1333
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366 .ilist
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1374 .next
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378 address.
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384 .next
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390 .next
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394 .next
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397 .next
1398 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399 of domains that it defines.
1400 .next
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1403 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1404 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1405 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1406 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1407 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1408 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1409 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1410 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1411 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1412 .next
1413 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1414 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1415 .vindex "&$home$&"
1416 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1417 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1418 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1419 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1420 remaining preconditions.
1421 .next
1422 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1423 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1424 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1425 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1426 could lead to confusion.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1429 set of addresses that it defines.
1430 .next
1431 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1432 specified files is tested.
1433 .next
1434 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1435 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1436 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1437 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 .endlist
1439
1440
1441 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1442 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1443 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1444 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1445 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1446 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1447 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448
1449
1450
1451 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1452 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1453 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454
1455 .ilist
1456 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1457 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1458 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1459 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1460 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1461 filtering'&.
1462 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1463 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1464
1465 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1466 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1467 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1468 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1469 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1470 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 filter.
1472 .next
1473 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1474 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1475 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1476 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1477 processed entirely independently of each other.
1478 .next
1479 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1480 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1481 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1482 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1483 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1484 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1485 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1486 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1487 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1488 .next
1489 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1490 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1491 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1492 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1493 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1494 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1495 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1496 addresses to the same domain.
1497 .next
1498 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1499 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1500 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1501 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1502 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1503 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1504 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1505 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1506 .next
1507 .cindex "queue runner"
1508 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1509 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1510 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1511 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1512 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1513 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1514 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1515 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1516 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1517 .next
1518 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1519 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1520 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1521 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1522 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1523 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1524 .next
1525 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1526 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1527 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1528 messages to other addresses.
1529 .next
1530 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1531 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1532 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 &'deferred'&.
1534 .next
1535 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1536 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1537 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1538 .endlist
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1544 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1545 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1546 .cindex "queue runner"
1547 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1548 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1549 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1550 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1551 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1552 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1553 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1554 passed its retry time.
1555 You can run several queue runners at once.
1556
1557 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1558 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1559 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1560 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1561 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1562 as permanent.
1563
1564
1565
1566 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1567 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1568 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1569 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1570 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1571 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1572 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1573 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1574 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 also apply.
1576
1577 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1578 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1579 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1580 deferred,
1581 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1582 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1583 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1584 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1585 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1586 one connection.
1587
1588
1589
1590 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1591 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1592 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1593 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1594 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1595 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1596 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1597 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1598 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1599 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1600 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1601
1602 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1603 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1604 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 automatically.
1606
1607 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1608 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1609 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1610 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1611 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1612 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1613 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1614 of the list.
1615
1616
1617
1618 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1619 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1620 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1621 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1622 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1623 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1624 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1625 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1633
1634 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1635 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1636
1637 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1638 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1639 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1640 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641
1642 .table2 140pt
1643 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1644 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1645 documented"
1646 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1647 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1648 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1649 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 instructions"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1654 following subdirectories are created:
1655
1656 .table2 140pt
1657 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1658 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1659 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1660 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1661 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1662 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1663 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 .endtable
1665
1666 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1667 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1668 that may be useful to some sites.
1669
1670
1671 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1672 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1673 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1674 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1675 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1676 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1677 system.
1678 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1679 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1680 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1681 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1682 overridden if necessary.
1683 .cindex compiler requirements
1684 .cindex compiler version
1685 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686
1687
1688 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1689 .cindex "PCRE library"
1690 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1691 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1692 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1693 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1694 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1695 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1696 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1697 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1698 If your operating system has no
1699 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1700 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1701 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1702
1703 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1704 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1705 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1706 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1707 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1708 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1709 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1710
1711 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1713 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1714 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1715 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1716 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1717 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1718 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1719
1720 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1721 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1722 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1723 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1724 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1725 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1726 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1727 Berkeley DB library.
1728
1729 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1730 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1731 possibilities:
1732
1733 .olist
1734 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1735 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1738 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1739 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1740 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1741 filename is used unmodified.
1742 .next
1743 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1744 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1745 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1746 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1747 .next
1748 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1749 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1750 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1751 .next
1752 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1753 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1754 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1755 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1756 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1757 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1758 page with far newer versions listed.
1759 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1760 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1761 suited to Exim's usage model.
1762 .next
1763 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1764 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1765 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1766 operates on a single file.
1767 .endlist
1768
1769 .cindex "USE_DB"
1770 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1771 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1772 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1773 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1775 .code
1776 USE_DB=yes
1777 .endd
1778 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1779 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1780
1781 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1782 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1783 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1784 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1785 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1786 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1787
1788 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1789 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1790 in one of these lines:
1791 .code
1792 DBMLIB = -ldb
1793 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1794 .endd
1795 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1796 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1797 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1798 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 this example:
1800 .code
1801 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1802 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1803 .endd
1804 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1805 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1806
1807
1808
1809 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1810 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1811 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1812 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1813 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1814 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1815 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1816 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1817 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1818 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1819 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1820 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1821
1822 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1823 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1824 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1825 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1826 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1827 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1828
1829 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1830 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1831 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1832 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1833 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1834 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 be logged.
1836
1837 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1838 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1839 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1840 facilities, you need to set
1841 .code
1842 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1843 .endd
1844 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1845 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846
1847
1848 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1849 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1850 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1851 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1852 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1853 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1854 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1855
1856 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1857 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1858 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1859 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1860 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1861 do this.
1862
1863
1864
1865 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1866 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1867 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1868 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1869 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1870 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1871 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1872 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1873 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1874 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1875
1876 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1877 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1878 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1879 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1880 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1881 .code
1882 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1883 .endd
1884 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1885
1886
1887
1888 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1889 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1890 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1891 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1892 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1893 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1894 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1895 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1896 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1897 line option).
1898
1899 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1900 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1901 implementing SSL.
1902
1903 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1904 .code
1905 DISABLE_TLS=yes
1906 .endd
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1908
1909 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1910 .code
1911 USE_OPENSL=yes
1912 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1913 .endd
1914 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1915 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1916 .code
1917 USE_OPENSSL=yes
1918 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1919 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1920 .endd
1921 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1922 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1923 .code
1924 USE_OPENSSL=yes
1925 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1928 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1929 .code
1930 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1931 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1932 .endd
1933 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1934 library and include files. For example:
1935 .code
1936 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1937 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1939 .endd
1940 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1941 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1942 .code
1943 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1944 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1945 .endd
1946
1947 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1948 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1949 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1955
1956 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1957 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1958 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1959 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1960 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1961 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1962 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1963 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1964 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1965 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1966 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1967 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1968 you might have
1969 .code
1970 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1971 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1972 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1973 .endd
1974 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1975 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1976 .code
1977 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1978 .endd
1979 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1980 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1981 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1982 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1983 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1984 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1985 further details.
1986
1987
1988 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1989 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1990 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1991 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1992 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1993 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1994 library files.
1995
1996 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1997 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1998 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1999 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2000 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2001 Exim used to
2002 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003 withdrawn.
2004
2005
2006
2007 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2008 .cindex "lookup modules"
2009 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2010 .cindex ".so building"
2011 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2012 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2013 on demand.
2014 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2015 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2016 dependencies.
2017 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2018
2019 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2020 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2021 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2022 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2023 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2024 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2025
2026 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2027 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2028 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2029 on demand:
2030 .code
2031 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2032 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2033 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2034 .endd
2035
2036
2037 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2038 .cindex "build directory"
2039 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2040 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2041 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2042 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2043 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2044 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2045 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2046
2047 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2048 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2049 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2050 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2051 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2052 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2053 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2054 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2055
2056 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2057 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2058 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2059
2060
2061
2062 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2063 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2064 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2065 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2066 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2067 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2068 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2069 .code
2070 FULLECHO='' make -e
2071 .endd
2072 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2073 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2074 given in addition to the short output.
2075
2076
2077
2078 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2079 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2080 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2081 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2082 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2083 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2084 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2085 order:
2086 .display
2087 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089 &_Local/Makefile_&
2090 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2091 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2092 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2093 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2094 .endd
2095 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2096 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2097 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2098 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2099 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2100 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2101 and are often not needed.
2102
2103 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2104 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2105 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2106 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2107 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2108 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2109 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2110 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2111 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2112
2113
2114 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2115 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2116 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2117 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2118 default values are.
2119
2120
2121 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2122 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2123 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2124 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2125 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2126 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2127 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2128 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2129 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2130 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2131 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2132 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2133 containing the lines
2134 .code
2135 CC=cc
2136 CFLAGS=-std1
2137 .endd
2138 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2139 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2140
2141 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2142 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2143 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2144
2145
2146 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2147 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2148 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2149 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2150 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2151 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2152 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2153 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2154 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2155 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2156 .code
2157 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2158 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2159 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2160 .endd
2161 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2162 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2163 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2164 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2165 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2166 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2167 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2168 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2169 errors.
2170
2171 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2172 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2173 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2174 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2175 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2176 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2177 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2178 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2179 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2180 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2181 syntax. For instance:
2182 .code
2183 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2184 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2185 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2186 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2187 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2188 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2189 .endd
2190
2191 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2192 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2193 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2194 .code
2195 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2196 .endd
2197 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2198 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2199
2200 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2201 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2202 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2203 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2204 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2205 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2206 .code
2207 X11=/usr/X11R6
2208 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2210 .endd
2211 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2212 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2213 .code
2214 X11=/usr/openwin
2215 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2217 .endd
2218 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2219 definition of all three of these variables into your
2220 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2221
2222 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2223 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2224 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2225 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2226 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2227
2228 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2229 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2230 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2231 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2232 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2233 libraries.
2234
2235 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2236 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2237 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2238 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2239 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2240
2241
2242 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2243 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2244 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2245 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2246 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2247 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2248 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2249 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2250
2251
2252
2253 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2254 .cindex "building Eximon"
2255 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2256 where the files that are involved are
2257 .display
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2261 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2262 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2263 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2264 .endd
2265 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2266 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2267 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2268 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2269 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2270 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2271 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2272 .ecindex IIDbuex
2273
2274
2275 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2276 .cindex "installing Exim"
2277 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2278 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2279 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2280 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2281 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2282 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2283 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2284 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2285 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2286 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2287 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2288 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2289
2290 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2291 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2292 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2293 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2294 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2295 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2296 alternative files, no default is installed.
2297
2298 .cindex "system aliases file"
2299 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2300 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2301 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2302 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2303 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2304 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2305 and outputs a comment to the user.
2306
2307 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2308 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2309 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2310 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2311 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2312
2313 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2314 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2315 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2316 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2317 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2318 over SMTP.
2319
2320 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2321 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2322 command such as
2323 .code
2324 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2325 .endd
2326 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2327 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2328 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2329 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2330 but this usage is deprecated.
2331
2332 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2333 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2334 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2335 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2336 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2337 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2338
2339 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2340 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2341 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2342 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2343 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2344 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2345 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2346
2347 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2348 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2349 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2350 command:
2351 .code
2352 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2353 .endd
2354 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2355 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2356 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2357 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2358 command:
2359 .code
2360 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2361 .endd
2362 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2363 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2364
2365 .ilist
2366 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2367 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2368 .next
2369 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2370 installed binary.
2371 .endlist
2372
2373 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2374 .code
2375 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2376 .endd
2377 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2378 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2379 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2380 .code
2381 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382 .endd
2383
2384
2385
2386 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2387 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2388 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2389 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2390 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2391 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2392
2393 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2394 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2395 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2396
2397
2398
2399 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2400 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2401 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2402 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2403 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2404 necessary.
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2410 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2411 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2412 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2413 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2414 .code
2415 exim -bV
2416 .endd
2417 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2418 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2419 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2420 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2421 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2422 example,
2423 .display
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2425 .endd
2426 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2427 .display
2428 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2429 .endd
2430 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2431 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2432 user agent. For example:
2433 .code
2434 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2435 From: user@your.domain.example
2436 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2437 Subject: Testing Exim
2438
2439 This is a test message.
2440 ^D
2441 .endd
2442 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2443 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2444 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2445
2446 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2447 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2448 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2449 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2450 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2451 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2452 .display
2453 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2454 .endd
2455 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2456 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2457 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2458 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2459 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2460
2461 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2462 .cindex "lock files"
2463 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2464 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2465 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2466 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2467 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2468 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2469 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2470 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2471 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2472 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2473 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2474 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2475
2476 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2477 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2478 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2479 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2480 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2481 incoming SMTP mail.
2482
2483 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2484 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2485 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2486 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2487 production version.
2488
2489
2490 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2491 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2492 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2493 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2494 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2495 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2496 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2497 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2498 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2499 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2500 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2501 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2502 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2503
2504 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2505 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2506 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2507 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2508 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2509 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2510 as follows:
2511 .code
2512 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2513 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2514 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2515 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2516 .endd
2517 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2518 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2519 favourite user agent.
2520
2521 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2522 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2523 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2524 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2525 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2526 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2527
2528
2529
2530 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2531 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2532 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2533 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2534 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2535 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2536 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2537 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2538 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2539 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2540 configuration file.
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2546 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2547 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2548 .code
2549 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2550 .endd
2551 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2552 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2553 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2554 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2555 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2556 .code
2557 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2558 .endd
2559 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2560
2561 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2562 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2563 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2570
2571 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2572 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2573 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2574 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2575 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2576 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2577 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2578 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2579 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2580
2581
2582 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2583 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2585 were present before any other options.
2586 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2587 standard output.
2588 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2589 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2590 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2595 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2596 format.
2597
2598 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2600 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2601 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2602
2603 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2604 .cindex "queue runner"
2605 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2606 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2607 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2608
2609 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2610 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2612 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2613 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2614 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2615 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2616 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2617
2618
2619 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2620 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2621 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2622 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2623 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2624 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2625
2626 .ilist
2627 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2628 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2629 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2630 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2631 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2632 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2633
2634 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2635 .cindex "envelope from"
2636 .cindex "envelope sender"
2637 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2638 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2639 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2640 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2641 users to set envelope senders.
2642
2643 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2644 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2645 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2646 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2647 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2648 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2649 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2650
2651 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2652 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2653 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2654 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2655 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2656 that are available to trusted users.
2657 .next
2658 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2659 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2660 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2661 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2662 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2663
2664 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2665 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2666 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2667 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2668
2669 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2670 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2671 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2672 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2673
2674 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2675 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2676 false.
2677 .endlist
2678
2679
2680 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2681 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2682 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2683 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2689 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2690 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2691 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2692 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2693 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2694 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2695 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2696
2697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2699 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2700 . creates a man page for the options.
2701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2702
2703 .literal xml
2704 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2705 .literal off
2706
2707
2708 .vlist
2709 .vitem &%--%&
2710 .oindex "--"
2711 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2712 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2713 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2714 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2715
2716 .vitem &%--help%&
2717 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2718 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2719 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2720 no arguments.
2721
2722 .vitem &%--version%&
2723 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2724 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2725 displayed.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2728 &%-Am%&
2729 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2730 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2731 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2732 ignored by Exim.
2733
2734 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2735 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2736 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2738 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2739 clean; it ignores this option.
2740
2741 .vitem &%-bd%&
2742 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2743 .cindex "daemon"
2744 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2745 .cindex "queue runner"
2746 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2747 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2748 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2749
2750 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2751 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2752 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2753 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2754
2755 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2756 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2757 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2758 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2759
2760 When a listening daemon
2761 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2762 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2763 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2764 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2765 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2766 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2767 running as root.
2768
2769 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2770 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2771 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2772
2773 The SIGHUP signal
2774 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2775 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2776 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2777 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2778 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2779 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2780 .cindex reload configuration
2781 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2782 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2783 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2784 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2785 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2786 because these are reread each time they are used.
2787
2788 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2789 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2790 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2791 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2792
2793 .vitem &%-be%&
2794 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2795 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2796 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2797 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2801
2802 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2803 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2804 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2805 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806 test data. A line history is supported.
2807
2808 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2809 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2810 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2811 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2812 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2813 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2814 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2815
2816 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2817 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2818 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2819 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2820
2821 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2822 defined and macros will be expanded.
2823 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2824 available to admin users.
2825
2826 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2828 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2829 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2830 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2831 of a file. For example:
2832 .code
2833 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2834 .endd
2835 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2836 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2837 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2838 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2839 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2840 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2841 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2842 &%-be%&).
2843
2844 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2845 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2846 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2847 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2848 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2849 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2850 system filters are recognized.
2851
2852 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2853 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2854 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2855 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2856 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2857 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2858 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2859 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2860 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2861 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2862 supplied.
2863
2864 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2865 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2866 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2867 .code
2868 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2869 .endd
2870 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2871 variables that are used by the user filter.
2872
2873 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2874 .code
2875 # Exim filter
2876 # Sieve filter
2877 .endd
2878 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2879 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2880 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2881 redirection lists.
2882
2883 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2884 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2885 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2886 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2887
2888 When testing a filter file,
2889 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2890 .cindex "envelope from"
2891 .cindex "envelope sender"
2892 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2893 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2894 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2895 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2896 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2897 options).
2898
2899 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2900 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2901 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2902 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2903 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2904 &$qualify_domain$&.
2905
2906 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2907 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2908 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2909 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2910 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2911 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2912 actually being delivered.
2913
2914 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2915 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2916 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2917 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2918 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2919 prefix.
2920
2921 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2922 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2923 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2924 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2926 suffix.
2927
2928 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2929 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2930 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2931 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2932 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2933 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2934 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2935 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2936 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2937 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2938 after a full stop. For example:
2939 .code
2940 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2941 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2942 .endd
2943 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2944 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2945 conversion to the canonical form is
2946 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2947
2948 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2949 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2950 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2951 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2952 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2953
2954 &*Warning 1*&:
2955 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2956 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2957 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2958 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2959 connection.
2960
2961 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2962 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2963 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2964
2965 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2966 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2967 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2968 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2969 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2970 session were authenticated.
2971
2972 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2973 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2974 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2975
2976 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2977 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2978 specialized SMTP test program such as
2979 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2980
2981 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2982 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2983 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2984 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2985 updating the callout cache database.
2986
2987 .vitem &%-bi%&
2988 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2989 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2990 .cindex "building alias file"
2991 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2992 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2993 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2994 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2995 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2996 recognized.
2997
2998 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2999 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3000 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3001 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3002 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3003 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3004 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
3005
3006 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3007 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
3008 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3009 .cindex "querying exim information"
3010 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3011 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3012 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3013 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3014 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3015
3016 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3017 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3018 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3019 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3020 recognised DSCP names.
3021
3022 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3023 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3024 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3025 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3026 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3027 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3028 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3029 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3030 way to guarantee a correct response.
3031
3032 .vitem &%-bm%&
3033 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3034 .cindex "local message reception"
3035 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3036 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3037 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3038 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3039 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3040 if no other conflicting option is present.
3041
3042 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3043 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3044 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3045 suppressing this for special cases.
3046
3047 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3048 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3049
3050 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3051 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3052 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3053
3054 The format
3055 .cindex "message" "format"
3056 .cindex "format" "message"
3057 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3058 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3059 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3060 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3061 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3062 .code
3063 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3064 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3065 .endd
3066 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3067 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3068 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3069 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3070 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3071
3072 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3073 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3074 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3075 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3076 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3077
3078 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3079 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3080 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3081 .cindex "malware scan test"
3082 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3083 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3084 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3085 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3086 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3087 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3088 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3089
3090 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3091 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3092 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3093 This option requires admin privileges.
3094
3095 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3096 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3097 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3098
3099 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3100 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3101 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3102 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3103 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3104 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3105 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3106 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3107 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3108
3109 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3110 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3111 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3112 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3113 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3114
3115 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3116 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3117 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3118 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3119
3120
3121 .vitem &%-bP%&
3122 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3123 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3124 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3125 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3126 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3127 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3128 arguments, for example:
3129 .code
3130 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3131 .endd
3132 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3133 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3134 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3135 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3136 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3137 users, the output is as in this example:
3138 .code
3139 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3140 .endd
3141 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3142 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3143
3144 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3145 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3146 backward compatibility.)
3147 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3148 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3151 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3152 name will not be output.
3153
3154 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3155 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3156 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3157 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3158 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3159 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3160 written directly into the spool directory.
3161
3162 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3163 .code
3164 exim -bP +local_domains
3165 .endd
3166 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3167 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3168
3169 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3170 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3171 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3172 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3173 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3174 that driver are output. For example:
3175 .code
3176 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3177 .endd
3178 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3179 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3180 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3181 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3182 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3183 &%authenticators%&.
3184
3185 .cindex "environment"
3186 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3187 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3188 variables.
3189
3190 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3191 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3192 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3193 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3194 The output format is one item per line.
3195 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3196 the exit status will be nonzero.
3197
3198 .vitem &%-bp%&
3199 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3200 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3201 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3202 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3203 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3204 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3205 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3206 to allow any user to see the queue.
3207
3208 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3209 .code
3210 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3211 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3212 <other addresses>
3213 .endd
3214 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3215 .cindex "size" "of message"
3216 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3217 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3218 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3219 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3220 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3221 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3222 before the sender address.
3223
3224 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3225 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3226 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3227
3228 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3229 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3230 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3231 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3232 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3233 complete.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3237 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3238 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3239 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3240 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3241 of just &"D"&.
3242
3243
3244 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3245 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3246 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3247 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3248 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3249 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3250
3251
3252 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3253 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3254 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3255 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3256 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3257 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3258
3259 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3260 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3261 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3262
3263 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3264 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3265 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3266
3267
3268 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3269 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3270 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3271 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3272 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3273 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3274
3275
3276 .vitem &%-brt%&
3277 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3278 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3279 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3280 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3281 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3282 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3283 .code
3284 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3285 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3286 .endd
3287 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3288 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3289 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3290 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3291 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3292 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3293 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3294 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3295 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3296 .code
3297 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3298 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3299 .endd
3300
3301 .vitem &%-brw%&
3302 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3303 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3304 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3305 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3306 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3307 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3308 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3309 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3310
3311 .vitem &%-bS%&
3312 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3313 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3314 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3315 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3316 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3317 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3318 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3319 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3320 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3321 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3322
3323 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3324 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3325 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3326
3327 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3328 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3329 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3330 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3333 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3334 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3335
3336 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3337 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3338 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3339 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3340 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3341
3342 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3343 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3344
3345 .vitem &%-bs%&
3346 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3347 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3348 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3349 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3350 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3351 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3352 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3353 messages to the MTA.
3354
3355 In
3356 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3357 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3358 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3359 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3360 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3361 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3362 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3363
3364 .cindex "inetd"
3365 The
3366 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3367 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3368 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3369 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3370 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3371 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3372 the listening daemon.
3373
3374 .vitem &%-bt%&
3375 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3376 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377 .cindex "address" "testing"
3378 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3383
3384 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3386
3387 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3389 security issues.
3390
3391 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3396 program.
3397
3398 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3402
3403 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3407 always shown.
3408
3409 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3411 message,
3412 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3418 doing such tests.
3419
3420 .vitem &%-bV%&
3421 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3422 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3423 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3424 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3425 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3426 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3427 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3428
3429 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3430 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3431 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3432 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3433 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3434 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3435 dynamic testing facilities.
3436
3437 .vitem &%-bv%&
3438 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3439 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3440 .cindex "address" "verification"
3441 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3442 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3443 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3444 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3445 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3446 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3447
3448 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3449 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3450 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3451
3452 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3453 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3454
3455 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3456 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3457 security issues.
3458
3459 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3460 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3461 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3462 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3463 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3464
3465 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3466 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3467 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3468 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3469 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3470 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3471 to succeed.
3472
3473 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3474 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3475 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3476
3477 The
3478 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3479 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3480 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3481 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3482
3483 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3484 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3485 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3486 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3487
3488 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3489 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3490 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3491 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3492 might happen.
3493
3494 .vitem &%-bw%&
3495 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3496 .cindex "daemon"
3497 .cindex "inetd"
3498 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3499 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3500 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3501 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3502
3503 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3504 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3505 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3506 each port only when the first connection is received.
3507
3508 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3509 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3510
3511 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3512 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3513 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3514 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3515 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3516 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3517 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3518 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3519 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3520 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3521 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3522
3523 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3524 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3525 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3526 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3527 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3528 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3529 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3530 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3531 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3532
3533 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3534 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3535 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3536 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3537 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3538 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3539 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3540
3541 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3542 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3543 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3544 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3545 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3546 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3547 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3548
3549 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3550 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3551 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3552 configuration file.
3553
3554 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3555 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3556 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3557 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3558 specified by this option.
3559
3560
3561 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3562 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3563 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3564 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3565 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3566 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3567 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3568 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3569
3570 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3571 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3572 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3573 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3574 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3575 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3576 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3577
3578 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3579 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3580 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3581 synonymous:
3582 .code
3583 exim -DABC ...
3584 exim -DABC= ...
3585 .endd
3586 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3587 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3588 example:
3589 .code
3590 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3591 .endd
3592 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3593 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3594
3595
3596 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3597 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3598 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3599 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3600 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3601 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3602 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3603 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3604 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3605 return code.
3606
3607 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3608 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3609 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3610 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3611 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3612 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3613 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3614 are:
3615 .display
3616 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3617 &`auth `& authenticators
3618 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3619 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3620 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3621 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3622 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3623 &`filter `& filter handling
3624 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3625 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3626 &`ident `& ident lookup
3627 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3628 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3629 &`load `& system load checks
3630 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3631 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3632 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3633 &`memory `& memory handling
3634 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3635 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3636 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3637 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3638 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3639 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3640 &`retry `& retry handling
3641 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3642 &`route `& address routing
3643 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3644 &`tls `& TLS logic
3645 &`transport `& transports
3646 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3647 &`verify `& address verification logic
3648 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3649 .endd
3650 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3651 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3652 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3653 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3654 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3655 turn everything off.
3656
3657 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3658 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3659 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3660 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3661 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3662 rather than stderr.
3663
3664 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3665 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3666 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3667 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3668 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3669 run in parallel.
3670
3671 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3672 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3673 in processing.
3674
3675 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3676 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3677 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3678 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3679 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3680 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3681
3682 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3683 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3684
3685 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3686 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3687 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3688 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3689 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3690 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3691
3692 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3693 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3694 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3695 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3696 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3697
3698 .vitem &%-E%&
3699 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3700 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3701 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3702 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3703 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3704 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3705 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3706 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3707 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3708
3709 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3710 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3711 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3712 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3713 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3714 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3715
3716 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3717 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3718 .cindex "sender" "name"
3719 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3720 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3721 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3722 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3723 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3724 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3725
3726 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3727 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3728 .cindex "sender" "address"
3729 .cindex "address" "sender"
3730 .cindex "trusted users"
3731 .cindex "envelope from"
3732 .cindex "envelope sender"
3733 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3734 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3735 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3736 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3737 users to use it.
3738
3739 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3740 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3741 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3742 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3743 domain.
3744
3745 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3746 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3747 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3748 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3749 examples of shell commands:
3750 .code
3751 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3752 exim -f "" user@domain
3753 .endd
3754 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3755 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3756 &%-bv%& options.
3757
3758 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3759 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3760 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3761 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3762
3763 White
3764 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3765 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3766 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3767 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3768 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3769 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3770
3771 .vitem &%-G%&
3772 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3773 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3774 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3775 .code
3776 control = suppress_local_fixups
3777 .endd
3778 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3779 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3780 in future.
3781
3782 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3783 this option.
3784
3785 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3786 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3787 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3788 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3789 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3790 headers.)
3791
3792 .vitem &%-i%&
3793 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3794 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3795 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3796 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3797 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3798 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3799 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3800
3801 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3802 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3803 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3804 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3805 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3806 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3807 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3808 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3809
3810 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3811
3812 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3813 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3814 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3815 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3816 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3817 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3818 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3819 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3820 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3821
3822 Retry
3823 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3824 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3825 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3826 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3827 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3828 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3829
3830 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3831 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3832 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3833 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3834
3835 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3836 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3837 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3838 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3839 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3840 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3841 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3842 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3843 can be used only by an admin user.
3844
3845 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3846 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3847 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3848 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3849 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3850 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3851 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3853 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3854 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3855 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3856
3857 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3858 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3859 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3861 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3862
3863 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3864 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3865 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3867 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3868
3869 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3870 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3871 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3873 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3876 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3879 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3880
3881 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3882 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3883 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3885 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3886
3887 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3888 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3889 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3891 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3892 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3893 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3894 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3895
3896 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3897 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3898 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3900 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3901 connection.
3902
3903 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3904 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3905 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3906 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3907 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3908
3909 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3910 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3911 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3914 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3915
3916 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3918 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3919 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3920 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3921 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3922 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3923 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3924 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3925 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3926 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3927 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3928 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3929 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3930 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3931
3932 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3933 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3934 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3935 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3936 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3937 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3938 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3939 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3940 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3941 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3942
3943 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3945 .cindex "freezing messages"
3946 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3947 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3948 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3949 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3950 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3951 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3952 user.
3953
3954 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3955 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3956 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3957 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3958 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3959 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3960 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3961 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3962 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3963 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3964 user.
3965
3966 .vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3967 .oindex "&%-MG%&"
3968 .cindex queue named
3969 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3970 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3971 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3972 queue to the given named queue.
3973 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3974 string to define the default queue.
3975 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3976 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3977
3978 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3979 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3980 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3981 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3982 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3983 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3984 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3987 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3988 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3989 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3990 .cindex "removing recipients"
3991 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3992 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3993 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3994 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3995 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3996 can be used only by an admin user.
3997
3998 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3999 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4000 .cindex "removing messages"
4001 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4002 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4003 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4004 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4005 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4006 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4007 placed in the queue.
4008
4009 . .new
4010 . .vitem &%-MS%&
4011 . .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4012 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4013 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4014 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4015 . a bounce message.
4016 . .wen
4017
4018 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4019 .oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4020 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4021 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4022 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4023 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4024 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4025 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4026 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4027 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4028 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4029
4030 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4031 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4032 .cindex "thawing messages"
4033 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4034 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4035 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4036 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4037 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4038 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4039 by an admin user.
4040
4041 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4042 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4043 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4044 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4045 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4046 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4050 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4051 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4052 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4053 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4054 only by an admin user.
4055
4056 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4057 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4058 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4059 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4060 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4061 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4062 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4063
4064 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4065 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4066 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4067 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4068 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4069 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4070
4071 .vitem &%-m%&
4072 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4073 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4074 treats it that way too.
4075
4076 .vitem &%-N%&
4077 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4078 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4079 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4080 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4081 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4082 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4083 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4084 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4085 than &"=>"&.
4086
4087 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4088 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4089 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4090 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4091 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4092 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4093 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4094 for that message.
4095
4096 .vitem &%-n%&
4097 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4098 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4099 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4100 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4101 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4102
4103 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4104 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4105 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4106 Exim.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4109 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4110 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4111 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4112 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4113 description above.
4114
4115 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4116 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4117 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4118 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4119 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4120 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4121 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4122 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4123
4124 .vitem &%-odb%&
4125 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4126 .cindex "background delivery"
4127 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4128 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4129 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4130 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4131 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4132 processes to finish.
4133
4134 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4135 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4136 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4137 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4138
4139 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4140 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4141 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4142 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4143
4144 .vitem &%-odf%&
4145 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4146 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4147 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4148 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4149 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4150 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4151 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4152
4153 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4154 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4155 during deliveries.
4156
4157 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4158 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4159
4160 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4161 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4162 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4163 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4164
4165
4166 .vitem &%-odi%&
4167 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4168 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4169 Sendmail.
4170
4171 .vitem &%-odq%&
4172 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4173 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4174 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4175 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4176 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4177 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4178 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4179 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4180 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4181 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4182 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4183 forces queueing.
4184
4185 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4186 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4187 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4188 .cindex "first pass routing"
4189 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4190 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4191 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4192 configuration file is in effect.
4193
4194 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4195 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4196 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4197 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4198 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4199 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4200 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4201 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4202 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4203 &%-qq%& option.
4204
4205 .vitem &%-oee%&
4206 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4207 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4208 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4209 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4210 message.
4211
4212 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4213 Provided
4214 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4215 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4216 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4217 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4218
4219 .vitem &%-oem%&
4220 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4221 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4222 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4223 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4224 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4225 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4226
4227 .vitem &%-oep%&
4228 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4229 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4230 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4231 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4232 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4233 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4234
4235 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4236 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4237 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4238 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4239 effect as &%-oep%&.
4240
4241 .vitem &%-oew%&
4242 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4243 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4244 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4245 effect as &%-oem%&.
4246
4247 .vitem &%-oi%&
4248 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4249 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4250 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4251 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4252 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4253 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4254 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4255
4256 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4257 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4258 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4259
4260 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4261 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4262 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4263 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4264 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4265 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4266 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4267 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4268
4269 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4270 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4271 .code
4272 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4273 .endd
4274 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4275 followed by a colon and the port number:
4276 .code
4277 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4278 .endd
4279 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4280 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4281 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4282 whichever one is last.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4285 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4286 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4287 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4288 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4289 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4290 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4291 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4294 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4295 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4296 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4297 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4298 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4299 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4300 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4301
4302 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4303 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4304 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4305 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4306 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4307 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4308 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4309 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4310 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4311 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4312
4313 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4314 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4315 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4316 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4317 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4318 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4319 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4322 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4323 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4324 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4325 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4326 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4327 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4328 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4329 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4330
4331 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4332 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4333 is sending the bounce.
4334
4335 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4336 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4337 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4338 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4339 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4340 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4341 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4342 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4343 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4344 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4345 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4346 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4347
4348 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4349 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4350 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4351 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4352 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4353 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4354 uses the name it is given.
4355
4356 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4357 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4358 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4359 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4360 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4361 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4362 used, when there is no default.
4363
4364 .vitem &%-om%&
4365 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4366 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4367 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4368 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4369 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4370
4371 .vitem &%-oo%&
4372 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4373 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4374 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4375 whatever that means.
4376
4377 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4378 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4379 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4380 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4381 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4382 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4383 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4384 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4385 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4386
4387 .new
4388 .vitem &%-oPX%&
4389 .oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4390 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4391 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4392 This option is not intended for general use.
4393 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4394 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4395 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4396 .wen
4397
4398 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4399 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4400 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4401 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4402 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4403 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4404 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4405
4406 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4407 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4408 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4409 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4410 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4411 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4412 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4413 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4414
4415 .vitem &%-ov%&
4416 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4417 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4418
4419 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4420 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4421 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4422 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4423 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4424 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4425 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4426 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4427 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4428 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4429
4430 .vitem &%-pd%&
4431 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4432 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4433 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4434 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4435 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4436 needed.
4437
4438 .vitem &%-ps%&
4439 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4440 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4441 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4442 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4443 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4444 started.
4445
4446 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4447 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4448 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4449 .display
4450 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4451 .endd
4452 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4453 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4454 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4455 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4456 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4457 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4458
4459 .vitem &%-q%&
4460 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4461 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4462 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4463 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4464 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4465 and &%-S%& options).
4466
4467 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4468 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4469 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4470 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4471 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4472 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4473 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4474
4475 If
4476 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4477 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4478 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4479 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4480 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4481 proceeding.
4482
4483 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4484 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4485 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4486 this to be repeated periodically.
4487
4488 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4489 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4490 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4491 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4492
4493 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4494 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4495 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4496
4497 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4498 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4499 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4500 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4501
4502 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4503 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4504 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4505 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4506 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4507 .cindex "first pass routing"
4508 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4509 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4510 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4511 transports are run.
4512
4513 .new
4514 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4515 .wen
4516
4517 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4518 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4519 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4520 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4521 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4522 delivered down a single SMTP
4523 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4524 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4525 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4526 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4527 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4528 intermittently.
4529
4530 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4531 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4532 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4533 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4534 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4535 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4536 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4537
4538 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4539 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4540 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4541 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4542 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4543 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4544 their retry times are tried.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4547 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4548 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4549 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4550 frozen or not.
4551
4552 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4553 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4554 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4555 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4556 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4557 for later delivery.
4558
4559 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4560 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4561 .cindex queue named
4562 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4563 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4564 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4565 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4566 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4567 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4568 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4569
4570 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4571 will specify a queue to operate on.
4572 For example:
4573 .code
4574 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4575 mailq -qGquarantine
4576 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4577 .endd
4578
4579 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4580 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4581 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4582 starting message id. For example:
4583 .code
4584 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4585 .endd
4586 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4587 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4588 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4589 .code
4590 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4591 .endd
4592 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4593 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4594 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4595 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4596 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4597 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4598
4599 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4600 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4601 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4602 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4603 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4604 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4605 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4606 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4607 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4608 .code
4609 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4610 .endd
4611 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4612 process every 30 minutes.
4613
4614 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4615 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4616
4617 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4618 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4619 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4620 compatibility.
4621
4622 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4623 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4624 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4625
4626 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4627 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4628 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4629 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4630 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4631 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4632 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4633 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4634 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4635
4636 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4637 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4638 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4639 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4640 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4641 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4642
4643 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4644 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4645 .code
4646 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4647 .endd
4648 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4649 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4650 applied to each queue run.
4651
4652 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4653 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4654 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4655 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4656 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4657 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4658 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4659 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4660 address will be skipped.
4661
4662 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4663 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4664 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4665 &'ff'& is present.
4666
4667 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4668 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4669 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4670 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4671 an arbitrary command instead.
4672
4673 .vitem &%-r%&
4674 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4675 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4676
4677 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4678 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4679 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4680 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4681 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4682 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4683 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4684 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4685
4686 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4687 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4688 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4689 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4690 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4691
4692 .vitem &%-t%&
4693 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4694 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4695 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4696 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4697 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4698 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4699 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4700 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4701 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4702 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4703
4704 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4705 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4706 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4707 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4708 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4709 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4710 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4711 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4712 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4713 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4714 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4715
4716 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4717 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4718 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4719 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4720 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4721 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4722
4723 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4724 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4725 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4726 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4727 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4728 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4729 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4730 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4731 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4732
4733 .vitem &%-ti%&
4734 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4735 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4736 compatibility with Sendmail.
4737
4738 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4739 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4740 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4741 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4742 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4743 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4744 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4745 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4746
4747
4748 .vitem &%-U%&
4749 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4751 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4752 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4753 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4754 set. Exim ignores this option.
4755
4756 .vitem &%-v%&
4757 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4758 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4759 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4760 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4761 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4762 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4763 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4764 unconditional.
4765
4766 .vitem &%-x%&
4767 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4768 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4769 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4770 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4771 this option.
4772
4773 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4774 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4775 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4776 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4777
4778 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4779 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4780 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4781 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4782 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4783 under most shells.
4784 .endlist
4785
4786 .ecindex IIDclo1
4787 .ecindex IIDclo2
4788
4789
4790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4791 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4792 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4793 . creates a man page for the options.
4794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4795
4796 .literal xml
4797 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4798 .literal off
4799
4800
4801
4802
4803
4804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4805 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4806
4807
4808 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4809 "The runtime configuration file"
4810
4811 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4812 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4813 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4814 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4815 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4816 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4817 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4818 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4819 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4820 control.
4821
4822 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4823 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4824 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4825 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4826 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4827 actually alter the string.
4828
4829 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4830 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4831 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4832 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4833 existing file in the list.
4834
4835 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4836 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4837 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4838 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4839 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4840 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4841 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4842 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4843 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4844 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4845 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4846
4847 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4848 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4849 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4850 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4851 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4852
4853 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4854 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4855 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4856 compromise the Exim user account.
4857
4858 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4859 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4860 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4861 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4862 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4863 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4864 configuration.
4865
4866
4867
4868 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4869 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4870 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4871 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4872 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4873 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4874 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4875 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4876 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4877 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4878 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4879
4880 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4881 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4882 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4883 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4884 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4885 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4886 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4887 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4888 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4889 &%-M%&).
4890
4891 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4892 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4893 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4894 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4895 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4896
4897 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4898 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4899 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4900 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4901 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4902 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4903
4904 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4905 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4906 necessarily be discarded.
4907 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4908 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4909 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4910 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4911 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4912 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4913
4914 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4915 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4916 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4917 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4918 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4919 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4920 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4921
4922 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4923 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4924 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4925
4926
4927
4928 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4929 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4930 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4931 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4932 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4933 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4934 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4935 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4936
4937 .ilist
4938 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4939 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4940 .next
4941 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4942 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4943 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4944 .next
4945 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4946 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4947 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4948 .next
4949 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4950 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4951 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4952 .next
4953 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4954 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4955 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4956 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4957 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4958 .next
4959 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4960 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4961 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4962 .next
4963 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4964 want to use this feature, you must set
4965 .code
4966 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4967 .endd
4968 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4969 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4970 .endlist
4971
4972 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4973 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4974 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4975 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4976
4977 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4978 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4979 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4980 and does not introduce a comment.
4981
4982 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4983 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4984 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4985 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4986 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4987
4988 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4989 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4990 change settings as required.
4991
4992 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4993 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4994 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4995 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4996 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4997 described.
4998
4999
5000
5001 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5002 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5003 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5004 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5005 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5006 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5007 using this syntax:
5008 .display
5009 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5010 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5011 .endd
5012 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5013 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5014 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5015 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5016 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5017 is required.
5018
5019 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5020 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5021 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5022 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5023
5024 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5025 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5026 for example:
5027 .code
5028 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5029 .include /some/file
5030 .endd
5031 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5032 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5033 inclusion appears.
5034
5035
5036
5037 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5038 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5039 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5040 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5041 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5042 definition, and must be of the form
5043 .display
5044 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5045 .endd
5046 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5047 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5048 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5049 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5050 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5051
5052 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5053 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5054 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5055
5056 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5057 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5058 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5059 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5060 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5061 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5062 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5063 define
5064 .display
5065 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5066 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5067 .endd
5068 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5069 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5070 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5071 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5072 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5073 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5074
5075
5076 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5077 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5078 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5079 &'='&. For example:
5080 .code
5081 MAC = initial value
5082 ...
5083 MAC == updated value
5084 .endd
5085 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5086 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5087 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5088 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5089 .code
5090 MAC = initial value
5091 ...
5092 MAC == MAC and something added
5093 .endd
5094 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5095 from a number of other files.
5096
5097 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5098 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5099 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5100 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5101 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5102 file to be ignored.
5103
5104
5105
5106 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5107 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5108 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5109 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5110 .code
5111 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5112 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5113 .endd
5114 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5115 .code
5116 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5117 .endd
5118 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5119 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5120 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5121
5122
5123 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5124 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5125 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5126 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5127 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5128 (see below).
5129
5130 The following classes of macros are defined:
5131 .display
5132 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5133 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5134 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5135 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5136 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5137 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5138 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5139 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5140 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5141 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5142 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5143 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5144 .endd
5145
5146 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5147
5148
5149 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5150 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5151 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5152 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5153 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5154 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5155 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5156
5157 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5158 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5159 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5160 line. Thus:
5161 .code
5162 .ifdef AAA
5163 message_size_limit = 50M
5164 .else
5165 message_size_limit = 100M
5166 .endif
5167 .endd
5168 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5169 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5170 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5171 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5172 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5173
5174 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5175 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5176 in this line"& will always be true.
5177
5178 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5179 to clarify complicated nestings.
5180
5181
5182
5183 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5184 .cindex "common option syntax"
5185 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5186 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5187 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5188 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5189 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5190 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5191 space) and then the value. For example:
5192 .code
5193 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5194 .endd
5195 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5196 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5197 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5198 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5199 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5200 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5201 word &"hide"&. For example:
5202 .code
5203 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5204 .endd
5205 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5206 .code
5207 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5208 .endd
5209 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5210 all instances of the same driver.
5211
5212 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5213 that are found in option settings.
5214
5215
5216 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5217 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5218 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5219 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5220 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5221 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5222 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5223 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5224 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5225 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5226 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5227 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5228 .code
5229 queue_only
5230 queue_only = true
5231 .endd
5232 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5233 .code
5234 no_queue_only
5235 queue_only = false
5236 .endd
5237 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5238
5239
5240
5241
5242 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5243 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5244 .cindex "format" "integer"
5245 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5246 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5247 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5248 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5249 hexadecimal number.
5250
5251 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5252 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5253 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5254 When the values
5255 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5256 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5257 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5258 used.
5259
5260
5261 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5262 .cindex "integer format"
5263 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5264 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5265 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5266 Such options are always output in octal.
5267
5268
5269 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5270 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5271 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5272 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5273 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5274
5275
5276
5277 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5278 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5279 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5280 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5281 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5282
5283 .table2 30pt
5284 .irow &%s%& seconds
5285 .irow &%m%& minutes
5286 .irow &%h%& hours
5287 .irow &%d%& days
5288 .irow &%w%& weeks
5289 .endtable
5290
5291 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5292 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5293 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5294
5295
5296
5297 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5298 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5299 .cindex "format" "string"
5300 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5301 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5302 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5303 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5304 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5305 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5306 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5307 therefore equivalent:
5308 .code
5309 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5310 trusted_users = uucp:\
5311 # This comment line is ignored
5312 mail
5313 .endd
5314 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5315 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5316 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5317 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5318 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5319
5320 .table2 100pt
5321 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5322 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5323 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5324 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5325 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5326 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5327 character"
5328 .endtable
5329
5330 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5331 character, that character replaces the pair.
5332
5333 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5334 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5335 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5336 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5337 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5338 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5339
5340
5341 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5342 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5343 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5344 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5345 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5346 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5347 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5348 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5349 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5350 within a quoted configuration string.
5351
5352
5353 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5354 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5355 .cindex "format" "user name"
5356 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5357 .cindex "format" "group name"
5358 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5359 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5360 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5361 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5362
5363
5364 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5365 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5366 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5367 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5368 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5369 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5370 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5371 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5372 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5373 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5374 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5375
5376 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5377 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5378 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5379 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5380 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5381 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5382 example, the list
5383 .code
5384 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5385 .endd
5386 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5387
5388 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5389 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5390 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5391 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5392
5393 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5394 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5395 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5396 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5397 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5398 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5399 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5400 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5401 .code
5402 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5403 .endd
5404 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5405 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5406 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5407
5408 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5409 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5410 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5411 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5412 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5413 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5414 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5415 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5416 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5417 .code
5418 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5419 .endd
5420 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5421 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5422 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5423 the value in quotes. For example:
5424 .code
5425 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5426 .endd
5427 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5428 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5429 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5430 enclosing an empty list item.
5431
5432
5433
5434 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5435 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5436 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5437 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5438 .code
5439 senders = user@domain :
5440 .endd
5441 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5442 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5443 items, the second of which is empty:
5444 .code
5445 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5446 .endd
5447 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5448 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5449 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5450 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5451 .code
5452 senders = :
5453 .endd
5454 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5455 is at the end of the list.
5456
5457
5458
5459
5460 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5461 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5462 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5463 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5464 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5465 a sequence of lines like this:
5466 .display
5467 <&'instance name'&>:
5468 <&'option'&>
5469 ...
5470 <&'option'&>
5471 .endd
5472 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5473 followed by three options settings:
5474 .code
5475 localuser:
5476 driver = accept
5477 check_local_user
5478 transport = local_delivery
5479 .endd
5480 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5481 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5482 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5483 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5484 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5485 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5486
5487 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5488 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5489
5490 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5491 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5492 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5493 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5494 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5495 server.
5496
5497 .cindex "generic options"
5498 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5499 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5500 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5501 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5502 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5503 .cindex "private options"
5504 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5505 they all have default values.
5506
5507 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5508 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5509 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5510
5511 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5512 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5513 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5514 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5515 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5516 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5517 configuration lines:
5518 .code
5519 remote_smtp:
5520 driver = smtp
5521 .endd
5522 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5523 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5524 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5525 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5526 thus:
5527 .code
5528 special_smtp:
5529 driver = smtp
5530 port = 1234
5531 command_timeout = 10s
5532 .endd
5533 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5534 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5535 lines.
5536
5537 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5538 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5539 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5540 option.
5541
5542
5543
5544
5545
5546
5547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5549
5550 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5551 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5552 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5553 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5554 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5555 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5556 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5557 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5558 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5559 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5560 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5561
5562
5563
5564 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5565 All macros should be defined before any options.
5566
5567 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5568 .code
5569 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5570 .endd
5571 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5572 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5573 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5574 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5575
5576 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5577 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5578 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5579
5580
5581 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5582 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5583 in the file, after the macros.
5584 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5585 .code
5586 # primary_hostname =
5587 .endd
5588 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5589 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5590 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5591 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5592
5593 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5594 .code
5595 domainlist local_domains = @
5596 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5597 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5598 .endd
5599 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5600 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5601 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5602 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5603
5604 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5605 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5606 on the local host.
5607
5608 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5609 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5610 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5611 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5612 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5613 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5614
5615 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5616 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5617 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5618 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5619 domain is permitted.
5620
5621 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5622 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5623 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5624 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5625 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5626 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5627
5628 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5629 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5630 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5631
5632 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5633 .code
5634 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5635 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5636 .endd
5637 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5638 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5639 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5640 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5641 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5642 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5643 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5644 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5645 contents of a message to be checked.
5646
5647 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5648 .code
5649 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5650 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5651 .endd
5652 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5653 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5654 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5655 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5656
5657 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5658 .code
5659 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5660 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5661 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5662 .endd
5663 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5664 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5665 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5666 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5667 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5668 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5669 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5670
5671 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5672 .code
5673 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5674 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5675 .endd
5676 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5677 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5678 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5679 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5680 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5681 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5682 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5683 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5684 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5685 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5686 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5687 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5688 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5689 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5690 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5691 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5692 consequences).
5693 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5694 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5695 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5696 which should be used in preference to 587.
5697 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5698 these ports.
5699 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5700
5701 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5702 .code
5703 # qualify_domain =
5704 # qualify_recipient =
5705 .endd
5706 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5707 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5708 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5709 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5710 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5711 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5712
5713 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5714 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5715 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5716 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5717 .code
5718 # allow_domain_literals
5719 .endd
5720 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5721 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5722 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5723 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5724 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5725 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5726
5727 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5728 .code
5729 never_users = root
5730 .endd
5731 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5732 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5733 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5734 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5735 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5736 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5737 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5738 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5739
5740 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5741 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5742 line,
5743 .code
5744 host_lookup = *
5745 .endd
5746 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5747 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5748 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5749 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5750 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5751 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5752 unreachable.
5753
5754 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5755 1413 (hence their names):
5756 .code
5757 rfc1413_hosts = *
5758 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5759 .endd
5760 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5761 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5762 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5763 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5764 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5765 information, you can change this.
5766
5767 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5768 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5769 .code
5770 prdr_enable = true
5771 .endd
5772
5773 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5774 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5775 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5776 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5777 .code
5778 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5779 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5780 .endd
5781 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5782 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5783
5784 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5785 over the default:
5786 .code
5787 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5788 +tls_certificate_verified
5789 .endd
5790
5791 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5792 .code
5793 # percent_hack_domains =
5794 .endd
5795 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5796 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5797 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5798
5799 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5800 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5801 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5802 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5803 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5804 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5805 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5806 always bounce messages.
5807 .code
5808 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5809 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5810 .endd
5811 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5812 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5813 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5814 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5815 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5816
5817 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5818 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5819 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5820 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5821 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5822 not often needed).
5823 .code
5824 # split_spool_directory = true
5825 .endd
5826
5827 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5828 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5829 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5830 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5831 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5832 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5833 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5834 .code
5835 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5836 .endd
5837
5838 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5839 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5840 that are not 8-bit clean.
5841 .code
5842 # accept_8bitmime = false
5843 .endd
5844
5845 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5846 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5847 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5848 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5849 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5850 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5851 .code
5852 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5853 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5854 .endd
5855
5856
5857 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5858 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5859 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5860 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5861 It starts with the line
5862 .code
5863 begin acl
5864 .endd
5865 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5866 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5867 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5868
5869 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5870 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5871 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5872 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5873 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5874 result of the ACL processing.
5875 .code
5876 acl_check_rcpt:
5877 .endd
5878 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5879 ACL, and names it.
5880 .code
5881 accept hosts = :
5882 .endd
5883 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5884 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5885 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5886 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5887 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5888 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5889
5890 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5891 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5892 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5893 manner.
5894 .code
5895 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5896 domains = +local_domains
5897 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5898
5899 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5900 domains = !+local_domains
5901 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5902 .endd
5903 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5904 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5905 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5906 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5907 in Internet mail addresses.
5908
5909 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5910 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5911 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5912 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5913 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5914 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5915 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5916 policy of being as safe as possible.
5917
5918 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5919 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5920 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5921 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5922 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5923 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5924
5925 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5926 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5927 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5928 have to modify this rule.
5929
5930 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5931 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5932 common convention of local parts constructed as
5933 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5934 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5935 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5936 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5937 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5938 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5939
5940 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5941 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5942 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5943 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5944 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5945 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5946 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5947 .code
5948 accept local_parts = postmaster
5949 domains = +local_domains
5950 .endd
5951 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5952 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5953 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5954 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5955 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5956
5957 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5958 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5959 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5960 .code
5961 require verify = sender
5962 .endd
5963 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5964 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5965 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5966 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5967 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5968 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5969 discusses the details of address verification.
5970 .code
5971 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5972 control = submission
5973 .endd
5974 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5975 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5976 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5977 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5978 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5979 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5980 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5981 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5982 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5983 .code
5984 accept authenticated = *
5985 control = submission
5986 .endd
5987 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5988 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5989 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5990 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5991 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5992 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5993 .code
5994 require message = relay not permitted
5995 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5996 .endd
5997 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5998 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5999 .code
6000 require verify = recipient
6001 .endd
6002 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6003 fails, the address is rejected.
6004 .code
6005 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6006 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6007 # $dnslist_text
6008 # dnslists = black.list.example
6009 #
6010 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6011 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6012 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6013 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6014 .endd
6015 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6016 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6017 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6018 line.
6019 .code
6020 # require verify = csa
6021 .endd
6022 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6023 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6024 records.
6025 .code
6026 accept
6027 .endd
6028 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6029 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6030 .code
6031 acl_check_data:
6032 .endd
6033 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6034 of this ACL are commented out:
6035 .code
6036 # deny malware = *
6037 # message = This message contains a virus \
6038 # ($malware_name).
6039 .endd
6040 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6041 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6042 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6043 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6044 .code
6045 # warn spam = nobody
6046 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6047 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6048 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6049 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6050 .endd
6051 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6052 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6053 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6054 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6055 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6056 whatever the spam score.
6057 .code
6058 accept
6059 .endd
6060 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6061
6062
6063 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6064 .cindex "default" "routers"
6065 .cindex "routers" "default"
6066 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6067 by the line
6068 .code
6069 begin routers
6070 .endd
6071 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6072 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6073 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6074 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6075 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6076 .code
6077 # domain_literal:
6078 # driver = ipliteral
6079 # domains = !+local_domains
6080 # transport = remote_smtp
6081 .endd
6082 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6083 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6084 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6085 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6086 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6087
6088 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6089 macro has been defined, per
6090 .code
6091 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6092 smarthost:
6093 #...
6094 .else
6095 dnslookup:
6096 #...
6097 .endif
6098 .endd
6099
6100 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6101 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6102 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6103 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6104
6105 .code
6106 smarthost:
6107 driver = manualroute
6108 domains = ! +local_domains
6109 transport = smarthost_smtp
6110 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6111 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6112 no_more
6113 .endd
6114 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6115 specified by the line
6116 .code
6117 domains = ! +local_domains
6118 .endd
6119 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6120 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6121 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6122 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6123 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6124 passed on to the following routers.
6125
6126 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6127 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6128 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6129 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6130
6131 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6132 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6133 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6134 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6135 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6136 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6137 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6138
6139 .code
6140 dnslookup:
6141 driver = dnslookup
6142 domains = ! +local_domains
6143 transport = remote_smtp
6144 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6145 no_more
6146 .endd
6147 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6148
6149 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6150 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6151 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6152 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6153 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6154
6155 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6156 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6157 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6158 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6159 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6160 the address fails and is bounced.
6161
6162 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6163 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6164 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6165 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6166 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6167 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6168 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6169 out.
6170 .code
6171 system_aliases:
6172 driver = redirect
6173 allow_fail
6174 allow_defer
6175 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6176 # user = exim
6177 file_transport = address_file
6178 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6179 .endd
6180 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6181 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6182 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6183 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6184 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6185 the next router.
6186
6187 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6188 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6189 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6190 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6191 .code
6192 userforward:
6193 driver = redirect
6194 check_local_user
6195 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6196 # local_part_suffix_optional
6197 file = $home/.forward
6198 # allow_filter
6199 no_verify
6200 no_expn
6201 check_ancestor
6202 file_transport = address_file
6203 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6204 reply_transport = address_reply
6205 .endd
6206 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6207 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6208 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6209 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6210 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6211 namely:
6212 .code
6213 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6214 # local_part_suffix_optional
6215 .endd
6216 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6217 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6218 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6219 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6220 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6221 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6222 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6223
6224 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6225 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6226 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6227 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6228
6229 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6230 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6231 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6232 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6233 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6234 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6235 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6236
6237 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6238 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6239 There are two reasons for doing this:
6240
6241 .olist
6242 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6243 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6244 unnecessary work.
6245 .next
6246 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6247 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6248 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6249 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6250 this time.
6251 .endlist
6252
6253 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6254 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6255 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6256 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6257
6258 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6259 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6260 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6261 .code
6262 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6263 .endd
6264 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6265 transport.
6266 .code
6267 localuser:
6268 driver = accept
6269 check_local_user
6270 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6271 # local_part_suffix_optional
6272 transport = local_delivery
6273 .endd
6274 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6275 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6276 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6277 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6278 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6279
6280
6281 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6282 .cindex "default" "transports"
6283 .cindex "transports" "default"
6284 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6285 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6286 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6287 .code
6288 begin transports
6289 .endd
6290 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6291 .code
6292 remote_smtp:
6293 driver = smtp
6294 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6295 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6296 hosts_try_prdr = *
6297 .endif
6298 .endd
6299 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6300 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6301 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6302 with over-long lines.
6303
6304 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6305 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6306 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6307 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6308
6309 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6310 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6311 usual federated system.
6312
6313 .code
6314 smarthost_smtp:
6315 driver = smtp
6316 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6317 multi_domain
6318 #
6319 .ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6320 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6321 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6322 hosts_require_tls = *
6323 tls_verify_hosts = *
6324 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6325 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6326 # or not:
6327 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6328 #
6329 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6330 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6331 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6332 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6333 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6334 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6335 #
6336 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6337 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6338 .endif
6339 .ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6340 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6341 .endif
6342 .endif
6343 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6344 hosts_try_prdr = *
6345 .endif
6346 .endd
6347 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6348 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6349 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6350 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6351 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6352 then no other options are defined.
6353 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6354 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6355 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6356 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6357 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6358 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6359 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6360 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6361 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6362 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6363 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6364
6365 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6366
6367 All other options are defaulted.
6368 .code
6369 local_delivery:
6370 driver = appendfile
6371 file = /var/mail/$local_part_verified
6372 delivery_date_add
6373 envelope_to_add
6374 return_path_add
6375 # group = mail
6376 # mode = 0660
6377 .endd
6378 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6379 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6380
6381 .new
6382 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6383 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6384 Instead we use &$local_part_verified$&,
6385 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6386 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6387 .wen
6388
6389 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6390 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6391 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6392 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6393 show how this can be done.
6394
6395 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6396 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6397 similarly-named options above.
6398 .code
6399 address_pipe:
6400 driver = pipe
6401 return_output
6402 .endd
6403 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6404 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6405 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6406 be returned to the sender.
6407 .code
6408 address_file:
6409 driver = appendfile
6410 delivery_date_add
6411 envelope_to_add
6412 return_path_add
6413 .endd
6414 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6415 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6416 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6417 .code
6418 address_reply:
6419 driver = autoreply
6420 .endd
6421 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6422 filter files.
6423
6424
6425
6426 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6427 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6428 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6429 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6430 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6431 introduced by the line
6432 .code
6433 begin retry
6434 .endd
6435 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6436 errors:
6437 .code
6438 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6439 .endd
6440 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6441 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6442 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6443 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6444 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6445
6446 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6447 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6448 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6449
6450
6451 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6452 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6453 .code
6454 begin rewrite
6455 .endd
6456 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6457 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6458
6459
6460
6461 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6462 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6463 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6464 .code
6465 begin authenticators
6466 .endd
6467 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6468 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6469 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6470 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6471 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6472 to support most MUA software.
6473
6474 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6475 .code
6476 #PLAIN:
6477 # driver = plaintext
6478 # server_set_id = $auth2
6479 # server_prompts = :
6480 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6481 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6482 .endd
6483 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6484 .code
6485 #LOGIN:
6486 # driver = plaintext
6487 # server_set_id = $auth1
6488 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6489 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6490 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6491 .endd
6492
6493 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6494 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6495 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6496 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6497 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6498 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6499 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6500 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6501
6502 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6503 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6504 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6505 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6506
6507 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6508 usercode and password are in different positions.
6509 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6510
6511 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6512
6513
6514
6515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6517
6518 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6519
6520 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6521 .cindex "PCRE"
6522 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6523 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6524 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6525 regular expressions is discussed in
6526 online Perl manpages, in
6527 many Perl reference books, and also in
6528 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6529 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6530 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6531 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6532 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6533
6534 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6535 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6536 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6537 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6538 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6539 case-insensitive.
6540
6541 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6542 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6543 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6544 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6545 .code
6546 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6547 .endd
6548 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6549 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6550 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6551 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6552 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6553 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6554 matched.
6555
6556 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6557 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6558 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6559 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6560 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6561 match anywhere in the subject string.
6562
6563 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6564 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6565 .code
6566 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6567 .endd
6568 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6569 You need to use:
6570 .code
6571 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6572 .endd
6573 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6574 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6575
6576
6577
6578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6580
6581 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6582 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6583 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6585 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6586 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6587
6588 .olist
6589 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6590 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6591 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6592 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6593 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6594 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6595 .next
6596 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6597 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6598 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6599 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6600 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6601 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6602 .endlist
6603
6604 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6605 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6606 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6607 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6608 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6609 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6610
6611 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6612 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6613 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6614 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6615 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6616 .code
6617 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6618 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6619 .endd
6620 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6621 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6622 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6623 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6624 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6625 .code
6626 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6627 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6628 .endd
6629 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6630 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6631
6632 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6633 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6634 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6635 .code
6636 domain1:
6637 domain2:
6638 .endd
6639 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6640 matches the list item.
6641
6642 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6643 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6644 .code
6645 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6646 .endd
6647 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6648 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6649 causes a second lookup to occur.
6650
6651 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6652 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6653 lookup is permitted.
6654
6655
6656 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6657 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6658 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6659 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6660
6661 .ilist
6662 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6663 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6664 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6665 .next
6666 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6667 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6668 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6669 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6670 .endlist
6671
6672 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6673 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6674 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6675 .code
6676 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6677 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6678 .endd
6679 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6680 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6681 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6682
6683
6684
6685
6686 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6687 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6688 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6689 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6690
6691 .ilist
6692 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6693 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6694 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6695 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6696 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6697 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6698 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6699 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6700 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6701 .display
6702 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6703 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6704 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6705 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6706 .endd
6707 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6708 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6709 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6710 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6711 .next
6712 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6714 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6715 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6716 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6717 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6718 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6719
6720 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6721 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6722 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6723 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6724 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6725 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6726 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6727 .next
6728 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6729 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6730 .cindex "sasldb2"
6731 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6732 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6733 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6734 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6735 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6736 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6737 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6738 .next
6739 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6740 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6741 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6742 .cindex "Courier"
6743 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6744 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6745 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6746 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6747 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6748 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6749 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6750 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6751 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6752 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6753 .next
6754 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6755 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6756 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6757 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6758 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6759 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6760 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6761 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6762 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6763 .next
6764 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6765 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6766 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6767 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6768 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6769 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6770 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6771 .code
6772 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6773 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6774 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6775 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6776 .endd
6777 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6778 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6779 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6780 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6781 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6782
6783 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6784 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6785 lookup types support only literal keys.
6786
6787 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6788 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6789 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6790
6791 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6792 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6793 notation before executing the lookup.)
6794 .next
6795 .cindex lookup json
6796 .cindex json "lookup type"
6797 .cindex JSON expansions
6798 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6799 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6800 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6801 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6802 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6803 of the JSON structure.
6804 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6805 nunbered array element is selected.
6806 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6807 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6808 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6809 is returned.
6810 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6811 .next
6812 .cindex "linear search"
6813 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6814 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6815 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6816 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6817 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6818 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6819 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6820 in the file is used.
6821
6822 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6823 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6824 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6825 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6826 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6827 colon, for example:
6828 .code
6829 baduser: :fail:
6830 .endd
6831 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6832 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6833 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6834 wildcarding of any kind.
6835
6836 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6837 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6838 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6839 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6840 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6841 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6842 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6843 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6844 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6845
6846 .next
6847 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6848 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6849 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6850 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6851 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6852 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6853 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6854 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6855
6856 .next
6857 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6858 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6859 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6860 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6861 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6862 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6863 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6864 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6865 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6866
6867 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6868 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6869 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6870 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6871
6872 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6873 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6874
6875 .olist
6876 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6877 .code
6878 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6879 *fish data for anythingfish
6880 .endd
6881 .next
6882 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6883 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6884 .code
6885 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6886 .endd
6887 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6888 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6889 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6890 .code
6891 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6892 .endd
6893 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6894 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6895 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6896 .code
6897 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6898 .endd
6899
6900 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6901 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6902 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6903 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6904 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6905
6906 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6907 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6908 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6909 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6910 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6911
6912 .next
6913 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6914 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6915 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6916 example:
6917 .code
6918 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6919 .endd
6920 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6921 .endlist olist
6922
6923 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6924 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6925 be followed by optional colons.
6926
6927 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6928 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6929 lookup types support only literal keys.
6930
6931 .next
6932 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6933 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6934 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6935 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6936 .endlist ilist
6937
6938
6939 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6940 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6941 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6942 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6943 many of them are given in later sections.
6944
6945 .ilist
6946 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6947 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6948 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6949 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6950 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6951 .next
6952 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6953 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6954 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6955 .next
6956 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6957 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6958 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6959 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6960 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6961 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6962 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6963 .next
6964 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6965 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6966 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6967 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6968 .next
6969 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6970 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6971 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6972 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6973 .next
6974 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6975 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6976 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6977 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6978 .next
6979 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6980 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6981 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6982 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6983 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6984 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6985 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6986 password value. For example:
6987 .code
6988 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6989 .endd
6990 .next
6991 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6992 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6993 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6994 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6995
6996 .next
6997 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6998 .cindex lookup Redis
6999 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7000 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7001
7002 .next
7003 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7004 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7005 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
7006 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7007
7008 .next
7009 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7010 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7011 .next
7012 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7013 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7014 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7015 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7016 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7017 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7018 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7019 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7020 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7021 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7022 .code
7023 require condition = \
7024 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7025 .endd
7026 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7027 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7028 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7029 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7030 .endlist
7031
7032
7033
7034 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7035 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7036 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7037 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7038 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7039 options such as a list of local domains.
7040
7041 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7042 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7043 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7044 or may give up altogether.
7045
7046
7047
7048 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7049 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7050 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7051 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7052 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7053 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7054 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7055 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7056
7057 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7058 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7059 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7060
7061 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7062 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7063 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7064
7065 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7066 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7067 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7068 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7069 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7070 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7071 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7072 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7073 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7074 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7075 .code
7076 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7077 .endd
7078 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7079 looks up these keys, in this order:
7080 .code
7081 jane@eyre.example
7082 *@eyre.example
7083 *
7084 .endd
7085 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7086 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7087 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7088 Exim move on to try the next key.
7089
7090
7091
7092 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7093 .cindex "partial matching"
7094 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7095 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7096 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7097 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7098 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7099 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7100 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7101 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7102 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7103 a key in a DBM file is
7104 .code
7105 *.dates.fict.example
7106 .endd
7107 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7108 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7109 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7110 file.
7111
7112 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7113 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7114 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7115
7116 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7117 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7118 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7119 partial matching keys
7120 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7121 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7122 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7123
7124 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7125 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7126 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7127 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7128 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7129 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7130 remains.
7131
7132 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7133 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7134 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7135 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7136 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7137 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7138 .code
7139 2250.dates.fict.example
7140 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7141 *.dates.fict.example
7142 *.fict.example
7143 .endd
7144 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7145 finishes.
7146
7147 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7148 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7149 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7150 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7151 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7152 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7153 .code
7154 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7155 .endd
7156 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7157 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7158 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7159 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7160 .code
7161 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7162 .endd
7163 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7164 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7165
7166 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7167 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7168 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7169
7170 .ilist
7171 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7172 .next
7173 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7174 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7175 .next
7176 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7177 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7178 for &"*"& on its own.
7179 .next
7180 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7181 .endlist
7182
7183
7184 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7185 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7186 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7187 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7188 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7189 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7190 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7191
7192 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7193 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7194 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7195 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7196 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7197
7198
7199
7200
7201 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7202 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7203 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7204 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7205 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7206 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7207 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7208
7209 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7210 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7211 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7212 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7213 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7214 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7215
7216 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7217 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7218 complete.
7219
7220
7221
7222
7223 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7224 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7225 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7226 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7227 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7228 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7229 .code
7230 [name=$local_part]
7231 .endd
7232 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7233 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7234 .code
7235 [name="$local_part"]
7236 .endd
7237 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7238 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7239 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7240 of the following form is provided:
7241 .code
7242 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7243 .endd
7244 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7245 .code
7246 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7247 .endd
7248 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7249 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7250 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7251
7252
7253
7254
7255 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7256 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7257 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7258 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7259 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7260 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7261 an expansion string could contain:
7262 .code
7263 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7264 .endd
7265 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7266 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7267 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7268 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7269
7270 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7271 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7272 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7273
7274 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7275 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7276 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7277 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7278 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7279 .code
7280 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7281 .endd
7282 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7283 white space is ignored.
7284 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7285 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7286 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7287
7288 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7289 When the type is PTR,
7290 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7291 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7292 .code
7293 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7294 .endd
7295 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7296 altered and nothing is added.
7297
7298 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7299 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7300 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7301 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7302 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7303 The field separator can be modified as above.
7304
7305 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7306 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7307 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7308 unless a field separator is specified.
7309 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7310 For SPF records the
7311 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7312 .code
7313 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7314 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7315 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7316 .endd
7317 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7318 white space is ignored.
7319
7320 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7321 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7322 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7323 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7324 specified.
7325 .code
7326 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7327 .endd
7328
7329 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7330 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7331 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7332 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7333 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7334 each followed by a comma,
7335 that may appear before the record type.
7336
7337 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7338 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7339 a defer-option modifier.
7340 The possible keywords are
7341 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7342 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7343 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7344 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7345 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7346 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7347 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7348 .code
7349 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7350 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7351 .endd
7352 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7353 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7354
7355 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7356 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7357 The possible keywords are
7358 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7359 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7360 with the lookup.
7361 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7362 is not labelled as authenticated data
7363 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7364 The default is &"lax"&.
7365
7366 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7367
7368 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7369 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7370 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7371 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7372 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7373 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7374
7375 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7376 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7377 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7378
7379 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7380 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7381 .cindex DNS TTL
7382 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7383 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7384 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7385
7386
7387 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7388 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7389 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7390 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7391 the pseudo-type MXH:
7392 .code
7393 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7394 .endd
7395 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7396 returned.
7397
7398 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7399 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7400 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7401 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7402 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7403 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7404 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7405 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7406 .code
7407 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7408 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7409 .endd
7410 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7411 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7412 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7413
7414 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7415 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7416 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7417 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7418 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7419 such a list.
7420
7421 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7422 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7423 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7424 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7425 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7426 result of a successful lookup such as:
7427 .code
7428 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7429 .endd
7430 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7431 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7432 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7433
7434 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7435 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7436 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7437 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7438 .code
7439 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7440 .endd
7441
7442
7443 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7444 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7445 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7446 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7447 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7448 .code
7449 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7450 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7451 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7452 .endd
7453 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7454 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7455 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7456 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7457
7458 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7459 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7460 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7461
7462
7463
7464
7465 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7466 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7467 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7468 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7469 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7470 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7471 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7472 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7473 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7474 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7475 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7476 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7477 .code
7478 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7479 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7480 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7481 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7482 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7483 .endd
7484 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7485 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7486
7487 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7488 the way they handle the results of a query:
7489
7490 .ilist
7491 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7492 gives an error.
7493 .next
7494 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7495 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7496 .next
7497 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7498 from all of them are returned.
7499 .endlist
7500
7501
7502 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7503 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7504 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7505 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7506
7507
7508 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7509 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7510 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7511 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7512 .code
7513 data = ${lookup ldap \
7514 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7515 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7516 .endd
7517 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7518 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7519 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7520 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7521
7522 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7523 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7524 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7525
7526 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7527 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7528 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7529 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7530 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7531 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7532 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7533 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7534 &_exim.conf_&.
7535
7536
7537 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7538 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7539 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7540 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7541 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7542 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7543
7544 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7545 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7546 the string:
7547 .code
7548 * => \2A
7549 ( => \28
7550 ) => \29
7551 \ => \5C
7552 .endd
7553 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7554 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7555 .code
7556 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7557 .endd
7558 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7559 .code
7560 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7561 .endd
7562 yields
7563 .code
7564 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7565 .endd
7566 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7567 .code
7568 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7569 .endd
7570 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7571 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7572 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7573 .code
7574 , + " \ < > ;
7575 .endd
7576 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7577 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7578 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7579 .code
7580 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7581 .endd
7582 yields
7583 .code
7584 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7585 .endd
7586 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7587 .code
7588 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7589 .endd
7590 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7591 authentication below.
7592
7593
7594 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7595 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7596 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7597 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7598 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7599 by starting it with
7600 .code
7601 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7602 .endd
7603 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7604 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7605 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7606 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7607 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7608 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7609 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7610 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7611 failures, and timeouts.
7612
7613 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7614 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7615 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7616 doubled. For example
7617 .code
7618 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7619 .endd
7620 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7621 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7622 the local host) is used.
7623
7624 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7625 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7626 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7627 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7628 not available.
7629
7630 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7631 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7632 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7633 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7634 .code
7635 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7636 .endd
7637 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7638 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7639 .code
7640 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7641 .endd
7642 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7643 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7644 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7645 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7646 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7647 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7648 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7649 backup host.
7650
7651 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7652 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7653 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7654
7655 .ilist
7656 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7657 interface.
7658 .next
7659 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7660 .endlist
7661
7662
7663 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7664 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7665
7666
7667
7668 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7669 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7670 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7671 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7672 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7673 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7674 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7675 them. The following names are recognized:
7676 .display
7677 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7678 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7679 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7680 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7681 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7682 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7683 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7684 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7685 .endd
7686 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7687 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7688 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7689 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7690
7691 .cindex LDAP timeout
7692 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7693 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7694 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7695 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7696 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7697 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7698 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7699 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7700 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7701 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7702
7703 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7704 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7705
7706 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7707 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7708 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7709 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7710 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7711 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7712 alternate list (colon-separated).
7713
7714 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7715 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7716 .code
7717 ${lookup ldap
7718 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7719 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7720 {$value}fail}
7721 .endd
7722 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7723 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7724 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7725 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7726
7727 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7728 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7729 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7730
7731 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7732 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7733 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7734 quoting has two advantages:
7735
7736 .ilist
7737 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7738 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7739 .next
7740 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7741 .endlist
7742
7743 For example, a setting such as
7744 .code
7745 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7746 .endd
7747 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7748
7749 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7750 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7751 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7752 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7753 .code
7754 PASS=${quote:$3}
7755 .endd
7756 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7757 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7758 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7759
7760
7761
7762 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7763 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7764 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7765 as a sequence of values, for example
7766 .code
7767 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7768 .endd
7769 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7770 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7771 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7772 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7773 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7774 directory.
7775
7776 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7777 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7778 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7779 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7780
7781 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7782 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7783 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7784 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7785 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7786 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7787 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7788 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7789 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7790
7791 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7792 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7793 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7794 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7795 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7796
7797 .code
7798 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7799 value1.1,value1,,2
7800
7801 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7802 value two
7803
7804 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7805 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7806
7807 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7808 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7809
7810 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7811 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7812 .endd
7813 You can
7814 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7815 results of LDAP lookups.
7816 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7817 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7818 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7819 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7820 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7821 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7822
7823
7824
7825
7826 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7827 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7828 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7829 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7830 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7831 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7832 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7833 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7834 .code
7835 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7836 .endd
7837 might return the string
7838 .code
7839 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7840 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7841 .endd
7842 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7843 .code
7844 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7845 .endd
7846 would just return
7847 .code
7848 Martin Guerre
7849 .endd
7850 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7851 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7852 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7853
7854
7855
7856 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7857 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7858 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7859 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7860 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7861 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7862 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7863 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7864 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7865 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7866 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7867 .cindex lookup Redis
7868 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7869 and SQLite
7870 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7871 might be
7872 .code
7873 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7874 {$value}fail}
7875 .endd
7876 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7877 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7878 .code
7879 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7880 {$value}}
7881 .endd
7882 might be
7883 .code
7884 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7885 .endd
7886 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7887 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7888 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7889 .code
7890 Mister X
7891 .endd
7892 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7893 with a newline between the data for each row.
7894
7895
7896 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7897 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7898 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7899 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7900 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7901 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7902 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7903 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7904 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7905 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7906 .cindex lookup Redis
7907 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7908 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7909 or &%redis_servers%&
7910 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7911 information.
7912 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7913 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7914 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7915 For all but Redis
7916 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7917 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7918 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7919 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7920 .code
7921 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7922 .endd
7923 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7924 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7925 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7926 .code
7927 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7928 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7929 .endd
7930 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7931 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7932 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7933 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7934 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7935 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7936
7937 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7938 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7939 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7940 information.
7941 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7942 host, database number, and password.
7943 .olist
7944 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7945 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7946 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7947 .next
7948 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7949 .next
7950 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7951 .endlist
7952
7953 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7954 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7955 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7956 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7957
7958 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7959 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7960
7961 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7962 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7963 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7964 done by starting the query with
7965 .display
7966 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7967 .endd
7968 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7969 .olist
7970 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7971 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7972 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7973 taken from there.
7974 .next
7975 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7976 .endlist
7977 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7978 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7979 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7980
7981 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7982 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7983 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7984 like this:
7985 .code
7986 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7987 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7988 master/db/name/pw
7989 .endd
7990 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7991 .code
7992 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7993 .endd
7994 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7995 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7996 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7997 .code
7998 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7999 .endd
8000
8001
8002 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8003 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8004 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8005 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8006 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8007 the default value is &"exim"&.
8008 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8009 .display
8010 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8011 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8012 .endd
8013 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8014 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8015
8016 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8017 the queries.
8018
8019 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8020 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8021
8022 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8023 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8024 is zero because no rows are affected.
8025
8026
8027 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8028 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8029 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8030 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8031 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8032 looks like this:
8033 .code
8034 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8035 .endd
8036 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8037 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8038 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8039
8040 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8041 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8042 affected.
8043
8044 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8045 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8046 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8047 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8048 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8049 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8050 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8051 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8052 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8053 .code
8054 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8055 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8056 .endd
8057 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8058 .code
8059 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8060 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8061 .endd
8062 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8063 quote, which it doubles.
8064
8065 .cindex timeout SQLite
8066 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8067 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8068 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8069 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8070 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8071 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8072 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8073 option.
8074
8075 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8076 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8077 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8078 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8079 Examples:
8080 .code
8081 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8082 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8083 .endd
8084
8085 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8086 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8087 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8088 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8089 servers.
8090
8091 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8092 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8093 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8094 reached.
8095
8096 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
8097 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
8098
8099
8100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8102
8103 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8104 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8105 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8106 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8107 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8108 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8109 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8110 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8111 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8112
8113 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8114 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8115 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8116 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8117
8118 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8119 support all the complexity available in
8120 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8121
8122
8123
8124 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8125 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8126 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8127
8128 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8129 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8130
8131 The result of
8132 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8133 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8134 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8135 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8136 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8137
8138
8139 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8140 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8141 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8142
8143 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8144 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8145 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8146 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8147 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8148 .code
8149 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8150 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8151 .endd
8152 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8153 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8154 senders based on the receiving domain.
8155
8156
8157
8158
8159 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8160 .cindex "list" "negation"
8161 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8162 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8163 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8164 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8165 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8166 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8167
8168 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8169 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8170 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8171 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8172 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8173 .code
8174 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8175 .endd
8176 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8177 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8178 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8179 .code
8180 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8181 .endd
8182 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8183 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8184 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8185
8186 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8187 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8188 item.
8189
8190
8191
8192 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8193 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8194 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8195 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8196 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8197 filenames are not allowed,
8198 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8199 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8200 lines:
8201
8202 .ilist
8203 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8204 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8205 .next
8206 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8207 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8208 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8209 .code
8210 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8211 .endd
8212 .endlist
8213
8214 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8215 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8216 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8217 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8218
8219 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8220 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8221 .code
8222 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8223 .endd
8224 and the file contains the lines
8225 .code
8226 !a.b.c
8227 *.b.c
8228 .endd
8229 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8230 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8231
8232
8233
8234 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8235 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8236 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8237 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8238 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8239 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8240 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8241 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8242
8243 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8244 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8245 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8246 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8247
8248
8249
8250
8251 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8252 .cindex "named lists"
8253 .cindex "list" "named"
8254 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8255 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8256 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8257 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8258 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8259 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8260 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8261 .code
8262 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8263 .endd
8264 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8265 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8266 configured with the line
8267 .code
8268 domains = +local_domains
8269 .endd
8270 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8271 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8272 .code
8273 dnslookup:
8274 driver = dnslookup
8275 domains = ! +local_domains
8276 transport = remote_smtp
8277 no_more
8278 .endd
8279 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8280 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8281 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8282 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8283 .code
8284 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8285 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8286 .endd
8287 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8288 .code
8289 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8290 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8291 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8292 .endd
8293 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8294 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8295 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8296 .code
8297 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8298 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8299 .endd
8300 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8301 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8302 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8303 .code
8304 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8305 .endd
8306 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8307 referenced lists if you can.
8308
8309 .new
8310 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8311 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8312 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8313 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8314 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8315 word &"hide"&. For example:
8316 .code
8317 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8318 .endd
8319 .wen
8320
8321
8322 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8323 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8324 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8325 .code
8326 domains = +local_domains
8327 .endd
8328 on several of your routers
8329 or in several ACL statements,
8330 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8331 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8332 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8333 the same each time they are referenced.
8334
8335 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8336 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8337 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8338 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8339
8340
8341
8342 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8343 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8344 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8345 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8346 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8347 write
8348 .code
8349 ALIST = host1 : host2
8350 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8351 .endd
8352 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8353 .code
8354 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8355 .endd
8356 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8357 list, and write
8358 .code
8359 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8360 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8361 .endd
8362 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8363 .code
8364 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8365 .endd
8366
8367
8368 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8369 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8370 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8371 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8372 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8373 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8374 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8375 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8376 message. For example:
8377 .code
8378 domainlist special_domains = \
8379 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8380 .endd
8381 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8382 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8383 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8384 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8385 same list each time.
8386
8387 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8388 cache the result anyway. For example:
8389 .code
8390 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8391 .endd
8392 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8393 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8394
8395
8396
8397 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8398 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8399 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8400 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8401 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8402
8403 .ilist
8404 .cindex "primary host name"
8405 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8406 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8407 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8408 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8409 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8410 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8411 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8412 differ only in their names.
8413 .next
8414 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8415 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8416 .cindex "domain literal"
8417 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8418 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8419 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8420 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8421 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8422 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8423 .next
8424 .cindex "@mx_any"
8425 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8426 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8427 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8428 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8429 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8430 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8431 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8432 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8433 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8434 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8435 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8436
8437 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8438 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8439 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8440 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8441 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8442
8443 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8444 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8445 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8446 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8447 on a router). For example:
8448 .code
8449 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8450 .endd
8451 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8452 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8453
8454 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8455 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8456 contain negative items.
8457
8458 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8459 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8460 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8461 .code
8462 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8463 an.other.domain : ...
8464 .endd
8465 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8466 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8467 .code
8468 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8469 an.other.domain ? ...
8470 .endd
8471 .next
8472 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8473 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8474 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8475 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8476 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8477 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8478 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8479 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8480 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8481 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8482
8483 .next
8484 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8485 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8486 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8487 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8488 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8489 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8490 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8491 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8492 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8493
8494 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8495 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8496 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8497 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8498 expression by expansion, of course).
8499 .next
8500 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8501 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8502 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8503 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8504 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8505 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8506 .code
8507 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8508 .endd
8509 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8510 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8511 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8512 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8513 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8514 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8515 other statements in the same ACL.
8516
8517 .next
8518 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8519 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8520 .code
8521 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8522 .endd
8523 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8524 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8525
8526 .next
8527 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8528 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8529 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8530 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8531 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8532 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8533 expansion variable.
8534 .next
8535 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8536 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8537 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8538 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8539 .code
8540 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8541 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8542 .endd
8543 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8544 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8545 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8546 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8547 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8548 .next
8549 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8550 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8551 between the pattern and the domain.
8552 .endlist
8553
8554 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8555 .code
8556 domainlist funny_domains = \
8557 @ : \
8558 lib.unseen.edu : \
8559 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8560 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8561 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8562 nis;domains.byname : \
8563 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8564 .endd
8565 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8566 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8567 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8568 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8569 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8570 patterns earlier.
8571
8572
8573
8574 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8575 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8576 .cindex "list" "host list"
8577 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8578 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8579 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8580 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8581 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8582 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8583 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8584
8585
8586 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8587 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8588 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8589 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8590 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8591 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8592 not used.
8593
8594 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8595 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8596 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8597
8598
8599
8600 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8601 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8602 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8603 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8604 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8605 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8606 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8607 concerns.)
8608
8609 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8610 inspecting its IP address:
8611
8612 .ilist
8613 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8614 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8615 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8616 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8617 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8618 with the IP address of the subject host.
8619
8620 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8621 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8622 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8623 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8624 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8625
8626 .next
8627 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8628 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8629 domain name, as just described.
8630
8631 .next
8632 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8633 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8634 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8635 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8636 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8637 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8638 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8639 that can never match a client host.
8640
8641 .next
8642 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8643 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8644 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8645 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8646 .code
8647 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8648 accept hosts = @[]
8649 .endd
8650 .next
8651 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8652 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8653 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8654 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8655 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8656 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8657 significant end of the address.
8658
8659 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8660 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8661 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8662 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8663 .code
8664 192.168.23.236/31
8665 .endd
8666 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8667 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8668 matches.
8669
8670 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8671 .code
8672 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8673 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8674 .endd
8675 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8676 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8677 For example:
8678 .code
8679 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8680 .endd
8681 could make use of a file containing
8682 .code
8683 172.16.0.0/12
8684 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8685 .endd
8686 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8687 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8688 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8689 .code
8690 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8691 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8692 .endd
8693 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8694 list.
8695 .endlist
8696
8697
8698
8699 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8700 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8701 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8702 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8703 address, the pattern takes this form:
8704 .display
8705 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8706 .endd
8707 For example:
8708 .code
8709 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8710 .endd
8711 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8712 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8713 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8714 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8715 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8716 returned by the lookup is not used.
8717
8718 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8719 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8720 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8721 patterns of this form:
8722 .display
8723 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8724 .endd
8725 For example:
8726 .code
8727 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8728 .endd
8729 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8730 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8731 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8732 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8733 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8734
8735 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8736 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8737 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8738 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8739 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8740 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8741 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8742 converted using colons and not dots.
8743 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8744 addresses are always used.
8745 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8746
8747 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8748 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8749 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8750 configurations.
8751
8752 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8753 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8754 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8755 case the IP address is used on its own.
8756
8757
8758
8759 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8760 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8761 .cindex "unknown host name"
8762 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8763 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8764 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8765 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8766 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8767 above.)
8768
8769 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8770 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8771 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8772 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8773 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8774 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8775 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8776
8777 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8778 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8779
8780 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8781 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8782 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8783 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8784 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8785 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8786 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8787 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8788 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8789
8790 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8791 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8792
8793 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8794 .cindex "alias for host"
8795 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8796 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8797
8798 .ilist
8799 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8800 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8801 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8802 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8803 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8804 expression.
8805 .next
8806 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8807 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8808 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8809 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8810 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8811 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8812 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8813 example,
8814 .code
8815 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8816 .endd
8817 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8818 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8819 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8820 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8821 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8822 .code
8823 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8824 .endd
8825 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8826 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8827 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8828 required.
8829 .endlist
8830
8831
8832
8833
8834 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8835 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8836 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8837 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8838 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8839 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8840
8841 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8842 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8843
8844 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8845 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8846 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8847 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8848 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8849 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8850 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8851 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8852 not recognized in an indirected file).
8853
8854 .ilist
8855 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8856 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8857 .code
8858 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8859 .endd
8860 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8861 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8862
8863 .next
8864 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8865 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8866 example:
8867 .code
8868 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8869 192.168.4.5
8870 .endd
8871 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8872 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8873 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8874 .endlist
8875
8876 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8877 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8878 list.
8879
8880 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8881 "SECTmixwilhos"
8882 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8883
8884 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8885 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8886 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8887
8888 .ilist
8889 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8890 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8891 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8892 .code
8893 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8894 .endd
8895 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8896 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8897 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8898 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8899 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8900 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8901 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8902
8903 .next
8904 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8905 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8906 .code
8907 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8908 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8909 .endd
8910 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8911 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8912 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8913 this section.
8914 .endlist
8915
8916
8917 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8918 "SECTtemdnserr"
8919 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8920 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8921 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8922 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8923 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8924 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8925 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8926 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8927 host lists such as whitelists.
8928
8929
8930
8931 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8932 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8933 .cindex "unknown host name"
8934 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8935 If a pattern is of the form
8936 .display
8937 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8938 .endd
8939 for example
8940 .code
8941 dbm;/host/accept/list
8942 .endd
8943 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8944 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8945 is not used.
8946
8947 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8948 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8949 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8950 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8951 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8952 lookup, both using the same file.
8953
8954
8955
8956 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8957 If a pattern is of the form
8958 .display
8959 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8960 .endd
8961 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8962 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8963 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8964 .code
8965 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8966 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8967 .endd
8968 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8969 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8970 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8971 operator.
8972
8973 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8974 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8975 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8976
8977 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8978 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8979 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8980 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8981 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8982 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8983
8984
8985
8986
8987
8988 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8989 .cindex "list" "address list"
8990 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8991 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8992 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8993 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8994 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8995 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8996 using this option setting:
8997 .code
8998 senders = :
8999 .endd
9000 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9001 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9002 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9003 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9004
9005 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9006 example:
9007 .code
9008 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9009 .endd
9010 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9011 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9012 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9013 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9014 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9015 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9016 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9017 .code
9018 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9019 *@+hostile_domains:\
9020 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9021 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9022 .endd
9023 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9024 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9025 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9026 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9027 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9028
9029 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9030 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9031 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9032 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9033 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9034 .code
9035 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9036 .endd
9037
9038 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9039 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9040 senders:
9041
9042 .ilist
9043 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9044 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9045 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9046 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9047 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9048 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9049 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9050 .code
9051 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9052 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9053 .endd
9054 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9055 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9056
9057 .next
9058 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9059 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9060 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9061 example:
9062 .code
9063 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9064 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9065 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9066 .endd
9067 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9068 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9069 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9070 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9071
9072 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9073 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9074 panic log.
9075 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9076 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9077 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9078 default. For example, with this lookup:
9079 .code
9080 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9081 .endd
9082 the file could contains lines like this:
9083 .code
9084 user1@domain1.example
9085 *@domain2.example
9086 .endd
9087 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9088 that are tried is:
9089 .code
9090 nimrod@jaeger.example
9091 *@jaeger.example
9092 *
9093 .endd
9094 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9095 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9096
9097 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9098 .code
9099 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9100 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9101 .endd
9102 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9103 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9104 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9105 .endlist
9106
9107
9108 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9109 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9110 always fails.
9111
9112
9113 .ilist
9114 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9115 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9116 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9117 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9118 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9119 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9120 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9121 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9122 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9123
9124 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9125 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9126 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9127 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9128 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9129 with
9130 .code
9131 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9132 .endd
9133 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9134 .code
9135 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9136 .endd
9137 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9138
9139 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9140 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9141 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9142 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9143 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9144 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9145 .code
9146 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9147 spammer3 : spammer4
9148 .endd
9149 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9150 doubling.
9151
9152 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9153 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9154 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9155 might have entries like
9156 .code
9157 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9158 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9159 *: ^\d{8}$
9160 .endd
9161 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9162 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9163 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9164 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9165
9166 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9167 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9168 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9169
9170 .next
9171 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9172 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9173 can only return a single list of local parts.
9174 .endlist
9175
9176 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9177 in these two examples:
9178 .code
9179 senders = +my_list
9180 senders = *@+my_list
9181 .endd
9182 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9183 example it is a named domain list.
9184
9185
9186
9187
9188 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9189 .cindex "case of local parts"
9190 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9191 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9192 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9193 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9194 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9195 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9196 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9197 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9198 default.
9199
9200 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9201 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9202 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9203 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9204 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9205 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9206 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9207 case-independent.
9208
9209 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9210 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9211 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9212 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9213 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9214 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9215 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9216 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9217
9218
9219
9220 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9221 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9222 .cindex "local part" "list"
9223 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9224 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9225 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9226 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9227 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9228 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9229 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9230 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9231
9232 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9233 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9234 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9235 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9236 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9237 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9238 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9239 types.
9240 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9241
9242
9243
9244
9245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9247
9248 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9249 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9250 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9251 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9252
9253 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9254 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9255 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9256 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9257 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9258 escape character, as described in the following section.
9259
9260 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9261 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9262 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9263 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9264 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9265 reasons,
9266 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9267 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9268 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9269 is not permitted.
9270
9271
9272
9273 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9274 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9275 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9276 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9277 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9278 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9279 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9280 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9281
9282 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9283 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9284 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9285 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9286 .code
9287 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9288 .endd
9289 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9290 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9291 string.
9292
9293
9294
9295 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9296 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9297 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9298 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9299 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9300 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9301 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9302 encoding.
9303
9304 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9305 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9306 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9307
9308
9309 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9310 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9311 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9312 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9313 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9314 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9315 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9316 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9317 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9318 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9319 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9320 and &%nhash%&.
9321
9322 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9323 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9324 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9325
9326 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9327 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9328 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9329 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9330 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9331 .code
9332 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9333 .endd
9334 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9335 Exim message identifier. For example:
9336 .code
9337 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9338 .endd
9339 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9340 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9341
9342
9343 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9344 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9345 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9346 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9347 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9348 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9349 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9350 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9351 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9352 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9353 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9354 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9355 being expanded.
9356
9357
9358
9359
9360 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9361 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9362 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9363 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9364 white space is significant.
9365
9366 .vlist
9367 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9368 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9369 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9370 .code
9371 $local_part
9372 ${domain}
9373 .endd
9374 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9375 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9376 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9377 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9378 given, the expansion fails.
9379
9380 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9381 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9382 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9383 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9384 .code
9385 ${lc:$local_part}
9386 .endd
9387 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9388 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9389 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9390 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9391 string easier to understand.
9392
9393 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9394 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9395 expansion item below.
9396
9397
9398 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9399 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9400 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9401 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9402 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9403 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9404 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9405 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9406 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9407 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9408 the result of the expansion.
9409 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9410 the expansion result is an empty string.
9411 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9412
9413
9414 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9415 .cindex authentication "results header"
9416 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9417 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9418 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9419 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9420 header line.
9421 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9422 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9423 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9424 .code
9425 none
9426 iprev
9427 auth
9428 spf
9429 dkim
9430 .endd
9431
9432 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9433 .code
9434 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9435 .endd
9436 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9437
9438
9439 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9440 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9441 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9442 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9443 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9444 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9445 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9446 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9447 .display
9448 &`version `&
9449 &`serial_number `&
9450 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9451 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9452 &`notbefore `& time
9453 &`notafter `& time
9454 &`sig_algorithm `&
9455 &`signature `&
9456 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9457 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9458 &`crl_uri `& list
9459 .endd
9460 If the field is found,
9461 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9462 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9463 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9464 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9465
9466 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9467 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9468 extracted is used.
9469
9470 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9471
9472 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9473 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9474 not quite
9475 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9476 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9477 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9478 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9479 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9480 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9481 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9482 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9483
9484 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9485 take an optional modifier of "int"
9486 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9487 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9488 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9489
9490 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9491 newline-separated by default,
9492 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9493 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9494 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9495
9496 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9497 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9498 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9499 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9500 if so the element tags are omitted.
9501
9502 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9503
9504 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9505 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9506 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9507 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9508 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9509 .code
9510 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9511 .endd
9512 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9513 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9514 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9515
9516 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9517
9518 When compiling
9519 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9520 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9521 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9522 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9523 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9524 must have the following type:
9525 .code
9526 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9527 .endd
9528 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9529 function should return one of the following values:
9530
9531 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9532 into the expanded string that is being built.
9533
9534 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9535 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9536
9537 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9538 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9539
9540 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9541
9542 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9543 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9544 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9545
9546
9547 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9548 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9549 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9550 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9551 removed.
9552 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9553 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9554 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9555
9556 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9557 appear, for example:
9558 .code
9559 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9560 .endd
9561 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9562 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9563
9564 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9565 search failure.
9566 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9567 search success.
9568
9569 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9570 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9571
9572
9573 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9574 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9575 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9576 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9577 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9578 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9579 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9580 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9581 .display
9582 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9583 .endd
9584 .vindex "&$value$&"
9585 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9586 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9587 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9588 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9589 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9590 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9591 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9592 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9593 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9594
9595 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9596 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9597 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9598 yield &"2001"&:
9599 .code
9600 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9601 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9602 .endd
9603 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9604 appear, for example:
9605 .code
9606 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9607 .endd
9608 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9609 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9610
9611 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9612 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9613 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9614 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9615 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9616 .cindex JSON expansions
9617 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9618 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9619 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9620 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9621 .display
9622 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9623 .endd
9624 .vindex "&$value$&"
9625 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9626 the spaces are optional.
9627 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9628 For the &"json"& variant,
9629 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9630 trailing quotes.
9631 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9632 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9633 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9634
9635 The results of matching are handled as above.
9636
9637
9638 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9639 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9640 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9641 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9642 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9643 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9644 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9645 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9646 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9647 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9648 <&'string3'&> as before.
9649
9650 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9651 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9652 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9653 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9654 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9655 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9656 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9657 provided. For example:
9658 .code
9659 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9660 .endd
9661 yields &"42"&, and
9662 .code
9663 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9664 .endd
9665 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9666 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9667
9668
9669 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9670 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9671 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9672 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9673 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9674 .cindex JSON expansions
9675 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9676 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9677
9678 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9679 there is no choice of field separator.
9680 For the &"json"& variant,
9681 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9682 trailing quotes.
9683 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9684 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9685
9686
9687 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9688 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9689 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9690 .vindex "&$item$&"
9691 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9692 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9693 For each item
9694 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9695 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9696 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9697 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9698 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9699 .code
9700 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9701 .endd
9702 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9703 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9704
9705
9706 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9707 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9708 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9709 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9710 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9711 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9712
9713 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9714 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9715 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9716 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9717 .code
9718 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9719 .endd
9720 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9721 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9722 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9723 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9724 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9725 .code
9726 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9727 .endd
9728 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9729 letters appear. For example:
9730 .display
9731 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9732 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9733 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9734 .endd
9735
9736 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9737 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9738 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9739 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9740 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9741 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9742 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9743 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9744 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9745 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9746 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9747 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9748 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9749 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9750 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9751 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9752 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9753 .code
9754 $header_reply-to:
9755 .endd
9756 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9757 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9758 lines) may be present.
9759
9760 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9761 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9762
9763 .ilist
9764 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9765 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9766 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9767
9768 .next
9769 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9770 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9771 are multiple headers with a given name.
9772 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9773 list-processing facilities can be used.
9774 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9775 the content is &"raw"&.
9776
9777 .next
9778 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9779 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9780 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9781 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9782 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9783 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9784 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9785 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9786
9787 .next
9788 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9789 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9790 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9791 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9792 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9793 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9794 .endlist ilist
9795
9796 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9797 command of the following form:
9798 .code
9799 headers charset "UTF-8"
9800 .endd
9801 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9802 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9803 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9804 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9805 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9806 ISO-8859-1.
9807
9808 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9809 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9810 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9811 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9812
9813 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9814 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9815 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9816 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9817 router or transport are not accessible.
9818
9819 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9820 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9821 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9822 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9823 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9824 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9825 point they are added.
9826 When any of the above ACLs ar
9827 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9828
9829 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9830 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9831 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9832 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9833 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9834 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9835 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9836 header.)
9837
9838 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9839 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9840 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9841 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9842 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9843 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9844 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9845 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9846
9847 .new
9848 .cindex "tainted data"
9849 When the headers are from an incoming message,
9850 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
9851 .wen
9852
9853
9854 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9855 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9856 .cindex &%hmac%&
9857 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9858 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9859 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9860 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9861 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9862 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9863 present. For example:
9864 .code
9865 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9866 .endd
9867 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9868 produces:
9869 .code
9870 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9871 .endd
9872 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9873 an Exim configuration:
9874 .code
9875 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9876 .endd
9877 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9878 .code
9879 headers_add = \
9880 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9881 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9882 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9883 .endd
9884 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9885 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9886 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9887 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9888 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9889 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9890
9891
9892 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9893 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9894 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9895 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9896 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9897 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9898 .code
9899 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9900 .endd
9901 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9902 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9903 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9904 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9905 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9906
9907 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9908 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9909 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9910 .code
9911 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9912 .endd
9913 you can use
9914 .code
9915 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9916 .endd
9917
9918
9919
9920 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9921 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9922 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9923 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9924 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9925 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9926
9927
9928
9929 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9930 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9931 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9932 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9933 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9934 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9935 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9936 some of the braces:
9937 .code
9938 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9939 .endd
9940 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9941 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9942 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9943 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9944
9945
9946 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9947 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9948 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9949 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9950 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9951 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9952 apart from an optional leading minus,
9953 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9954
9955 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9956 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9957
9958 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9959 If the number is negative, the fields are
9960 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9961 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9962 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9963
9964 If the modulus of the
9965 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9966 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9967
9968 For example:
9969 .code
9970 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9971 .endd
9972 yields &"42"&, and
9973 .code
9974 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9975 .endd
9976 yields &"result: 42"&.
9977
9978 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9979 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9980 extracted is used.
9981 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9982
9983
9984 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9985 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9986 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9987 described in the next item.
9988
9989 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9990 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9991 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9992 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9993 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9994 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9995 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9996 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9997 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9998
9999 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10000 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10001 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10002 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10003 out by the system administrator.
10004
10005 .vindex "&$value$&"
10006 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10007 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10008 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10009 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10010 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10011 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10012 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10013 original lookup fails.
10014
10015 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10016 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10017 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10018 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10019 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10020 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10021 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10022 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10023
10024 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10025 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10026 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10027 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10028
10029 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10030 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10031 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10032 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10033
10034 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10035 .code
10036 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10037 .endd
10038 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10039 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10040 .code
10041 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10042 {$value}fail}
10043 .endd
10044
10045
10046 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10047 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10048 .vindex "&$item$&"
10049 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10050 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10051 For each item
10052 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10053 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10054 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10055 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10056 .code
10057 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10058 .endd
10059 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10060 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10061 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10062
10063 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10064 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10065 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10066 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10067 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10068 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10069 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10070 .code
10071 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10072 .endd
10073 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10074 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10075 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10076 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10077 example,
10078 .code
10079 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10080 .endd
10081 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10082
10083
10084
10085 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10086 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10087 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10088 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10089 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10090 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10091 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10092 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10093
10094 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10095 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10096 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10097 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10098 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10099 not its contents.
10100
10101 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10102 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10103 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10104
10105 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10106 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10107
10108
10109 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10110 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10111 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10112 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10113 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10114 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10115 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10116 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10117
10118 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10119 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10120 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10121 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10122 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10123 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10124 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10125 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10126 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10127 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10128
10129 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10130 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10131 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10132 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10133
10134 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10135 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10136 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10137 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10138 is the expansion of the third argument.
10139
10140 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10141 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10142 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10143
10144 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10145 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10146 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10147 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10148 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10149 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10150 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10151 newlines are left in the string.
10152 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10153 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10154 the string expansion fails.
10155
10156 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10157 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10158
10159
10160
10161 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10162 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10163 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10164 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10165 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10166 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10167 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10168 examples:
10169 .code
10170 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10171 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10172 .endd
10173 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10174 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10175 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10176 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10177 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10178 example:
10179 .code
10180 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10181 .endd
10182 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10183 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10184 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10185 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10186 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10187 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10188 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10189 .code
10190 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10191 .endd
10192
10193 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10194 and must be present if the argument is given.
10195 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10196 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10197 The first defines whether (the default)
10198 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10199 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10200 .code
10201 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10202 .endd
10203 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10204 .code
10205 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10206 .endd
10207 The default is to not use TLS.
10208 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10209
10210 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10211 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10212 turns them into spaces:
10213 .code
10214 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10215 .endd
10216 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10217 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10218 addition, the following errors can occur:
10219
10220 .ilist
10221 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10222 .next
10223 Failure to connect the socket;
10224 .next
10225 Failure to write the request string;
10226 .next
10227 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10228 .endlist
10229
10230 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10231 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10232 errors occurs. For example:
10233 .code
10234 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10235 {socket failure}}
10236 .endd
10237 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10238 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10239 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10240 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10241 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10242
10243 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10244 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10245
10246
10247 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10248 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10249 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10250 .vindex "&$value$&"
10251 .vindex "&$item$&"
10252 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10253 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10254 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10255 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10256 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10257 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10258 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10259 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10260 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10261 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10262 .code
10263 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10264 .endd
10265 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10266 can be found:
10267 .code
10268 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10269 .endd
10270 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10271 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10272 expansion items.
10273
10274 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10275 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10276 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10277
10278 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10279 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10280 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10281 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10282 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10283 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10284 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10285 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10286 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10287
10288 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10289 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10290 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10291 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10292 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10293 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10294 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10295 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10296 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10297 character.
10298
10299 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10300 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10301 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10302 .vindex "&$value$&"
10303 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10304 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10305 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10306 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10307 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10308 &$value$&.
10309
10310 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10311 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10312 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10313 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10314
10315 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10316 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10317 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10318 troubleshoot:
10319 .code
10320 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10321 log_message = Output of id: $value
10322 .endd
10323 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10324 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10325 .code
10326 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10327 .endd
10328
10329 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10330 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10331 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10332 .code
10333 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10334 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10335 ...
10336 endif
10337 .endd
10338 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10339 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10340 commands.
10341
10342 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10343 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10344 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10345 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10346
10347 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10348 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10349
10350
10351 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10352 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10353 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10354 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10355 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10356 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10357 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10358 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10359 .code
10360 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10361 .endd
10362 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10363 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10364 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10365 .code
10366 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10367 .endd
10368 yields &"defabc"&, and
10369 .code
10370 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10371 .endd
10372 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10373 the regular expression from string expansion.
10374
10375 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10376 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10377
10378
10379 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10380 .cindex sorting "a list"
10381 .cindex list sorting
10382 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10383 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10384 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10385 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10386 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10387 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10388 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10389 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10390 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10391 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10392 to give values for comparison.
10393
10394 The item result is a sorted list,
10395 with the original list separator,
10396 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10397
10398 Examples:
10399 .code
10400 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10401 .endd
10402 sorts a list of numbers, and
10403 .code
10404 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10405 .endd
10406 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10407
10408
10409 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10410 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10411 .cindex "substring extraction"
10412 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10413 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10414 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10415 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10416 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10417 .code
10418 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10419 .endd
10420 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10421 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10422 omitted.
10423
10424 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10425 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10426 length required. For example
10427 .code
10428 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10429 .endd
10430 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10431 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10432 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10433 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10434
10435 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10436 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10437 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10438 .code
10439 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10440 .endd
10441 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10442 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10443 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10444 .code
10445 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10446 .endd
10447 yields an empty string, but
10448 .code
10449 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10450 .endd
10451 yields &"1"&.
10452
10453 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10454 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10455 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10456 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10457 .code
10458 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10459 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10460 .endd
10461 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10462
10463 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10464
10465
10466
10467 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10468 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10469 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10470 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10471 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10472 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10473 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10474 replacement list. For example
10475 .code
10476 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10477 .endd
10478 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10479 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10480 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10481 place.
10482
10483 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10484
10485 .endlist
10486
10487
10488
10489 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10490 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10491 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10492 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10493 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10494 following operations can be performed:
10495
10496 .vlist
10497 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10498 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10499 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10500 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10501 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10502 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10503
10504 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10505
10506
10507 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10508 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10509 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10510 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10511 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10512 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10513 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10514 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10515 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10516
10517 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10518 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10519 character. For example:
10520 .code
10521 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10522 .endd
10523 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10524 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10525 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10526 separator explicitly:
10527 .code
10528 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10529 .endd
10530
10531 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10532 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10533 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10534 processing lists.
10535
10536 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10537 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10538 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10539 email address separator. For the example header line:
10540 .code
10541 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10542 .endd
10543 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10544 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10545 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10546 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10547 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10548 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10549 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10550 .code
10551 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10552 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10553 user@example.com
10554 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10555 Last:user@example.com
10556 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10557 user@example.com
10558 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10559 フィリップ@example.jp
10560 .endd
10561
10562 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10563 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10564 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10565 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10566 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10567 Only lowercase letters are used.
10568
10569 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10570 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10571 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10572 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10573 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10574
10575 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10576 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10577 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10578 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10579 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10580 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10581 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10582 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10583 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10584
10585 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10586 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10587 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10588 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10589 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10590 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10591 string.
10592
10593 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10594 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10595 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10596 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10597 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10598 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10599
10600 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10601 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10602
10603
10604 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10605 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10606 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10607 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10608 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10609
10610
10611 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10612 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10613 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10614 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10615 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10616
10617
10618 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10619 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10620 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10621 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10622 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10623 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10624 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10625
10626 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10627 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10628 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10629 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10630 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10631 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10632
10633
10634 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10635 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10636 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10637 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10638 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10639 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10640 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10641 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10642 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10643 C programming language):
10644 .table2 70pt 300pt
10645 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10646 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10647 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10648 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10649 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10650 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10651 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10652 .endtable
10653 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10654 space is permitted before or after operators.
10655
10656 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10657 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10658 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10659 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10660 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10661
10662 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10663 or 1024*1024*1024,
10664 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10665 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10666
10667 .display
10668 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10669 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10670 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10671 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10672 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10673 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10674 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10675 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10676 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10677 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10678 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10679 .endd
10680
10681 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10682 .code
10683 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10684 condition = \
10685 ${if and { \
10686 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10687 { \
10688 < \
10689 {$recipients_count} \
10690 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10691 } \
10692 }{yes}{no}}
10693 .endd
10694 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10695 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10696
10697
10698 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10699 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10700 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10701 example,
10702 .code
10703 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10704 .endd
10705 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10706 and then re-expands what it has found.
10707
10708
10709 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10710 .cindex "Unicode"
10711 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10712 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10713 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10714 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10715 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10716 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10717 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10718 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10719 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10720
10721 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10722 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10723 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10724 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10725 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10726 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10727 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10728
10729
10730 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10731 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10732 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10733 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10734 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10735 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10736 .code
10737 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10738 .endd
10739 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10740 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10741
10742
10743
10744 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10745 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10746 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10747 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10748 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10749 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10750
10751
10752
10753 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10754 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10755 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10756 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10757 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10758 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10759 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10760
10761
10762 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10763 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10764 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10765 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10766 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10767 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10768 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10769
10770 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10771 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10772 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10773 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10774 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10775 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10776 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10777 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10778 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10779
10780
10781 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10782 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10783 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10784 .cindex "lower casing"
10785 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10786 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10787 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10788 .code
10789 ${lc:$local_part}
10790 .endd
10791 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10792
10793 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10794 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10795 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10796 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10797 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10798 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10799 .code
10800 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10801 .endd
10802 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10803 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10804 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10805 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10806
10807
10808 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10809 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10810 .cindex "list" "item count"
10811 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10812 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10813 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10814
10815
10816 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10817 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10818 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10819 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10820 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10821 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10822 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10823 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10824 matching list is returned.
10825
10826
10827 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10828 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10829 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10830 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10831 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10832 empty.
10833 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10834
10835
10836 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10837 .cindex "masked IP address"
10838 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10839 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10840 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10841 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10842 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10843 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10844 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10845 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10846 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10847 .code
10848 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10849 .endd
10850 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10851 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10852 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10853 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10854 .code
10855 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10856 .endd
10857 returns the string
10858 .code
10859 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10860 .endd
10861 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10862
10863
10864 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10865 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10866 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10867 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10868 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10869 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10870 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10871
10872 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10873 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10874
10875
10876 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10878 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10879 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10880 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10881 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10882 .code
10883 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10884 .endd
10885 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10886
10887
10888 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10889 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10890 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10891 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10892 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10893 is an empty string or
10894 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10895 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10896 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10897 respectively For example,
10898 .code
10899 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10900 .endd
10901 becomes
10902 .code
10903 "ab\"*\"cd"
10904 .endd
10905 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10906 variable or a message header.
10907
10908 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10909 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10910 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10911 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10912 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10913 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10914 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10915
10916 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10917 will likely use the quoting form.
10918 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10919
10920
10921 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10922 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10923 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10924 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10925 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10926 .code
10927 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10928 .endd
10929 returns
10930 .code
10931 two%20%5C2A%20two
10932 .endd
10933 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10934 yields an unchanged string.
10935
10936
10937 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10938 .cindex "random number"
10939 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10940 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10941 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10942 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10943 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10944 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10945 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10946 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10947 random().
10948
10949
10950 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10951 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10952 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10953 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10954 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10955 for DNS. For example,
10956 .code
10957 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10958 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10959 .endd
10960 returns
10961 .code
10962 4.2.0.192
10963 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10964 .endd
10965
10966
10967 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10968 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10969 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10970 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10971 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10972 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10973 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10974 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10975 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10976 characters
10977 .code
10978 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10979 .endd
10980 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10981 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10982 characters.
10983
10984
10985 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10986 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10987 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10988 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10989 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10990 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10991 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10992 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10993
10994 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10995 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10996 to use this operator as well.
10997
10998
10999
11000 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11001 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11002 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11003 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11004 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11005 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11006 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11007
11008
11009 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11010 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11011 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11012 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11013 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11014 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11015 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11016
11017 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11018 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11019
11020
11021 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11022 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11023 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11024 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11025 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11026 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11027 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11028 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11029 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11030 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11031 and returns
11032 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11033
11034 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11035 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11036
11037 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11038 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11039 Finally, if an underbar
11040 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11041 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11042 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11043
11044
11045 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11046 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11047 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11048 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11049 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11050 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11051 and returns
11052 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11053
11054 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11055 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11056 with 256 being the default.
11057
11058 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11059 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11060 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11061 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11062
11063
11064 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11065 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11066 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11067 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11068 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11069 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11070 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11071 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11072 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11073 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11074 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11075 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11076 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11077
11078 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11079 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11080 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11081
11082 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11084 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11085
11086
11087
11088 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11089 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11090 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11091 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11092 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11093 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11094 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11095
11096
11097 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11098 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11099 .cindex "substring extraction"
11100 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11101 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11102 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11103 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11104 .code
11105 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11106 .endd
11107 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11108 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11109 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11110
11111 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11112 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11113 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11114 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11115 seconds.
11116
11117 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11118 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11119 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11120 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11121 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11122 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11123 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11124
11125 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11126 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11127 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11128 .cindex "upper casing"
11129 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11130 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11131 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11132 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11133
11134 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11135 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11136 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11137 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11138 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11139 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11140 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11141 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11142 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11143 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11144 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11145 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11146 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11147 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11148 .code
11149 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11150 .endd
11151 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11152 literal question mark).
11153
11154 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11155 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11156 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11157 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11158 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11159 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11160 .cindex EAI
11161 .cindex internationalisation
11162 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11163 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11164 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11165 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11166 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11167 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11168 .endlist
11169
11170
11171
11172
11173
11174
11175 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11176 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11177 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11178 while expanding strings:
11179
11180 .vlist
11181 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11182 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11183 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11184 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11185 condition.
11186
11187 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11188 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11189 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11190 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11191 are:
11192 .display
11193 &`= `& equal
11194 &`== `& equal
11195 &`> `& greater
11196 &`>= `& greater or equal
11197 &`< `& less
11198 &`<= `& less or equal
11199 .endd
11200 For example:
11201 .code
11202 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11203 .endd
11204 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11205 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11206 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11207 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11208 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11209 zero.
11210
11211 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11212 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11213 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11214
11215
11216 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11217 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11218 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11219 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11220 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11221 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11222 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11223 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11224 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11225 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11226 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11227 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11228 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11229 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11230
11231 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11232 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11233 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11234 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11235 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11236 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11237 false if zero.
11238 An empty string is treated as false.
11239 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11240 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11241 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11242
11243 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11244 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11245 For example:
11246 .code
11247 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11248 .endd
11249
11250
11251 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11252 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11253 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11254 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11255 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11256 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11257 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11258 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11259
11260 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11261
11262 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11263 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11264 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11265 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11266 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11267 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11268 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11269 included in the binary.
11270
11271 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11272 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11273 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11274 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11275 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11276 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11277 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11278 string in LDAP form is:
11279 .code
11280 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11281 .endd
11282 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11283 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11284 .code
11285 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11286 .endd
11287 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11288 supported:
11289
11290 .ilist
11291 .cindex "MD5 hash"
11292 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11293 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11294 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11295 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11296 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11297 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11298 comparison fails.
11299
11300 .next
11301 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11302 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11303 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11304 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11305 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11306 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11307
11308 .next
11309 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11310 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11311 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11312 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11313 whatever its length.
11314
11315 .next
11316 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11317 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11318 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11319 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11320 .endlist
11321 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11322 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11323 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11324 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11325 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11326 support &[crypt16()]&.
11327
11328 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11329 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11330 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11331 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11332 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11333
11334 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11335 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11336 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11337
11338 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11339 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11340 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11341 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11342 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11343
11344 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11345 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11346 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11347 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11348 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11349 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11350 .code
11351 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11352 .endd
11353 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11354 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11355
11356 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11357 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11358 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11359 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11360 exists in the message. For example,
11361 .code
11362 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11363 .endd
11364 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11365 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11366
11367 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11368 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11369 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11370 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11371 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11372 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11373 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11374 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11375 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11376 case is defined per the system C locale.
11377
11378 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11379 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11380 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11381 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11382 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11383 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11384 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11385 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11386
11387 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11388 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11389 .cindex "first delivery"
11390 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11391 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11392 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11393 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11394
11395
11396 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11397 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11398 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11399 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11400 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11401 .vindex "&$item$&"
11402 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11403 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11404 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11405 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11406 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11407 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11408 .ilist
11409 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11410 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11411 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11412 .next
11413 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11414 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11415 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11416 .endlist
11417 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11418 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11419 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11420 list separator is changed to a comma:
11421 .code
11422 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11423 .endd
11424 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11425 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11426
11427 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11428
11429 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11430 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11431 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11432 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11433 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11434 .cindex JSON expansions
11435 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11436 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11437 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11438 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11439 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11440 be a JSON array.
11441 The array separator is not changeable.
11442 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11443 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11444
11445
11446
11447 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11448 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11449 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11450 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11451 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11452 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11453 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11454 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11455 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11456 case-independent.
11457 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11458
11459 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11460 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11461 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11462 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11463 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11464 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11465 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11466 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11467 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11468 case-independent.
11469 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11470
11471 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11472 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11473 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11474 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11475 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11476 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11477 is true.
11478 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11479
11480 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11481 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11482 .code
11483 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11484 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11485 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11486 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11487 .endd
11488
11489 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11490 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11491 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11492 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11493 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11494 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11495 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11496 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11497 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11498 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11499 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11500
11501 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11502 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11503 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11504 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11505 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11506
11507 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11508 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11509 check.
11510 This is no longer the case.
11511
11512 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11513 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11514 .code
11515 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11516 .endd
11517 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11518
11519 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11520 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11521 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11522 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11523 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11524 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11525 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11526 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11527 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11528 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11529 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11530 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11531 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11532 this can be used.
11533
11534
11535 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11536 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11537 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11538 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11539 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11540 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11541 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11542 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11543 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11544 case-independent.
11545 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11546
11547 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11548 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11549 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11550 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11551 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11552 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11553 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11554 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11555 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11556 case-independent.
11557 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11558
11559
11560 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11561 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11562 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11563 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11564 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11565 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11566 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11567 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11568 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11569 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11570 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11571 For example,
11572 .code
11573 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11574 .endd
11575 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11576 backslashes is also required.
11577
11578 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11579 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11580 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11581 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11582 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11583 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11584 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11585 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11586
11587 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11588 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11589 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11590 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11591 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11592 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11593 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11594 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11595
11596 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11597 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11598 See &*match_local_part*&.
11599
11600 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11601 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11602 See &*match_local_part*&.
11603
11604 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11605 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11606 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11607 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11608 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11609 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11610 .code
11611 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11612 .endd
11613 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11614
11615 .ilist
11616 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11617 .next
11618 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11619 .next
11620 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11621 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11622 in a single test such as
11623 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11624 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11625 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11626 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11627 .code
11628 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11629 .endd
11630 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11631 .next
11632 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11633 .next
11634 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11635 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11636 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11637 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11638 masks. For example:
11639 .code
11640 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11641 .endd
11642 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11643 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11644 address mask, for example:
11645 .code
11646 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11647 .endd
11648 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11649 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11650 .code
11651 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11652 .endd
11653 .endlist ilist
11654
11655 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11656 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11657
11658 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11659
11660 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11661 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11662 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11663 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11664 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11665 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11666 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11667 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11668 example is:
11669 .code
11670 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11671 .endd
11672 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11673 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11674 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11675 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11676 .code
11677 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11678 .endd
11679 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11680 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11681 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11682 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11683 caselessly.
11684
11685 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11686 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11687
11688 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11689 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11690 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11691 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11692
11693 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11694 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11695 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11696 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11697 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11698 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11699 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11700 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11701 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11702 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11703 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11704 .code
11705 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11706 .endd
11707 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11708 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11709
11710 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11711 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11712 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11713 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11714 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11715 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11716 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11717
11718 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11719 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11720 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11721 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11722 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11723 .code
11724 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11725 .endd
11726 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11727 .code
11728 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11729 .endd
11730 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11731 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11732 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11733 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11734
11735
11736 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11737 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11738 .cindex "Cyrus"
11739 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11740 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11741 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11742 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11743 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11744 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11745
11746 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11747 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11748 building Exim. For example:
11749 .code
11750 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11751 .endd
11752 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11753 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11754 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11755 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11756
11757 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11758 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11759 configuration, you might have this:
11760 .code
11761 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11762 .endd
11763 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11764 .code
11765 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11766 .endd
11767 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11768 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11769 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11770 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11771 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11772 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11773
11774
11775 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11776 .cindex "Radius"
11777 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11778 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11779 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11780 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11781 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11782 support.
11783
11784 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11785 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11786 this library, you need to set
11787 .code
11788 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11789 .endd
11790 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11791 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11792 .code
11793 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11794 .endd
11795 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11796 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11797 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11798
11799 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11800 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11801 the authentication is successful. For example:
11802 .code
11803 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11804 .endd
11805
11806
11807 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11808 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11809 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11810 .cindex "Cyrus"
11811 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11812 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11813 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11814 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11815 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11816 by a process that is not running as root.
11817
11818 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11819 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11820 building Exim. For example:
11821 .code
11822 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11823 .endd
11824 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11825 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11826 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11827
11828 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11829 two are mandatory. For example:
11830 .code
11831 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11832 .endd
11833 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11834 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11835 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11836 .endlist vlist
11837
11838
11839
11840 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11841 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11842 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11843 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11844 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11845 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11846 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11847
11848
11849 .vlist
11850 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11851 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11852 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11853 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11854 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11855 For example,
11856 .code
11857 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11858 .endd
11859 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11860 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11861 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11862
11863 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11864 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11865 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11866 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11867 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11868 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11869 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11870 parsed but not evaluated.
11871 .endlist
11872 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11873
11874
11875
11876
11877 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11878 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11879 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11880 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11881 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11882
11883 .vlist
11884 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11885 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11886 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11887 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11888 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11889 In the expansion condition case
11890 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11891 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11892 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11893 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11894 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11895 matching condition.
11896
11897 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11898 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11899 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11900 any unused variables being made empty.
11901
11902 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11903 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11904 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11905 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11906 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11907 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11908 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11909 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11910 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11911 during subsequent delivery.
11912
11913 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11914 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11915 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11916 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11917 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11918 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11919 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11920 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11921 delivery.
11922
11923 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11924 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11925 this variable has the number of arguments.
11926
11927 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11928 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11929 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11930 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11931 be preserved by coding like this:
11932 .code
11933 warn !verify = sender
11934 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11935 .endd
11936 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11937 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11938 failure.
11939
11940 .vitem &$address_data$&
11941 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11942 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11943 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11944 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11945 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11946 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11947 user filter files.
11948
11949 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11950 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11951 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11952 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11953 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11954 from the child's routing.
11955
11956 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11957 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11958 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11959 address.
11960
11961 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11962 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11963 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11964
11965 .vitem &$address_file$&
11966 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11967 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11968 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11969 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11970 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11971 .code
11972 /home/r2d2/savemail
11973 .endd
11974 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11975 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11976 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11977 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11978 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11979 to the relevant file.
11980
11981 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11982 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11983 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11984 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11985
11986 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11987 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11988 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11989 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11990
11991 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11992 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11993 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11994 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11995 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11996 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11997 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11998 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11999 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12000
12001 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12002 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12003 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12004 command line option.
12005 This second case also sets up information used by the
12006 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12007
12008 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12009 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12010 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12011 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12012 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12013 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12014 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12015 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12016 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12017 the ACL's as well.
12018
12019
12020 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12021 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12022 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12023 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12024 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12025 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12026 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12027 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12028 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12029 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12030 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12031
12032 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12033 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12034 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12035 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12036 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12037
12038
12039 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12040 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12041 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12042 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12043 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12044 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12045 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12046 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12047 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12048 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12049 an undefined mechanism.
12050
12051 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12052 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12053 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12054 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12055 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12056 the ACL malware condition.
12057
12058 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12059 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12060 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12061 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12062 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12063 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12064
12065 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12066 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12067 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12068 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12069 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12070 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12071 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12072
12073 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12074 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12075 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12076 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12077 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12078
12079 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12080 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12081 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12082 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12083 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12084
12085 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12086 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12087 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12088 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12089 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12090 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12091 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12092
12093 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12094 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12095 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12096 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12097 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12098 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12099 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12100
12101 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12102 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12103 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12104 address that was connected to.
12105
12106 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12107 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12108 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12109 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12110 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12111
12112 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12113 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12114 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12115 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12116 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12117 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12118
12119 .vitem &$config_file$&
12120 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12121 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12122
12123 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12124 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12125 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12126 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12127 Results of DMARC verification.
12128 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12129
12130 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12131 Results of DKIM verification.
12132 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12133
12134 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12135 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12136 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12137 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12138 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12139 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12140 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12141 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12142 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12143 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12144 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12145 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12146 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12147 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12148 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12149 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12150 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12151 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12152 &$dkim_key_length$&
12153 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12154 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12155
12156 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12157 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12158 When a message has been received this variable contains
12159 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12160 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12161
12162 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12163 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12164 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12165 &$dnslist_value$&
12166 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12167 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12168 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12169 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12170 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12171 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12172 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12173 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12174 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12175
12176 .vitem &$domain$&
12177 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12178 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12179 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12180 case for &$domain$&.
12181
12182 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12183 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12184 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12185 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12186
12187 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12188 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12189 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12190 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12191 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12192 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12193
12194 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12195 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12196 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12197
12198 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12199
12200 .ilist
12201 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12202 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12203 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12204 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12205 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12206 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12207 the &(smtp)& transport.
12208
12209 .next
12210 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12211 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12212 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12213 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12214
12215 .next
12216 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12217 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12218 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12219 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12220 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12221 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12222
12223 .next
12224 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12225 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12226 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12227 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12228 .endlist
12229
12230 .new
12231 .cindex "tainted data"
12232 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12233 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12234 See also &$domain_verified$&.
12235 .wen
12236
12237
12238 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12239 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12240 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12241 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12242 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12243 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12244 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12245 used.
12246
12247 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12248 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12249 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12250 to nothing.
12251
12252 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12253 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12254 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12255
12256 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12257 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12258 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12259
12260 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12261 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12262 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12263
12264 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12265 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12266 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12267 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12268 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12269 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12270 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12271
12272 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12273 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12274 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12275 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12276 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12277 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12278
12279 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12280 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12281 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12282 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12283 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12284
12285 .vitem &$home$&
12286 .vindex "&$home$&"
12287 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12288 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12289 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12290 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12291 by a setting on the transport itself.
12292
12293 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12294 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12295 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12296
12297 .vitem &$host$&
12298 .vindex "&$host$&"
12299 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12300 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12301 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12302 to local and remote transports.
12303
12304 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12305 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12306 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12307 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12308 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12309 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12310 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12311 is connected.
12312
12313 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12314 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12315 client is connected.
12316
12317
12318 .vitem &$host_address$&
12319 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12320 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12321 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12322 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12323
12324 .vitem &$host_data$&
12325 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12326 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12327 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12328 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12329 .code
12330 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12331 message = $host_data
12332 .endd
12333 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12334 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12335 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12336 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12337 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12338 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12339 variables is set to &"1"&.
12340
12341 .ilist
12342 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12343 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12344
12345 .next
12346 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12347 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12348 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12349 .endlist ilist
12350
12351 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12352 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12353 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12354 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12355 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12356 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12357 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12358 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12359 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12360 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12361
12362 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12363 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12364 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12365
12366
12367 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12368 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12369 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12370
12371 .vitem &$host_port$&
12372 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12373 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12374 for an outbound connection.
12375
12376 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12377 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12378 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12379 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12380 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12381 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12382
12383 .vitem &$inode$&
12384 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12385 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12386 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12387 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12388 a unique name for the file.
12389
12390 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12391 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12392 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12393
12394 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12395 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12396 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12397
12398 .vitem &$item$&
12399 .vindex "&$item$&"
12400 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12401 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12402 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12403 empty.
12404
12405 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12406 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12407 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12408 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12409 lookup.
12410
12411 .vitem &$load_average$&
12412 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12413 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12414 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12415 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12416
12417 .vitem &$local_part$&
12418 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12419 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12420 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12421 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12422 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12423
12424 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12425 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12426 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12427 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12428 once.
12429
12430 .new
12431 .cindex "tainted data"
12432 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12433 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12434
12435 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12436 attacker.
12437 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12438 for file access.
12439 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12440 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12441 &$local_part_verified$& variable rather than this one.
12442 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12443 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12444 rather than this variable.
12445 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12446 the retrieved data.
12447 .wen
12448
12449 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12450 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12451 .cindex affix variables
12452 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12453 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12454 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12455 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12456
12457 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12458 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12459 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12460 &$address_pipe$&).
12461
12462 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12463 local part of the recipient address.
12464
12465 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12466 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12467 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12468
12469 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12470 the addresses
12471 .code
12472 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12473 abc\:xyz@test.example
12474 .endd
12475 the value of &$local_part$& is
12476 .code
12477 abc:xyz
12478 .endd
12479 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12480 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12481 have:
12482 .code
12483 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12484 .endd
12485 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12486 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12487 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12488
12489 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12490 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12491 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12492 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12493 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12494 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12495 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12496
12497 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12498 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12499 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12500 variable expands to nothing.
12501
12502 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12503 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12504 .cindex affix variables
12505 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12506 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12507 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12508
12509 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12510 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12511 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12512 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12513 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12514
12515 .new
12516 .vitem &$local_part_verified$&
12517 .vindex "&$local_part_verified$&"
12518 If the router generic option &%check_local_part%& has run successfully,
12519 this variable has the user database version of &$local_part$&.
12520 Such values are not tainted and hence usable for building file names.
12521 .wen
12522
12523 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12524 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12525 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12526 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12527
12528 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12529 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12530 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12531
12532 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12533 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12534 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12535 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12536 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12537 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12538 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12539 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12540
12541 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12542 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12543 This contains the expanded value of the
12544 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12545 been read.
12546
12547 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12548 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12549 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12550 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12551 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12552 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12553
12554 .vitem &$log_space$&
12555 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12556 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12557 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12558 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12559 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12560 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12561
12562
12563 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12564 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12565 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12566 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12567 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12568 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12569 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12570 and &"yes"& if it was.
12571 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12572 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12573 as authenticated data.
12574
12575 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12576 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12577 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12578 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12579 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12580 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12581 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12582 variable is empty.
12583
12584 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12585 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12586 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12587 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12588 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12589
12590 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12591 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12592 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12593 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12594 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12595 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12596 character(s).
12597 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12598
12599 .vitem &$message_age$&
12600 .cindex "message" "age of"
12601 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12602 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12603 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12604 delivery attempt.
12605
12606 .vitem &$message_body$&
12607 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12608 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12609 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12610 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12611 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12612 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12613 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12614 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12615 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12616
12617 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12618 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12619 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12620 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12621 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12622
12623 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12624 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12625 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12626 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12627 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12628 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12629 &$message_body$&.
12630
12631 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12632 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12633 .cindex "message body" "size"
12634 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12635 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12636 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12637 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12638 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12639
12640 If the spool file is wireformat
12641 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12642 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12643
12644 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12645 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12646 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12647 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12648 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12649 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12650 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12651 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12652
12653 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12654 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12655 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12656 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12657 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12658 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12659
12660 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12661 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12662 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12663 contents of header lines is done.
12664
12665 .vitem &$message_id$&
12666 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12667
12668 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12669 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12670 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12671 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12672 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12673 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12674 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12675 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12676 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12677 from the body is not counted.
12678
12679 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12680 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12681 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12682 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12683 header and the body).
12684
12685 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12686 .code
12687 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12688 condition = \
12689 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12690 .endd
12691 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12692 message has not yet been received.
12693
12694 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12695
12696 .vitem &$message_size$&
12697 .cindex "size" "of message"
12698 .cindex "message" "size"
12699 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12700 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12701 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12702 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12703 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12704 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12705 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12706 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12707 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12708
12709 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12710 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12711 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12712 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12713
12714 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12715 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12716 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12717 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12718
12719 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12720 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12721 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12722
12723 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12724 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12725 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12726 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12727 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12728 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12729 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12730 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12731 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12732 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12733
12734 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12735 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12736 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12737
12738 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12739 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12740 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12741 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12742 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12743 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12744 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12745 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12746 the original address.
12747
12748 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12749 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12750 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12751 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12752 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12753
12754 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12755 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12756 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12757
12758 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12759 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12760 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12761 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12762 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12763 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12764 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12765 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12766 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12767
12768 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12769 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12770 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12771 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12772 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12773 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12774 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12775 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12776 user.
12777
12778 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12779 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12780 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12781 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12782
12783 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12784 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12785 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12786 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12787
12788 .vitem &$pid$&
12789 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12790 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12791 This variable contains the current process id.
12792
12793 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12794 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12795 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12796 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12797 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12798 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12799 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12800 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12801 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12802 variable"& error if encountered.
12803
12804 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12805 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12806 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12807 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12808 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12809 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12810 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12811
12812
12813 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12814 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12815 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12816 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12817 &$proxy_session$&
12818 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12819 or SOCKS5 support.
12820 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12821
12822 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12823 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12824 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12825 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12826
12827 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12828 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12829 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12830 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12831
12832 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12833 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12834 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12835 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12836
12837 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12838 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12839 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12840 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12841
12842 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12843 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12844 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12845
12846 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12847 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12848 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12849 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12850
12851 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12852 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12853 .cindex "named queues" variable
12854 .cindex queues named
12855 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12856
12857 .vitem &$r_...$&
12858 .vindex &$r_...$&
12859 .cindex router variables
12860 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12861 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12862 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12863 and the eventual transport.
12864
12865 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12866 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12867 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12868 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12869 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12870
12871 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12872 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12873 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12874 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12875 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12876 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12877
12878 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12879 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12880 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12881 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12882 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12883
12884 .vitem &$received_count$&
12885 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12886 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12887 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12888 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12889 delivering.
12890
12891 .vitem &$received_for$&
12892 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12893 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12894 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12895 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12896 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12897
12898 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12899 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12900 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12901 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12902 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12903 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12904 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12905 option.
12906
12907 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12908 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12909 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12910 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12911 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12912 time.
12913 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12914
12915 .vitem &$received_port$&
12916 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12917 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12918
12919 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12920 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12921 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12922 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12923 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12924 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12925 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12926 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12927 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12928
12929 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12930 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12931 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12932 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12933 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12934 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12935
12936 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12937 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12938 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12939
12940 .vitem &$received_time$&
12941 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12942 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12943 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12944
12945 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12946 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12947 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12948 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12949 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12950 .display
12951 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12952 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12953 .endd
12954 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12955 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12956 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12957 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12958
12959 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12960 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12961 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12962 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12963
12964 .ilist
12965 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12966 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12967
12968 .next
12969 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12970
12971 .next
12972 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12973 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12974 MAIL).
12975
12976 .next
12977 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12978 .next
12979
12980 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12981 .endlist
12982
12983 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12984 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12985
12986 .vitem &$recipients$&
12987 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12988 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12989 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12990 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12991 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12992 cases:
12993
12994 .olist
12995 In a system filter file.
12996 .next
12997 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12998 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12999 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13000 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13001 .next
13002 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13003 .endlist
13004
13005
13006 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13007 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13008 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13009 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13010 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13011 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13012
13013
13014 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13015 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13016 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13017 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13018
13019 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13020 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13021 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13022 these variables contain the
13023 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13024
13025
13026 .vitem &$reply_address$&
13027 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13028 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13029 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13030 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13031 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13032 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13033
13034 .vitem &$return_path$&
13035 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13036 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13037 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13038 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13039 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13040 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13041 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13042 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13043 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13044 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13045 envelope sender.
13046
13047 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13048 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13049 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13050
13051 .vitem &$router_name$&
13052 .cindex "router" "name"
13053 .cindex "name" "of router"
13054 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13055 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13056
13057 .vitem &$runrc$&
13058 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13059 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13060 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13061 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13062 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13063 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13064 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13065 another.
13066
13067 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13068 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13069 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13070 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13071 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13072 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13073 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13074 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13075
13076 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13077 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13078 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13079 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13080 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13081 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13082
13083 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13084 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13085 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13086 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13087 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13088 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13089 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13090 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13091
13092 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13093 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13094 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13095
13096 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13097 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13098 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13099
13100 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13101 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13102 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13103 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13104 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13105 this:
13106 .display
13107 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13108 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13109 .endd
13110 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13111 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13112 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13113 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13114
13115 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13116 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13117 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13118 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13119 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13120 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13121 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13122 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13123 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13124 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13125 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13126 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13127 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13128
13129 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13130 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13131 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13132 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13133 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13134
13135 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13136 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13137 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13138 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13139 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13140 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13141
13142 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13143 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13144 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13145 this variable contains that
13146 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13147
13148 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13149 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13150 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13151 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13152 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13153 &$authenticated_id$&.
13154
13155 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13156 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13157 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13158 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13159 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13160 resolver library states that both
13161 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13162 other times, this variable is false.
13163
13164 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13165 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13166 library, by setting:
13167 .code
13168 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13169 .endd
13170
13171 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13172 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13173
13174 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13175 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13176
13177 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13178 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13179 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13180 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13181
13182
13183 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13184 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13185 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13186 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13187 other means, this variable is empty.
13188
13189 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13190 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13191 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13192 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13193 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13194 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13195 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13196
13197 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13198 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13199 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13200 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13201
13202 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13203 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13204 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13205 is set to &"1"&.
13206
13207 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13208 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13209 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13210 following are true:
13211
13212 .ilist
13213 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13214 .next
13215 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13216 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13217 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13218 .next
13219 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13220 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13221 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13222 .next
13223 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13224 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13225 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13226 .next
13227 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13228 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13229 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13230 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13231 .code
13232 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13233 .endd
13234 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13235 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13236 .endlist
13237
13238
13239 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13240 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13241 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13242 number that was used on the remote host.
13243
13244 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13245 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13246 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13247 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13248 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13249 called Exim.
13250
13251 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13252 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13253 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13254 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13255
13256 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13257 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13258 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13259 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13260 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13261 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13262 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13263 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13264 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13265 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13266 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13267 the parentheses.
13268
13269 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13270 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13271 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13272 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13273 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13274
13275 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13276 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13277 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13278 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13279 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13280
13281 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13282 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13283 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13284 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13285 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13286 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13287 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13288
13289 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13290 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13291 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13292 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13293 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13294
13295 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13296 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13297 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13298 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13299 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13300 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13301
13302 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13303 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13304 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13305 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13306 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13307 .code
13308 MAIL FROM:<>
13309 MAIL FROM: <>
13310 .endd
13311 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13312 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13313 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13314 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13315
13316 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13317 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13318 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13319 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13320 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13321 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13322 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13323
13324 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13325 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13326 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13327 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13328 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13329 are remembered.
13330
13331 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13332 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13333 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13334 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13335 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13336 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13337 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13338 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13339 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13340 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13341 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13342
13343 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13344 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13345 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13346 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13347 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13348 message is junk mail.
13349
13350 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13351 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13352 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13353 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13354
13355 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13356 &$spf_received$& &&&
13357 &$spf_result$& &&&
13358 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13359 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13360 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13361 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13362
13363 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13364 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13365 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13366
13367 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13368 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13369 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13370 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13371 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13372 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13373
13374 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13375 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13376 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13377 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13378 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13379 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13380 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13381 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13382 .code
13383 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13384 .endd
13385 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13386
13387
13388 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13389 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13390 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13391 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13392 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13393 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13394
13395 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13396 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13397 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13398 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13399 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13400 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13401 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13402 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13403
13404 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13405 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13406 the outbound.
13407
13408 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13409 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13410 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13411 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13412 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13413 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13414
13415 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13416 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13417 .cindex certificate variables
13418 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13419 inbound connection when the message was received.
13420 It is only useful as the argument of a
13421 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13422 or a &%def%& condition.
13423
13424 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13425 when a list of more than one
13426 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13427 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13428
13429 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13430 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13431 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13432 inbound connection when the message was received.
13433 It is only useful as the argument of a
13434 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13435 or a &%def%& condition.
13436 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13437 which is not the leaf.
13438
13439 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13440 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13441 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13442 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13443 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13444 or a &%def%& condition.
13445
13446 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13447 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13448 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13449 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13450 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13451 or a &%def%& condition.
13452 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13453 which is not the leaf.
13454
13455 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13456 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13457 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13458 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13459
13460 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13461 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13462 the outbound.
13463
13464 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13465 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13466 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13467 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13468 and &"0"& otherwise.
13469
13470 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13471 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13472 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13473 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13474 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13475 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13476 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13477 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13478 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13479
13480 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13481 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13482 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13483
13484 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13485 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13486 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13487
13488 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13489 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13490 This variable is
13491 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13492 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13493 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13494 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13495
13496 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13497 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13498 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13499
13500 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13501 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13502 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13503
13504 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13505 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13506 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13507 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13508 .code
13509 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13510 1 No response to request
13511 2 Response not verified
13512 3 Verification failed
13513 4 Verification succeeded
13514 .endd
13515
13516 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13517 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13518 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13519 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13520 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13521
13522 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13523 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13524 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13525 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13526 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13527 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13528 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13529 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13530 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13531 which is not the leaf.
13532
13533 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13534 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13535 the outbound.
13536
13537 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13538 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13539 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13540 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13541 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13542 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13543 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13544 which is not the leaf.
13545
13546 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13547 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13548 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13549 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13550 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13551 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13552 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13553 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13554 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13555 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13556 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13557
13558 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13559 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13560 the outbound.
13561
13562 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13563 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13564 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13565 During outbound
13566 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13567 the transport.
13568
13569 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13570 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13571 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13572
13573 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13574 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13575 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13576 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13577
13578 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13579 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13580 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13581 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13582
13583
13584 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13585 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13586 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13587 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13588
13589 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13590 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13591 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13592
13593 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13594 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13595 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13596
13597 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13598 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13599 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13600 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13601 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13602 values for those that are behind (west).
13603
13604 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13605 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13606 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13607 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13608
13609 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13610 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13611 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13612 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13613 flag.
13614
13615 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13616 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13617 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13618 -0500.
13619
13620 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13621 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13622 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13623 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13624
13625 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13626 .cindex "transport" "name"
13627 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13628 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13629 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13630
13631 .vitem &$value$&
13632 .vindex "&$value$&"
13633 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13634 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13635 &*reduce*& expansion.
13636
13637 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13638 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13639 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13640 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13641 Otherwise, empty.
13642
13643 .vitem &$version_number$&
13644 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13645 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13646 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13647
13648 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13649 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13650 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13651 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13652
13653 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13654 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13655 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13656 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13657 .endlist
13658 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13659
13660
13661
13662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13664
13665 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13666 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13667 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13668 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13669 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13670 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13671 the line
13672 .code
13673 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13674 .endd
13675 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13676
13677
13678 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13679 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13680 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13681 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13682 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13683 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13684 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13685 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13686 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13687
13688 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13689 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13690 should usually be something like
13691 .code
13692 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13693 .endd
13694 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13695 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13696 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13697 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13698 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13699 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13700 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13701 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13702 two ways:
13703
13704 .ilist
13705 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13706 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13707 a startup when Exim is entered.
13708 .next
13709 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13710 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13711 .endlist
13712
13713 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13714 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13715
13716 .ilist
13717 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13718 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13719 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13720 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13721 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13722 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13723 defaults to false.
13724
13725
13726 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13727 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13728 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13729 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13730 forms:
13731 .code
13732 ${perl{foo}}
13733 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13734 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13735 .endd
13736 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13737 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13738 with an error message of the form
13739 .code
13740 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13741 .endd
13742 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13743 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13744 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13745 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13746 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13747 that was passed to &%die%&.
13748
13749
13750 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13751 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13752 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13753 the Perl code
13754 .code
13755 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13756 .endd
13757 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13758 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13759 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13760
13761 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13762 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13763 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13764 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13765
13766 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13767 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13768 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13769 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13770 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13771 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13772 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13773
13774
13775 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13776 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13777 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13778 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13779 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13780 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13781 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13782 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13783 avoided, but the output is lost.
13784
13785 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13786 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13787 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13788 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13789 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13790 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13791 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13792 .code
13793 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13794 .endd
13795 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13796 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13797 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13798 as the first subroutine argument.
13799 .ecindex IIDperl
13800
13801
13802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13804
13805 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13806 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13807 "Starting the daemon"
13808 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13809 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13810 .cindex "network interface"
13811 .cindex "interface" "network"
13812 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13813 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13814 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13815 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13816 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13817 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13818 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13819 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13820 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13821 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13822 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13823
13824 .olist
13825 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13826 and ports to listen on.
13827 .next
13828 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13829 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13830 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13831 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13832 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13833 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13834 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13835 as an error situation.
13836 .next
13837 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13838 for the outgoing connection.
13839 .endlist
13840
13841
13842 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13843 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13844 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13845 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13846 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13847
13848 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13849 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13850 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13851 chapter describes how they operate.
13852
13853 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13854 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13855
13856
13857
13858 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13859 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13860 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13861 following options:
13862
13863 .ilist
13864 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13865 or service names.
13866 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13867 .next
13868 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13869 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13870 .endlist
13871
13872 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13873 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13874 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13875 colons. For example:
13876 .code
13877 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13878 192.168.23.65 ; \
13879 ::1 ; \
13880 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13881 .endd
13882 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13883 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13884
13885 .olist
13886 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13887 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13888 .code
13889 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13890 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13891 .endd
13892 .next
13893 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13894 with a colon separator, for example:
13895 .code
13896 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13897 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13898 .endd
13899 .endlist
13900
13901 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13902 default setting contains just one port:
13903 .code
13904 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13905 .endd
13906 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13907 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13908 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13909 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13910 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13911
13912
13913
13914 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13915 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13916 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13917 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13918 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13919 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13920 .code
13921 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13922 .endd
13923 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13924 .code
13925 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13926 .endd
13927 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13928
13929
13930
13931 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13932 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13933 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13934 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13935 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13936 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13937 exim.
13938
13939 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13940 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13941 If there are any items that do not
13942 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13943 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13944 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13945 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13946 .code
13947 -oX 1225
13948 .endd
13949 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13950 whereas
13951 .code
13952 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13953 .endd
13954 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13955 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13956 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13957
13958
13959
13960 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13961 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13962 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13963 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13964 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13965 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13966 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13967 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13968 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13969 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13970 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13971 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13972 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13973 the 465 TCP ports.
13974
13975 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13976 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13977 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13978
13979 The common use of this option is expected to be
13980 .code
13981 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13982 .endd
13983 per RFC 8314.
13984 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13985 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13986
13987 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13988 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13989 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13990 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13991 connections via the daemon.)
13992
13993
13994
13995
13996 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13997 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13998 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13999 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14000 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14001 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14002 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14003 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14004 .code
14005 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14006 .endd
14007 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14008 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14009 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14010 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14011 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14012 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14013 .code
14014 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14015 .endd
14016 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14017 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14018 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14019 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14020 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14021
14022 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14023 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14024 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14025 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14026 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14027 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14028 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14029 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14030 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14031 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14032 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14033 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14034
14035 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14036 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14037 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14038 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14039 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14040
14041
14042
14043 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14044 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14045 .code
14046 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14047 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14048 .endd
14049 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14050 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14051 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14052 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14053
14054 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14055 .code
14056 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14057 .endd
14058 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14059 .code
14060 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14061 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14062 .endd
14063 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14064 IPv4 loopback address only:
14065 .code
14066 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14067 .endd
14068 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14069 .code
14070 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14071 .endd
14072 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14073
14074
14075
14076 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14077 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14078 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14079 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14080 treated as local.
14081
14082 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14083 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14084 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14085 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14086
14087 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14088 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14089 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14090 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14091 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14092 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14093 used for listening. Consider this example:
14094 .code
14095 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14096 192.168.53.235 ; \
14097 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14098
14099 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14100 .endd
14101 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14102 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14103 Exim is routing.
14104
14105 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14106 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14107 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14108 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14109 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14110 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14111 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14112 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14113
14114
14115
14116 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14117 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14118 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14119 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14120 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14121 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14122 details.
14123
14124
14125
14126
14127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14128 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14129
14130 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14131 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14132 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14133 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14134
14135 .ilist
14136 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14137 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14138 .next
14139 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14140 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14141 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14142 .next
14143 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14144 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14145 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14146 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14147 settings.
14148 .endlist
14149
14150 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14151 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14152 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14153 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14154 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14155 listed in more than one group.
14156
14157 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14158 .table2
14159 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14160 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14161 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14162 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14163 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14164 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14165 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14166 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14167 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14168 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14169 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14170 .endtable
14171
14172
14173 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14174 .table2
14175 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14176 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14177 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14178 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14179 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14180 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14181 .endtable
14182
14183
14184
14185 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14186 .table2
14187 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14188 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14189 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14190 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14191 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14192 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14193 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14194 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14195 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14196 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14197 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14198 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14199 .endtable
14200
14201
14202
14203 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14204 .table2
14205 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14206 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14207 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14208 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14209 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14210 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14211 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14212 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14213 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14214 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14215 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14216 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14217 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14218 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14219 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14220 .endtable
14221
14222
14223
14224 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14225 .table2
14226 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14227 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14228 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14229 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14230 .endtable
14231
14232
14233
14234 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14235 .table2
14236 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14237 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14238 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14239 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14240 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14241 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14242 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14243 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14244 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14245 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14246 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14247 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14248 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14249 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14250 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14251 .endtable
14252
14253
14254
14255 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14256 .table2
14257 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14258 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14259 .endtable
14260
14261
14262
14263 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14264 .table2
14265 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14266 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14267 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14268 .endtable
14269
14270
14271
14272 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14273 .table2
14274 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14275 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14276 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14277 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14278 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14279 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14280 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14281 .endtable
14282
14283
14284
14285 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14286 .table2
14287 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14288 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14289 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14290 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14291 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14292 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14293 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14294 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14295 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14296 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14297 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14298 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14299 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14300 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14301 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14302 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14303 connection"
14304 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14305 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14306 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14307 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14308 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14309 .endtable
14310
14311
14312
14313 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14314 .table2
14315 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14316 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14317 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14318 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14319 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14320 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14321 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14322 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14323 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14324 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14325 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14326 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14327 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14328 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14329 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14330 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14331 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14332 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14333 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14334 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14335 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14336 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14337 words""&"
14338 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14339 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14340 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14341 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14342 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14343 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14344 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14345 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14346 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14347 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14348 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14349 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14350 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14351 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14352 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14353 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14354 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14355 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14356 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14357 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14358 .endtable
14359
14360
14361
14362 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14363 .table2
14364 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14365 item"
14366 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14367 item"
14368 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14369 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14370 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14371 .endtable
14372
14373
14374
14375 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14376 .table2
14377 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14378 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14379 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14380 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14381 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14382 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14383 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14384 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14385 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14386 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14387 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14388 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14389 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14390 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14391 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14392 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14393 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14394 .endtable
14395
14396
14397
14398 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14399 .table2
14400 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14401 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14402 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14403 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14404 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14405 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14406 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14407 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14408 .endtable
14409
14410
14411
14412 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14413 .table2
14414 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14415 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14416 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14417 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14418 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14419 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14420 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14421 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14422 .endtable
14423
14424
14425
14426
14427 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14428 .table2
14429 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14430 .endtable
14431
14432
14433
14434
14435
14436 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14437 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14438
14439 .table2
14440 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14441 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14442 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14443 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14444 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14445 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14446 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14447 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14448 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14449 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14450 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14451 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14452 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14453 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14454 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14455 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14456 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14457 connection"
14458 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14459 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14460 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14461 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14462 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14463 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14464 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14465 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14466 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14467 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14468 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14469 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14470 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14471 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14472 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14473 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14474 .endtable
14475
14476
14477
14478 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14479 .table2
14480 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14481 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14482 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14483 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14484 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14485 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14486 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14487 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14488 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14489 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14490 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14491 .endtable
14492
14493
14494
14495 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14496 .table2
14497 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14498 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14499 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14500 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14501 words""&"
14502 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14503 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14504 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14505 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14506 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14507 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14508 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14509 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14510 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14511 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14512 .endtable
14513
14514
14515
14516 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14517 .table2
14518 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14519 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14520 directory"
14521 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14522 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14523 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14524 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14525 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14526 .endtable
14527
14528
14529
14530 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14531 .table2
14532 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14533 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14534 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14535 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14536 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14537 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14538 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14539 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14540 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14541 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14542 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14543 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14544 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14545 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14546 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14547 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14548 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14549 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14550 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14551 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14552 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14553 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14554 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14555 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14556 .endtable
14557
14558
14559
14560 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14561 .table2
14562 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14563 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14564 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14565 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14566 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14567 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14568 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14569 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14570 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14571 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14572 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14573 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14574 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14575 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14576 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14577 .endtable
14578
14579
14580
14581 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14582 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14583 &dagger;.
14584
14585 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14586 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14587 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14588 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14589 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14590 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14591 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14592 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14593 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14594
14595 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14596 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14597 It now defaults to true.
14598 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14599 .display
14600 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14601 .endd
14602
14603 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14604 .code
14605 log_selector = +8bitmime
14606 .endd
14607
14608 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14609 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14610 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14611 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14612 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14613 further details.
14614
14615 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14616 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14617 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14618 SMTP messages.
14619
14620 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14621 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14622 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14623 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14624 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14625
14626 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14627 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14628 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14629 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14630 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14631
14632 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14633 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14634 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14635 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14636
14637 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14638 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14639 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14640 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14641 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14642
14643 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14644 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14645 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14646 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14647 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14648 This option defines the ACL that,
14649 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14650 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14651 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14652 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14653
14654 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14655 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14656 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14657 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14658 of a received message.
14659 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14660
14661 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14662 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14663 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14664 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14665
14666 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14667 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14668 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14669 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14670
14671 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14672 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14673 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14674 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14675 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14676
14677
14678 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14679 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14680 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14681 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14682
14683 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14684 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14685 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14686 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14687 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14688
14689 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14690 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14691 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14692 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14693 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14694
14695 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14696 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14697 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14698 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14699 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14700
14701 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14702 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14703 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14704 further details.
14705
14706 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14707 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14708 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14709 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14710
14711 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14712 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14713 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14714 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14715
14716 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14717 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14718 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14719 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14720
14721 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14722 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14723 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14724 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14725
14726 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14727 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14728 This option adds individual environment variables that the
14729 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14730 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14731
14732 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14733
14734 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14735 .cindex "admin user"
14736 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14737 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14738 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14739 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14740 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14741 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14742 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14743
14744 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14745 .cindex "domain literal"
14746 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14747 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14748 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14749 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14750
14751 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14752 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14753 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14754 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14755 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14756 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14757 the local host's IP addresses.
14758
14759
14760 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14761 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14762 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14763 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14764 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14765 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14766 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14767 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14768 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14769
14770 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14771 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14772 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14773 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14774 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14775 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14776 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14777
14778 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14779 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14780 letters, digits, and hyphens.
14781
14782 If Exim is built with internationalization support
14783 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14784 this option can be left as default.
14785 Without that,
14786 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14787 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14788 suitable setting is:
14789 .code
14790 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14791 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14792 .endd
14793 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14794 .code
14795 dns_check_names_pattern =
14796 .endd
14797 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14798
14799
14800 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14801 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14802 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14803 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14804 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14805 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14806 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14807 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14808 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14809 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14810 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14811
14812 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14813 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14814 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14815 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14816 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14817 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14818
14819 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14820 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14821 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14822 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14823 .code
14824 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14825 .endd
14826 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14827 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14828 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14829 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14830
14831
14832 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14833 .cindex "thawing messages"
14834 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14835 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14836 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14837 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14838 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14839 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14840
14841 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14842 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14843 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14844
14845
14846 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14847 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14848 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14849 .code
14850 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14851 .endd
14852 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14853 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14854
14855
14856 .option bi_command main string unset
14857 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14858 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14859 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14860 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14861 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14862
14863
14864 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14865 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14866 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14867 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14868 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14869 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14870
14871
14872 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14873 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14874 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14875 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14876
14877 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14878 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14879 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14880 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14881 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14882 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14883 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14884 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14885 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14886 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14887
14888 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14889 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14890 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14891 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14892 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14893 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14894 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14895 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14896 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14897 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14898
14899 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14900 during reception of a message.
14901 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14902
14903 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14904
14905
14906 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14907 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14908 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14909 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14910
14911
14912 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14913 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14914 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14915 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14916 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14917 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14918 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14919 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14920 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14921
14922 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14923 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14924 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14925 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14926 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14927 messages.
14928
14929 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14930 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14931 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14932 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14933 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14934 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14935 connection. A typical setting might be:
14936 .code
14937 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14938 .endd
14939 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14940 .code
14941 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14942 .endd
14943 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14944 address.
14945
14946 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14947 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14948 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14949 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14950 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14951 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14952
14953
14954 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14955 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14956 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14957 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14958
14959
14960 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14961 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14962 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14963 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14964
14965
14966 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14967 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14968 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14969 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14970
14971
14972 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14973 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14974 callout verification. The default value is
14975 .code
14976 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14977 .endd
14978 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14979
14980
14981 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14982 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14983
14984
14985 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14986 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14987
14988 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14989 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14990 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14991 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14992 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14993 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14994 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14995 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14996 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14997 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14998
14999
15000 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15001 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15002
15003
15004 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15005 .cindex "checking disk space"
15006 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15007 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15008 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15009 message is accepted.
15010
15011 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15012 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15013 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15014 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15015 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15016 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15017 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15018 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15019
15020
15021 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15022 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15023 .code
15024 check_spool_space = 100M
15025 check_spool_inodes = 100
15026 .endd
15027 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15028 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15029 transit.
15030
15031 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15032 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15033 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15034
15035 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15036 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15037 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15038 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15039 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15040 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15041
15042 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15043 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15044 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15045
15046 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15047 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15048 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15049
15050 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15051 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15052 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15053 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15054
15055 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15056 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15057 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15058 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15059 these hosts.
15060 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15061
15062 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15063 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15064 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15065 administrative user.
15066 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15067
15068 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15069 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15070 .cindex memory debugging
15071 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15072 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15073 it should normally be left as default.
15074
15075 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15076 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15077 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15078 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15079 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15080 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15081
15082 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15083 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15084 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15085 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15086 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15087 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15088 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15089
15090 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15091 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15092
15093 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15094 .cindex "warning of delay"
15095 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15096 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15097 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15098 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15099 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15100 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15101 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15102 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15103 with
15104 .code
15105 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15106 .endd
15107 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15108 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15109 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15110 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15111 .code
15112 delay_warning = 6h
15113 .endd
15114 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15115 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15116 .code
15117 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15118 .endd
15119 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15120 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15121 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15122
15123 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15124 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15125 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15126 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15127 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15128 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15129 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15130 not sent. The default is:
15131 .code
15132 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15133 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15134 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15135 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15136 } {no}{yes}}
15137 .endd
15138 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15139 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15140 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15141 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15142
15143 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15144 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15145 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15146 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15147 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15148 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15149 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15150 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15151
15152 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15153 .cindex "load average"
15154 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15155 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15156 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15157 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15158 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15159
15160
15161 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15162 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15163 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15164 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15165 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15166 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15167 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15168 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15169
15170 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15171 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15172 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15173 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15174 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15175 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15176 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15177 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15178
15179 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15180 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15181 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15182 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15183
15184
15185 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15186 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15187 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15188 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15189 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15190 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15191 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15192
15193
15194 .new
15195 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15196 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15197 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15198 .wen
15199 and an order of processing.
15200 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15201
15202 Acceptable values include:
15203 .code
15204 sha1
15205 sha256
15206 sha512
15207 .endd
15208
15209 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15210
15211 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15212 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15213 and an order of processing.
15214 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15215
15216 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15217 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15218 first success.
15219
15220 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15221 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15222 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15223 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15224 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15225 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15226
15227
15228 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15229 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15230 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15231 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15232 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15233 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15234 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15235 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15236 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15237 by a setting such as this:
15238 .code
15239 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15240 .endd
15241 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15242 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15243 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15244 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15245 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15246 options are applied after this global option.
15247
15248 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15249 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15250 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15251 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15252 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15253 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15254 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15255 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15256 value of this option. The default pattern is
15257 .code
15258 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15259 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15260 .endd
15261 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15262 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15263 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15264 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15265 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15266 empty string.
15267
15268 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15269 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15270 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15271
15272 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15273 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15274 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15275 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15276
15277 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15278 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15279 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15280 not do it internally.
15281 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15282 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15283
15284 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15285 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15286 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15287
15288
15289 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15290 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15291 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15292 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15293 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15294 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15295
15296 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15297
15298
15299 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15300 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15301 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15302 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15303 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15304 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15305 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15306 domain matches this list.
15307
15308 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15309 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15310 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15311 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15312 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15313 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15314
15315
15316 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15317 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15318 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15319 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15320 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15321 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15322 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15323 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15324 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15325 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15326 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15327 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15328 to set in them.
15329 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15330
15331
15332 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15333 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15334
15335
15336 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15337 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15338 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15339 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15340 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15341 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15342 match with this expanded domain list.
15343
15344 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15345 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15346 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15347 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15348 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15349 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15350
15351 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15352 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15353 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15354
15355 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15356 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15357 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15358 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15359 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15360
15361 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15362 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15363 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15364 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15365 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15366 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15367 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15368 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15369 on.
15370
15371 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15372
15373 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15374 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15375 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15376
15377
15378 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15379 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15380 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15381 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15382
15383 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15384 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15385 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15386 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15387 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15388 and accepted from, these hosts.
15389 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15390 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15391 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15392 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15393 are sent.
15394
15395 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15396 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15397 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15398 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15399 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15400 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15401 .code
15402 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15403 .endd
15404 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15405 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15406
15407 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15408 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15409 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15410 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15411 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15412 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15413 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15414 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15415 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15416
15417
15418 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15419 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15420 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15421 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15422 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15423 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15424 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15425 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15426 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15427
15428 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15429 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15430 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15431 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15432 are examined. For example:
15433 .code
15434 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15435 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15436 postmaster@mydomain.example
15437 .endd
15438 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15439 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15440 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15441 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15442 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15443 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15444 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15445
15446
15447 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15448 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15449 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15450 .display
15451 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15452 .endd
15453 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15454 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15455 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15456 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15457 overrides the default.
15458
15459 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15460 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15461 and warning messages. For example:
15462 .code
15463 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15464 .endd
15465 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15466 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15467 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15468 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15469 not used.
15470
15471
15472 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15473 .cindex events
15474 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15475 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15476
15477
15478 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15479 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15480 .cindex "Exim group"
15481 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15482 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15483 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15484 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15485 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15486 security issues.
15487
15488
15489 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15490 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15491 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15492 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15493 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15494 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15495 other place.
15496 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15497 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15498 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15499 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15500
15501
15502 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15503 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15504 .cindex "Exim user"
15505 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15506 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15507 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15508 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15509
15510 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15511 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15512 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15513 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15514
15515
15516 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15517 .cindex "Exim version"
15518 .cindex customizing "version number"
15519 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15520 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15521 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15522
15523
15524 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15525 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15526 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15527 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15528
15529
15530 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15531 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15532
15533 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15534 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15535 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15536 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15537 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15538 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15539 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15540 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15541 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15542 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15543 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15544 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15545 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15546 addresses.
15547
15548
15549 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15550 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15551 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15552 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15553 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15554 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15555 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15556 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15557 retries.
15558
15559 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15560 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15561 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15562 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15563
15564
15565
15566 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15567 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15568 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15569 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15570 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15571 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15572 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15573 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15574 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15575 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15576 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15577 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15578 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15579 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15580 logging that you require.
15581
15582
15583 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15584 .cindex "HP-UX"
15585 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15586 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15587 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15588 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15589 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15590 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15591 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15592 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15593
15594 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15595 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15596 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15597 user's name.
15598
15599 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15600 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15601 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15602 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15603 .code
15604 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15605 gecos_name = $1
15606 .endd
15607
15608 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15609 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15610
15611
15612 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15613 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15614 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15615 implementations of TLS.
15616
15617
15618 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15619 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15620 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15621
15622 See
15623 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15624 for documentation.
15625
15626
15627
15628 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15629 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15630 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15631 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15632 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15633 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15634
15635
15636
15637 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15638 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15639 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15640 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15641 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15642 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15643 sections are rejected.
15644
15645
15646 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15647 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15648 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15649 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15650 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15651 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15652 zero means &"no limit"&.
15653
15654
15655
15656
15657 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15658 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15659 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15660 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15661 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15662 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15663 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15664 if you want to do semantic checking.
15665 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15666 set.
15667
15668
15669 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15670 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15671 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15672 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15673 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15674 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15675 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15676 .code
15677 helo_allow_chars = _
15678 .endd
15679 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15680
15681
15682 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15683 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15684 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15685 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15686 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15687 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15688 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15689 do.
15690
15691
15692 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15693 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15694 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15695 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15696 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15697 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15698 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15699 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15700 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15701 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15702 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15703 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15704
15705 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15706 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15707 EHLO command either:
15708
15709 .ilist
15710 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15711 .next
15712 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15713 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15714 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15715 calling host address, or
15716 .next
15717 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15718 .endlist
15719
15720 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15721 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15722 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15723
15724 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15725 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15726 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15727
15728 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15729 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15730 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15731 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15732 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15733 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15734 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15735 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15736 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15737 error.
15738
15739 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15740 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15741 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15742 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15743 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15744 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15745 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15746 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15747 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15748
15749 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15750 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15751 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15752 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15753 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15754
15755 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15756 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15757 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15758 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15759
15760
15761 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15762 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15763 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15764 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15765 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15766 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15767 default configuration file contains
15768 .code
15769 host_lookup = *
15770 .endd
15771 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15772 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15773
15774 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15775 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15776 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15777
15778 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15779 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15780 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15781 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15782 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15783 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15784
15785
15786 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15787 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15788 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15789 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15790 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15791 if you want.
15792
15793 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15794 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15795 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15796 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15797
15798
15799
15800 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15801 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15802 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15803 as soon as the connection is made.
15804 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15805 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15806 connections immediately.
15807
15808 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15809 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15810 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15811 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15812 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15813
15814
15815 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15816 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15817 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15818 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15819 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15820 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15821 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15822 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15823 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15824 .code
15825 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15826 .endd
15827 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15828
15829
15830
15831 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15832 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15833 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15834 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15835
15836
15837 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15838 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15839 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15840 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15841 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15842 records
15843 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15844 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15845
15846 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15847 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15848 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15849 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15850 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15851 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15852 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15853
15854
15855 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15856 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15857 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15858 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15859 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15860
15861
15862
15863 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15864 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15865 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15866 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15867 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15868 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15869
15870 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15871 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15872 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15873 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15874 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15875 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15876 for frozen messages. For example,
15877 .code
15878 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15879 .endd
15880 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15881 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15882 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15883 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15884 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15885 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15886
15887
15888 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15889 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15890 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15891 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15892 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15893 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15894 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15895 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15896 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15897 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15898
15899
15900 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15901 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15902
15903 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15904 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15905 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15906 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15907 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15908 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15909 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15910 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15911 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15912
15913 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15914 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15915
15916 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15917 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15918 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15919 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15920
15921 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15922 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15923 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15924 anymore.
15925
15926 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15927 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15928 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15929 details.
15930
15931
15932 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15933 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15934 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15935 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15936 logged.
15937
15938
15939 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15940 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15941 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15942 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15943 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15944 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15945 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15946 and constrained to be a directory.
15947
15948
15949 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15950 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15951 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15952 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15953 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15954 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15955 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15956 and constrained to be a file.
15957
15958
15959 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15960 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15961 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15962 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15963 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15964 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15965
15966
15967 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15968 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15969 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15970 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15971 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15972 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15973 identity to be proven.
15974
15975
15976 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15977 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15978 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15979 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15980 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15981
15982
15983 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15984 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15985 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15986 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15987 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15988 with LDAP support.
15989
15990
15991 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15992 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15993 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15994 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15995 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15996 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15997 to hard/demand.
15998
15999
16000 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16001 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16002 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16003 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16004 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16005 of SSL-on-connect.
16006 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16007 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16008 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16009
16010
16011 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16012 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16013 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16014 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16015 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16016 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16017 has been built with LDAP support.
16018
16019
16020
16021 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16022 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16023 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16024 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16025 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16026 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16027 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16028
16029 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16030 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16031 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16032
16033 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16034 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16035 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16036 and the default qualify domain.
16037
16038 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16039 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16040 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16041 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16042
16043 .cindex "envelope from"
16044 .cindex "envelope sender"
16045 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16046 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16047 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16048
16049 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16050 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16051 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16052
16053
16054
16055
16056 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16057 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16058 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16059 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16060 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16061 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16062 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16063 example, if
16064 .code
16065 local_from_prefix = *-
16066 .endd
16067 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16068 .code
16069 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16070 .endd
16071 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16072 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16073 qualify domain.
16074
16075
16076 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16077 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16078
16079
16080 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16081 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16082 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16083 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16084 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16085 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16086 &%local_interfaces%& is
16087 .code
16088 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16089 .endd
16090 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16091 .code
16092 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16093 .endd
16094
16095 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16096 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16097 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16098 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16099 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16100 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16101 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16102 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16103
16104
16105
16106 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16107 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16108 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16109 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16110 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16111 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16112 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16113 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16114
16115
16116
16117
16118 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16119 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16120 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16121 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16122 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16123 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16124 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16125 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16126 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16127 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16128 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16129 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16130 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16131 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16132 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16133
16134
16135
16136 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16137 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16138 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16139 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16140 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16141 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16142 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16143 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16144 A path must start with a slash.
16145 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16146 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16147 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16148 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16149 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16150 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16151 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16152 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16153
16154
16155 .option log_selector main string unset
16156 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16157 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16158 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16159 minus characters. For example:
16160 .code
16161 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16162 .endd
16163 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16164 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16165
16166
16167 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16168 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16169 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16170 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16171 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16172 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16173 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16174 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16175 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16176 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16177 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16178 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16179 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16180
16181
16182 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16183 .cindex "too many open files"
16184 .cindex "open files, too many"
16185 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16186 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16187 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16188 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16189 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16190 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16191 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16192 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16193 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16194 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16195 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16196 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16197
16198
16199 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16200 .cindex "length of login name"
16201 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16202 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16203 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16204 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16205 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16206 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16207
16208
16209 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16210 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16211 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16212 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16213 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16214 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16215 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16216 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16217
16218
16219 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16220 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16221 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16222 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16223 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16224 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16225 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16226
16227
16228 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16229 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16230 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16231 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16232 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16233 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16234 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16235 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16236 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16237 empty string, the option is ignored.
16238
16239
16240 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16241 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16242 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16243 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16244 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16245 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16246 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16247 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16248 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16249 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16250 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16251 colons will become hyphens.
16252
16253
16254 .option message_logs main boolean true
16255 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16256 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16257 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16258 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16259 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16260 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16261 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16262 which is not affected by this option.
16263
16264
16265 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16266 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16267 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16268 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16269 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16270 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16271 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16272 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16273 optionally followed by K or M.
16274
16275 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16276 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16277 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16278 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16279 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16280
16281 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16282 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16283 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16284 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16285 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16286 message that an individual transport can process.
16287
16288 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16289 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16290 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16291 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16292 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16293 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16294 some problems may result.
16295
16296 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16297 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16298 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16299
16300
16301 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16302 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16303 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16304 .code
16305 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16306 .endd
16307 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16308 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16309 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16310 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16311 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16312
16313
16314 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16315 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16316 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16317 contains a full description of this facility.
16318
16319
16320
16321 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16322 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16323 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16324 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16325 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16326
16327
16328 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16329 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16330 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16331 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16332 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16333 safety precaution.
16334
16335 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16336 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16337 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16338 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16339 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16340
16341 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16342 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16343 example is
16344 .code
16345 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16346 .endd
16347 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16348 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16349 transport driver.
16350
16351
16352 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16353 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16354 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16355 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16356 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16357
16358 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16359 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16360 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16361 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16362 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16363 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16364 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16365
16366 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16367 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16368 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16369 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16370 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16371
16372 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16373
16374 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16375 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16376 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16377 some now infamous attacks.
16378
16379 Examples:
16380 .code
16381 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16382 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16383 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16384
16385 # Disable older protocol versions:
16386 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16387 .endd
16388
16389 Possible options may include:
16390 .ilist
16391 &`all`&
16392 .next
16393 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16394 .next
16395 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16396 .next
16397 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16398 .next
16399 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
16400 .next
16401 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16402 .next
16403 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16404 .next
16405 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16406 .next
16407 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16408 .next
16409 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16410 .next
16411 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16412 .next
16413 &`no_compression`&
16414 .next
16415 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16416 .next
16417 &`no_sslv2`&
16418 .next
16419 &`no_sslv3`&
16420 .next
16421 &`no_ticket`&
16422 .next
16423 &`no_tlsv1`&
16424 .next
16425 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
16426 .next
16427 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
16428 .next
16429 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16430 .next
16431 &`single_dh_use`&
16432 .next
16433 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16434 .next
16435 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16436 .next
16437 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16438 .next
16439 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16440 .next
16441 &`tls_d5_bug`&
16442 .next
16443 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16444 .endlist
16445
16446 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16447 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16448 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16449 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16450 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16451 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16452
16453
16454 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16455 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16456 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16457 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16458 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16459
16460
16461 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16462 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16463 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16464 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16465 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16466 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16467 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16468 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16469 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16470 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16471 an ACL.
16472
16473 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16474 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16475 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16476 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16477 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16478 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16479 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16480
16481
16482 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16483 .cindex "Perl"
16484 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16485 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16486
16487
16488 .option perl_startup main string unset
16489 .cindex "Perl"
16490 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16491 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16492
16493 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16494 .cindex "Perl"
16495 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16496
16497
16498 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16499 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16500 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16501 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16502 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16503 PostgreSQL support.
16504
16505
16506 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16507 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16508 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16509 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16510 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16511 to the host name:
16512 .code
16513 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16514 .endd
16515 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16516 spool directory.
16517 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16518 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16519 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16520
16521
16522 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16523 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16524 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16525 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16526 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16527 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16528 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16529 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16530 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16531
16532 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16533 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16534 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16535 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16536 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16537 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16538 commands are acceptable.
16539 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16540
16541 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16542
16543 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16544
16545
16546 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16547 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16548 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16549 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16550 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16551 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16552 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16553 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16554
16555 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16556 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16557 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16558 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16559 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16560 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16561 volume of mail. Use with care!
16562
16563
16564 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16565 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16566 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16567 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16568 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16569 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16570 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16571 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16572 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16573 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16574
16575 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16576 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16577 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16578 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16579 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16580 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16581
16582
16583 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16584 .cindex "printing characters"
16585 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16586 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16587 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16588 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16589 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16590 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16591 characters.
16592
16593 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16594 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16595 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16596 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16597 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16598 standards.
16599
16600
16601 .option process_log_path main string unset
16602 .cindex "process log path"
16603 .cindex "log" "process log"
16604 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16605 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16606 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16607 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16608 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16609 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16610 different spool directories.
16611
16612
16613 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16614 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16615 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16616 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16617 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16618 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16619 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16620 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16621
16622
16623 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16624 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16625 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16626 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16627 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16628 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16629 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16630 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16631 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16632
16633 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16634 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16635 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16636 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16637 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16638 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16639 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16640
16641
16642 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16643 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16644 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16645
16646
16647
16648 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16649 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16650 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16651 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16652 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16653 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16654 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16655 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16656
16657
16658 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16659 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16660 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16661 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16662 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16663 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16664 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16665
16666
16667 .option queue_only main boolean false
16668 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16669 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16670 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16671 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16672 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16673 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16674
16675 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16676 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16677 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16678 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16679
16680
16681 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16682 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16683 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16684 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16685 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16686 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16687 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16688 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16689 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16690 .code
16691 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16692 .endd
16693 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16694 &_/some/file_& exists.
16695
16696
16697 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16698 .cindex "load average"
16699 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16700 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16701 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16702 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16703 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16704 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16705 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16706 false.
16707
16708 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16709 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16710 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16711 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16712
16713
16714 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16715 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16716 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16717 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16718 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16719 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16720 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16721 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16722 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16723 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16724 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16725 re-evaluated for each message.
16726
16727
16728 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16729 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16730 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16731 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16732 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16733 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16734
16735
16736 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16737 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16738 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16739 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16740 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16741 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16742 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16743 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16744 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16745 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16746 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16747 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16748 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16749
16750
16751
16752 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16753 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16754 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16755 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16756 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16757 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16758 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16759 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16760 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16761
16762 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16763 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16764 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16765 the daemon's command line.
16766
16767 .cindex queues named
16768 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
16769 To set limits for different named queues use
16770 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16771
16772 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16773 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16774 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16775 .cindex "first pass routing"
16776 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16777 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16778 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16779 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16780 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16781 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16782 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16783 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16784 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16785 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16786 &%queue_domains%&.
16787
16788
16789 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16790 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16791 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16792 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16793 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16794 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16795 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16796
16797 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16798 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16799 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16800 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16801 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16802 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16803 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16804 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16805 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16806 header lines.
16807 The default setting is:
16808
16809 .code
16810 received_header_text = Received: \
16811 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16812 {${if def:sender_ident \
16813 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16814 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16815 by $primary_hostname \
16816 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16817 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16818 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16819 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16820 ${if def:sender_address \
16821 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16822 id $message_exim_id\
16823 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16824 .endd
16825
16826 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16827 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16828 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16829 header lines such as the following:
16830 .code
16831 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16832 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16833 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16834 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16835 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16836 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16837 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16838 .endd
16839 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16840 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16841 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16842 message was accepted.
16843
16844
16845 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16846 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16847 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16848 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16849 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16850 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16851 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16852 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16853
16854
16855 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16856 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16857 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16858 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16859 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16860 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16861 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16862 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16863 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16864 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16865 option was not set.
16866
16867
16868 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16869 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16870 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16871 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16872 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16873 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16874 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16875 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16876 done.
16877
16878 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16879 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16880 RCPT commands in a single message.
16881
16882
16883 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16884 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16885 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16886 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16887 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16888 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16889 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16890
16891
16892 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16893 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16894 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16895 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16896 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16897 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16898 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16899 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16900 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16901 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16902 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16903 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16904 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16905 tagged with its process id.
16906
16907 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16908 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16909 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16910 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16911 is received.
16912
16913 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16914 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16915 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16916 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16917 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16918 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16919 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16920 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16921 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16922 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16923 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16924
16925 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16926 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16927 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16928 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16929
16930
16931 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16932 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16933 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16934 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16935 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16936 .code
16937 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16938 .endd
16939 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16940 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16941
16942
16943 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16944 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16945 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16946 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16947 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16948 past failures.
16949
16950
16951 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16952 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16953 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16954 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16955 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16956 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16957 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16958 the default value.
16959
16960
16961 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16962 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16963 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16964 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16965 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16966 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16967 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16968 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16969 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16970 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16971
16972
16973 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16974 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16975
16976
16977 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16978 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16979 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16980 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16981 an item in the list.
16982 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16983 for the system.
16984
16985 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16986 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16987 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16988 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16989 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16990
16991
16992 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16993 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16994 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16995 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16996 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16997 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16998 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16999 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17000 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17001 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17002
17003
17004 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17005 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17006 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17007 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17008 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17009 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17010 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17011
17012
17013
17014 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17015 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17016 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17017 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17018 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17019 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17020 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17021 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17022 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17023 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17024 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17025
17026
17027
17028 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17029 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17030 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17031 .cindex "inetd"
17032 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17033 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17034 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17035 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17036 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17037 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17038
17039 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17040 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17041 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17042 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17043
17044
17045 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17046 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17047 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17048 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17049 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17050 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17051 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17052 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17053
17054 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17055 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17056 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17057 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17058 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17059 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17060 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17061 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17062
17063
17064 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17065 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17066 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17067 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17068 live with.
17069
17070
17071 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17072 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17073 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17074 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17075 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17076 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17077 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17078 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17079 . the option name to split.
17080
17081 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17082 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17083 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17084 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17085 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17086 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17087 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17088 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17089 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17090 seen).
17091
17092
17093 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17094 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17095 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17096 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17097 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17098 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17099 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17100 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17101 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17102 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17103 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17104
17105 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17106 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17107 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17108 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17109 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17110 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17111
17112
17113
17114 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17115 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17116 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17117 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17118 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17119 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17120 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17121 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17122 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17123 to all messages received in the same connection.
17124
17125 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17126 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17127 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17128 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17129
17130
17131 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17132
17133 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17134 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17135 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17136 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17137 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17138 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17139 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17140 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17141 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17142 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17143 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17144 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17145 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17146
17147
17148 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17149 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17150 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17151 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17152 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17153 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17154 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17155 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17156 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17157 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17158 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17159 individual host.
17160
17161 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17162 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17163 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17164 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17165
17166
17167 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17168 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17169 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17170 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17171 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17172 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17173 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17174 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17175 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17176
17177 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17178 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17179 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17180 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17181
17182 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17183 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17184 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17185 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17186 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17187 For example:
17188 .code
17189 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17190 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17191 .endd
17192
17193 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17194 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17195 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17196 &%helo_data%& value.
17197
17198 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17199 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17200 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17201 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17202 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17203 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17204 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17205 .code
17206 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17207 $version_number $tod_full
17208 .endd
17209 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17210 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17211 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17212 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17213 multiline response).
17214
17215
17216 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17217 .cindex "checking disk space"
17218 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17219 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17220 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17221 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17222 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17223 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17224 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17225
17226
17227 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17228 .cindex "connection backlog"
17229 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17230 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17231 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17232 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17233 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17234 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17235 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17236 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17237 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17238 attacks by SYN flooding.
17239
17240
17241 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17242 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17243 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17244 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17245 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17246 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17247 fewer, but they still exist.
17248
17249 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17250 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17251 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17252 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17253 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17254 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17255 does detect many instances.
17256
17257 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17258 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17259 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17260 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17261
17262
17263
17264 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17265 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17266 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17267 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17268 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17269 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17270 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17271 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17272 example:
17273 .code
17274 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17275 $sender_host_address
17276 .endd
17277 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17278 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17279 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17280 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17281 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17282 the command.
17283
17284
17285 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17286 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17287 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17288 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17289 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17290
17291
17292 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17293 .cindex "load average"
17294 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17295 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17296 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17297 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17298 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17299 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17300
17301
17302
17303 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17304 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17305 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17306 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17307 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17308 .code
17309 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17310 .endd
17311 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17312 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17313 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17314 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17315 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17316
17317 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17318 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17319 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17320 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17321 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17322 not count towards the limit.
17323
17324
17325
17326 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17327 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17328 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17329 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17330 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17331 that subvert web
17332 clients
17333 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17334 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17335
17336
17337
17338 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17339 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17340 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17341 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17342 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17343 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17344 recipients.
17345
17346 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17347 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17348 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17349 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17350
17351 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17352 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17353 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17354 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17355 values:
17356
17357 .ilist
17358 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17359 .next
17360 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17361 fractional parts are allowed here.
17362 .next
17363 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17364 .next
17365 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17366 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17367 .endlist
17368
17369 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17370 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17371 .code
17372 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17373 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17374 .endd
17375 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17376 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17377 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17378 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17379
17380
17381 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17382 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17383
17384
17385 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17386 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17387
17388
17389 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17390 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17391 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17392 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17393 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17394 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17395 the message is abandoned.
17396 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17397 .code
17398 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17399 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17400 .endd
17401 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17402 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17403
17404 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17405 expanded before use and may depend on
17406 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17407
17408
17409 .oindex "&%-os%&"
17410 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17411 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17412 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17413 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17414 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17415
17416
17417 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17418 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17419 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17420
17421
17422 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17423 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17424 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17425 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17426 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17427 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17428 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17429 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17430 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17431 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17432 .code
17433 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17434 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17435 .endd
17436
17437
17438 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17439 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17440 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17441 the availability thereof is advertised in
17442 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17443 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17444
17445
17446 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17447 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17448 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17449 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17450
17451
17452
17453 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17454 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17455 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17456
17457
17458
17459 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17460 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17461 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17462 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17463 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17464 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17465 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17466 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17467 arrival of the message.
17468
17469 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17470 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17471 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17472 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17473 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17474
17475 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17476 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17477 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17478 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17479 automatically deleted.
17480
17481 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17482 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17483 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17484 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17485 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17486 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17487 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17488 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17489 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17490
17491
17492 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17493 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17494 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17495 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17496 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17497 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17498 &$primary_hostname$&.
17499
17500 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17501 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17502 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17503 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17504 as failures in the configuration file.
17505
17506 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17507 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17508
17509 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17510 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17511 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17512 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17513 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17514 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17515 option.
17516
17517 The following variables will not have useful values:
17518 .code
17519 $max_received_linelength
17520 $body_linecount
17521 $body_zerocount
17522 .endd
17523
17524 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17525 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17526 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17527 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17528
17529 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17530 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17531 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17532
17533 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17534 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17535 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17536 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17537
17538 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17539 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17540 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17541 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17542 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17543 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17544
17545 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17546 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17547 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17548 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17549 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17550 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17551 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17552
17553
17554 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17555 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17556 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17557 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17558 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17559 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17560 domain causes a syntax error.
17561 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17562 syntax checking.
17563
17564
17565 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17566 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17567 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17568 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17569 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17570 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17571 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17572 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17573 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17574 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17575 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17576 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17577
17578
17579 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17580 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17581 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17582 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17583 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17584 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17585 details of Exim's logging.
17586
17587
17588 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17589 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17590 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17591 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17592 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17593 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17594 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17595
17596
17597
17598 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17599 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17600 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17601 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17602 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17603
17604
17605
17606 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17607 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17608 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17609 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17610 details of Exim's logging.
17611
17612
17613 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17614 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17615 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17616 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17617 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17618 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17619 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17620 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17621 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17622 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17623 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17624 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17625
17626
17627 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17628 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17629 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17630 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17631 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17632 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17633
17634
17635 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17636 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17637 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17638 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17639 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17640
17641 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17642 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17643 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17644 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17645 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17646
17647 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17648 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17649 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17650 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17651 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17652 contains the pipe command.
17653
17654
17655 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17656 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17657 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17658 is used in a system filter.
17659
17660
17661 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17662 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17663 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17664 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17665 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17666 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17667 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17668 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17669 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17670 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17671
17672 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17673 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17674 transport option overrides.
17675
17676
17677 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17678 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17679 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17680 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17681 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17682 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17683 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17684 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17685 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17686 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17687 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17688 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17689 TCP_NODELAY.
17690
17691
17692 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17693 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17694 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17695 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17696 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17697 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17698 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17699 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17700 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17701 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17702
17703 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17704 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17705 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17706
17707
17708 .option timezone main string unset
17709 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17710 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17711 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17712 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17713 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17714 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17715 .code
17716 timezone = UTC
17717 .endd
17718 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17719 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17720 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17721 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17722 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17723 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17724
17725
17726 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17727 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17728 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17729 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17730 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17731 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17732 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17733 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17734 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17735 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17736 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17737
17738
17739 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17740 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17741 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17742 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17743 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17744 Commonly only one file is needed.
17745 The server's private key is also
17746 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17747 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17748
17749 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17750 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17751 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17752 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17753
17754 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17755 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17756
17757 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17758 when a list of more than one
17759 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17760 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17761
17762 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17763 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17764 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17765 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17766
17767 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17768 generated for every connection.
17769
17770 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17771 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17772 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17773 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17774 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17775
17776 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17777
17778 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17779 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17780 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17781
17782 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17783
17784
17785 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17786 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17787 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17788 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17789 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17790 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17791
17792 The value must be at least 1024.
17793
17794 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17795 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17796 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17797
17798 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17799 number.
17800
17801 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17802 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17803 larger prime than requested.
17804
17805
17806 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17807 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17808 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17809 to be used by Exim.
17810
17811 This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17812 The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17813
17814 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17815 for other TLS library versions,
17816 using a filename with site-generated
17817 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17818 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17819 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17820
17821 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17822 then it names a file from which DH
17823 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17824 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17825 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17826 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17827 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17828 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17829
17830 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17831 loaded by Exim.
17832
17833 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17834 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17835 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17836 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17837
17838 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17839 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17840
17841 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17842 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17843 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17844
17845 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17846 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17847 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17848 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17849 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17850
17851 The available standard primes are:
17852 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17853 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17854 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17855 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17856
17857 The available additional primes are:
17858 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17859
17860 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17861 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17862 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17863 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17864 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17865
17866 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17867 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17868 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17869
17870 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17871 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17872 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17873 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17874 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17875 userbase.
17876
17877 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17878 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17879 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17880 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17881 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17882 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17883 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17884
17885
17886 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17887 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17888 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17889 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17890
17891 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17892 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17893 for valid selections.
17894
17895 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17896 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17897 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17898
17899 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17900
17901
17902 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17903 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17904 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17905 This option
17906 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17907 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17908 Certificate Authority.
17909
17910 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17911 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17912
17913 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17914 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17915 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17916 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17917 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17918
17919 The file(s) should be in DER format,
17920 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17921 or for OpenSSL,
17922 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17923 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17924 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17925 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17926 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17927 (this only works under TLS1.3)
17928 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17929
17930 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17931 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17932 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17933 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17934
17935 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17936 .cindex SSMTP
17937 .cindex SMTPS
17938 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17939 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17940 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17941 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17942
17943
17944
17945 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17946 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17947 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17948 files which contains the server's private keys.
17949 If this option is unset, or if
17950 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17951 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17952 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17953
17954 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17955
17956
17957 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17958 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17959 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17960 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17961 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17962 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17963 TLS session.
17964
17965
17966 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17967 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17968 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17969 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17970 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17971 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17972 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17973 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17974 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17975 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17976 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17977
17978
17979 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17980 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17981 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17982 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17983
17984
17985 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17986 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17987 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17988 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17989 word "system"
17990 or the absolute path to
17991 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17992 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17993
17994 The "system" value for the option will use a
17995 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17996 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17997 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17998 must be specified.
17999
18000 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18001 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18002
18003 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18004 explicitly
18005 either by file or directory
18006 are added to those given by the system default location.
18007
18008 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18009 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18010 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18011 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18012 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18013 use the explicit directory version.
18014
18015 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18016
18017 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18018 being unset.
18019
18020
18021 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18022 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18023 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18024 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18025 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18026 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18027 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18028 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18029
18030 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18031 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18032 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18033 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18034 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18035 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18036 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18037
18038 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18039 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18040 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18041 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18042 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18043 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18044 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18045 certificate"&.
18046
18047 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18048 certificates.
18049
18050
18051 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18052 .cindex "trusted groups"
18053 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18054 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18055 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18056 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18057 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18058 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18059 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18060 are trusted.
18061
18062 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18063 .cindex "trusted users"
18064 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18065 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18066 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18067 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18068 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18069 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18070 Exim user are trusted.
18071
18072 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18073 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18074 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18075 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18076 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18077 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18078 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18079 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18080 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18081 &%-F%& option.
18082
18083 .option unknown_username main string unset
18084 See &%unknown_login%&.
18085
18086 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18087 .cindex "trusted users"
18088 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18089 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18090 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18091 .cindex "envelope from"
18092 .cindex "envelope sender"
18093 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18094 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18095 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18096 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18097 is used) is ignored.
18098
18099 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18100 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18101 .code
18102 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18103 .endd
18104 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18105 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18106 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18107 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18108 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18109 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18110 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18111 followed by a hyphen
18112 by a setting like this:
18113 .code
18114 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18115 .endd
18116 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18117 restriction, you can use
18118 .code
18119 untrusted_set_sender = *
18120 .endd
18121 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18122 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18123 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18124 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18125 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18126 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18127 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18128 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18129
18130 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18131 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18132 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18133 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18134 sender address.
18135
18136
18137 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18138 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18139 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18140 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18141 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18142 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18143 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18144 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18145 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18146 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18147 .code
18148 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18149 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18150 .endd
18151 The pattern can be seen by running
18152 .code
18153 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18154 .endd
18155 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18156 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18157 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18158 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18159 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18160 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18161
18162
18163 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18164 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18165
18166
18167 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18168 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18169 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18170 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18171 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18172 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18173 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18174 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18175
18176
18177 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18178 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18179 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18180 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18181 .ecindex IIDconfima
18182 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18183
18184
18185
18186
18187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18189
18190 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18191 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18192 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18193 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18194 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18195
18196 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18197 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18198 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18199 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18200 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18201
18202
18203
18204 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18205 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18206 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18207 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18208 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18209 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18210 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18211
18212 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18213 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18214 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18215 routers, and the eventual transport.
18216
18217 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18218 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18219 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18220 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18221 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18222
18223 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18224 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18225 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18226 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18227 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18228
18229 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18230 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18231 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18232 .code
18233 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18234 .endd
18235 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18236 .code
18237 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18238 .endd
18239 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18240 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18241
18242 See also the &%set%& option below.
18243
18244 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18245 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18246 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18247 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18248 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18249 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18250 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18251
18252
18253
18254 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18255 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
18256 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18257 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18258 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18259 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18260 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18261 routing.
18262
18263
18264
18265 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18266 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18267 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18268 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18269 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18270 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18271 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18272 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18273 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18274 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18275 you could put:
18276 .code
18277 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18278 .endd
18279 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18280 and
18281 .code
18282 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18283 .endd
18284 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18285 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18286 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18287 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18288
18289
18290 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18291 .cindex "case of local parts"
18292 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18293 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18294 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18295 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18296 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18297 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18298 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18299 more details.
18300
18301 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18302 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18303 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18304 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18305 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18306 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18307 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18308 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18309 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18310
18311 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18312 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18313 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18314 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18315
18316
18317
18318 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18319 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18320 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18321 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18322 .vindex "&$home$&"
18323 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18324 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18325 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18326 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18327 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18328 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18329 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18330 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18331 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18332 the router is skipped.
18333
18334 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18335 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18336 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18337 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18338 setting to achieve this. For example:
18339 .code
18340 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18341 .endd
18342 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18343 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18344 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18345
18346
18347
18348 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18349 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18350 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18351 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18352 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18353 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18354 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18355 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18356
18357 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18358 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18359
18360 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18361 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18362
18363 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18364 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18365 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18366 .code
18367 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18368 .endd
18369 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18370 .code
18371 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18372 .endd
18373
18374 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18375 .code
18376 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18377 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18378 condition = foobar
18379 .endd
18380
18381 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18382 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18383 be specified using &%condition%&.
18384
18385 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18386 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18387 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18388 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18389 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18390 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18391 Router rules processing behavior.
18392
18393 This is best illustrated in an example:
18394 .code
18395 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18396 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18397
18398 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18399 true {yes} {no}}
18400
18401 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18402 {yes} {no}}
18403 .endd
18404 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18405 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18406 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18407 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18408 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18409 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18410 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18411 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18412
18413 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18414 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18415 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18416 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18417 string characters.
18418
18419 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18420 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18421 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18422 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18423 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18424
18425
18426 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18427 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18428 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18429 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18430 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18431 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18432 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18433 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18434 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18435 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18436 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18437 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18438 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18439 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18440
18441
18442
18443 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18444 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18445 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18446 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18447 transport option of the same name.
18448
18449 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18450 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18451 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18452 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18453 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18454 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18455 the dnssec request bit set.
18456 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18457
18458 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18459 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18460 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18461 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18462 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18463 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18464 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18465 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18466 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18467
18468
18469 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18470 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18471 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18472 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18473 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18474 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18475 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18476 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18477
18478
18479
18480 .option driver routers string unset
18481 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18482 to be used.
18483
18484
18485 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18486 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18487 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18488 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18489 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18490 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18491 Not effective on redirect routers.
18492
18493
18494
18495 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18496 .cindex "envelope from"
18497 .cindex "envelope sender"
18498 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18499 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18500 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18501 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18502 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18503 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18504 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18505
18506 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18507 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18508 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18509 setting.
18510
18511 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18512 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18513 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18514 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18515
18516 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18517 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18518 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18519 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18520 settings:
18521 .code
18522 errors_to =
18523 errors_to = ""
18524 .endd
18525 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18526 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18527 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18528 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18529 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18530
18531 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18532 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18533 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18534 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18535 setting &%return_path%&.
18536
18537 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18538 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18539 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18540
18541
18542
18543 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18544 .cindex "address" "testing"
18545 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18546 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18547 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18548 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18549 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18550 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18551 on for the system alias file.
18552 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18553 are evaluated.
18554
18555 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18556 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18557 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18558
18559
18560
18561 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18562 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18563 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18564 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18565
18566
18567
18568 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18569 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18570 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18571
18572
18573
18574 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18575 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18576 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18577
18578
18579
18580 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18581 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18582 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18583 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18584 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18585 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18586 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18587 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18588 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18589
18590 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18591 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18592 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18593 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18594 transport for further details.
18595
18596
18597 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18598 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18599 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18600 .cindex "transport" "local"
18601 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18602 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18603 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18604 process.
18605 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18606 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18607 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18608 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18609 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18610
18611
18612
18613 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18614 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18615 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18616 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18617 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18618 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18619 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18620 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18621 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18622 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18623 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18624 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18625 &"see"& the added header lines.
18626
18627 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18628 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18629 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18630 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18631
18632 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18633 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18634
18635 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18636 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18637
18638 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18639 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18640 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18641 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18642 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18643 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18644 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18645 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18646 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18647 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18648
18649
18650
18651 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18652 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18653 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18654 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18655 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18656 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18657 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
18658 Each list item is separately expanded, at routing time.
18659 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the same prefix.
18660 The way in which
18661 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18662 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18663 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18664 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18665 &"see"& the original header lines.
18666
18667 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18668 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18669 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18670 errors.
18671
18672 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18673 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18674
18675 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18676 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18677
18678 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18679 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18680 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18681 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18682
18683 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18684 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18685 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18686
18687
18688
18689 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18690 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18691 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18692 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18693 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18694 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18695 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18696 like
18697 .code
18698 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18699 .endd
18700 by setting
18701 .code
18702 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18703 .endd
18704 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18705 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18706 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18707 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18708 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18709 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18710
18711 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18712 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18713 .code
18714 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18715 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18716 .endd
18717 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18718 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18719
18720 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18721 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18722 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18723 domain that is being routed.
18724
18725 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18726 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18727 checked.
18728
18729 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18730 .cindex "additional groups"
18731 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18732 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18733 .cindex "transport" "local"
18734 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18735 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18736 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18737 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18738 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18739
18740
18741
18742 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18743 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18744 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18745 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18746 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18747 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18748 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18749 evaluated.
18750
18751 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18752 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18753 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18754 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18755 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18756 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18757 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18758 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18759 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18760
18761 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18762 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18763 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18764 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18765 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18766 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18767 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18768 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18769 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18770 the relevant transport.
18771
18772 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18773 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18774 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18775 callout.
18776
18777 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18778 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18779 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18780 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18781 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18782 .code
18783 real_localuser:
18784 driver = accept
18785 local_part_prefix = real-
18786 check_local_user
18787 transport = local_delivery
18788 .endd
18789 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18790 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18791 .code
18792 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18793 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18794 .endd
18795
18796 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18797 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18798 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18799 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18800
18801
18802 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18803 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18804
18805
18806
18807 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18808 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18809 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18810 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18811 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18812 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18813 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18814 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18815 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18816 &%username-foo%&.
18817
18818
18819 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18820 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18821
18822
18823
18824 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18825 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18826 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18827 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18828 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18829 are evaluated, and
18830 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18831 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18832 example:
18833 .code
18834 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18835 .endd
18836 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18837 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18838 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18839 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18840 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18841 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18842 each virtual domain:
18843 .code
18844 postmaster:
18845 driver = redirect
18846 local_parts = postmaster
18847 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18848 .endd
18849
18850
18851 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18852 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18853 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18854 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18855 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18856 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18857 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18858 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18859 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18860 redirect addresses.
18861
18862
18863
18864 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18865 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18866 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18867 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18868 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18869 delivery to be deferred.
18870
18871 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18872 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18873 .oindex "&%self%&"
18874 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18875 means of the setting
18876 .code
18877 self = pass
18878 .endd
18879 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18880 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18881 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18882
18883 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18884 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18885 controls what happens next.
18886
18887
18888 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18889 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18890 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18891 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18892 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18893 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18894 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18895 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18896
18897 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18898 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18899 applies to all of them.
18900
18901
18902
18903 .option pass_router routers string unset
18904 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18905 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18906 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18907 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18908 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18909 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18910 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18911 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18912 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18913 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18914
18915
18916
18917 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18918 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18919 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18920 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18921 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18922 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18923
18924 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18925 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18926 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18927 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18928
18929
18930
18931 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18932 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18933 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18934 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18935 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18936 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18937 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18938
18939 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18940 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18941 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18942 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18943 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18944
18945 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18946 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18947 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18948 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18949 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18950
18951 .cindex "NFS"
18952 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18953 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18954 unavailable.
18955
18956 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18957 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18958 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18959 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18960 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18961 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18962 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18963 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18964
18965 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18966 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18967 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18968 operates as follows:
18969
18970 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18971 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18972 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18973 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18974 used. For example:
18975 .code
18976 require_files = mail:/some/file
18977 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18978 .endd
18979 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18980 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18981
18982 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18983 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18984 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18985 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18986
18987 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18988 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18989 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18990 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18991 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18992
18993 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18994 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18995 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18996 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18997 check again in that process.
18998
18999 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19000 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19001 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19002 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19003 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19004 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19005 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19006 .code
19007 require_files = +/some/file
19008 .endd
19009 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19010 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19011 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19012
19013
19014
19015 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19016 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19017 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19018 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19019 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19020 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19021 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19022 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19023 latter kind.
19024
19025 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19026 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19027 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19028 &%check_local_user%&,
19029 &%local_parts%&,
19030 &%condition%&,
19031 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19032 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19033 &%senders%& or
19034 &%require_files%&
19035 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19036 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19037 same name.
19038
19039 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19040 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19041 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19042
19043 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19044 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19045 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19046
19047
19048
19049 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19050 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19051 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19052 .vindex "&$home$&"
19053 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19054 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19055 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19056 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19057 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19058 cause the router to defer.
19059
19060 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19061 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19062 place.
19063 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19064 are evaluated.)
19065 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19066 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19067
19068 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19069 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19070 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19071 of these values that is set:
19072
19073 .ilist
19074 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19075 .next
19076 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19077 .next
19078 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19079 .next
19080 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19081 .endlist
19082
19083 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19084 router, but not for the transport.
19085
19086
19087
19088 .option self routers string freeze
19089 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19090 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19091 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19092 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19093 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19094 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19095 of remote hosts.
19096 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19097 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19098 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19099 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19100 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19101
19102 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19103 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19104 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19105 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19106 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19107 cases:
19108
19109 .vlist
19110 .vitem &%defer%&
19111 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19112
19113 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19114 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19115 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19116 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19117
19118 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19119 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19120 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19121 rewritten.
19122
19123 .vitem &%pass%&
19124 .oindex "&%more%&"
19125 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19126 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19127 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19128 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19129 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19130 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19131 combination
19132 .code
19133 self = pass
19134 no_more
19135 .endd
19136 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19137 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19138 be passed to the next router.
19139
19140 .vitem &%fail%&
19141 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19142
19143 .vitem &%send%&
19144 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19145 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19146 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19147 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19148 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19149 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19150 .endlist
19151
19152
19153
19154 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19155 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19156 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19157 address matches something on the list.
19158 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19159 are evaluated.
19160
19161 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19162 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19163 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19164 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19165 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19166 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19167 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19168 matters.
19169
19170
19171 .option set routers "string list" unset
19172 .cindex router variables
19173 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19174 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19175 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19176 usual way.
19177
19178 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19179 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19180 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19181 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19182 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19183 the address.
19184 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19185 The variables can be used by the router options
19186 (not including any preconditions)
19187 and by the transport.
19188 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19189 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19190
19191 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19192 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19193
19194
19195 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19196 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19197 .cindex "packet radio"
19198 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19199 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19200 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19201 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19202 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19203 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19204 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19205 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19206
19207 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19208 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19209 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19210 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19211 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19212 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19213 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19214 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19215 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19216 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19217 .code
19218 translate_ip_address = \
19219 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19220 {$value}fail}}
19221 .endd
19222 The file would contain lines like
19223 .code
19224 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19225 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19226 .endd
19227 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19228 are doing.
19229
19230
19231
19232 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19233 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19234 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19235 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19236 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19237 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19238 delivery is deferred.
19239
19240 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19241 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19242 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19243
19244
19245
19246 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19247 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19248 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19249 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19250 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19251 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19252 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19253 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19254 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19255 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19256 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19257 environment.
19258
19259
19260
19261
19262 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19263 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19264 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19265 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19266 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19267 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19268 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19269 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19270 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19271 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19272
19273 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19274 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19275 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19276 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19277 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19278
19279 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19280 environment.
19281
19282
19283
19284
19285 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19286 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19287 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19288 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19289 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19290 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19291 delivery to be deferred.
19292
19293 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19294 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19295 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19296 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19297 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19298 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19299
19300 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19301 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19302 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19303 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19304 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19305 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19306 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19307 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19308
19309 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19310 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19311 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19312 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19313 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19314 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19315 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19316 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19317 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19318 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19319
19320 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19321 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19322 subsequent routers.
19323
19324
19325 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19326 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19327 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19328 .cindex "transport" "local"
19329 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19330 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19331 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19332 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19333 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19334 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19335 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19336 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19337 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19338 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19339 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19340 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19341
19342
19343
19344 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19345 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19346 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19347
19348
19349 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19350 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19351 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
19352 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19353 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19354 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19355 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19356 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19357 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19358 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19359
19360 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19361 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19362 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19363 user or group.
19364
19365
19366 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19367 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19368 addresses,
19369 delivering in cutthrough mode
19370 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19371 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19372 are evaluated.
19373 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19374
19375
19376 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19377 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19378 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19379 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19380 are evaluated.
19381 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19382 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19383 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19384
19385
19386
19387
19388
19389
19390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19391 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19392
19393 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19394 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19395 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19396 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19397 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19398 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19399 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19400 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19401 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19402 .code
19403 localusers:
19404 driver = accept
19405 domains = mydomain.example
19406 check_local_user
19407 transport = local_delivery
19408 .endd
19409 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19410 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19411 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19412 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19413
19414
19415
19416
19417
19418
19419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19421
19422 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19423 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19424 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19425 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19426 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19427 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19428
19429 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19430 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19431 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19432 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19433 records.
19434
19435 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19436 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19437 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19438 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19439 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19440 generic option, the router declines.
19441
19442 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19443 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19444 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19445
19446 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19447 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19448 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19449 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19450 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19451 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19452
19453
19454 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19455 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19456 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19457 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19458 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19459 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19460
19461 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19462 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19463 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19464 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19465 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19466 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19467 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19468 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19469 case routing fails.
19470
19471
19472 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19473 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19474 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19475 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19476 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19477
19478 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19479 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19480
19481 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19482 .ilist
19483 The domain does not exist in DNS
19484 .next
19485 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19486 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19487 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19488 .next
19489 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19490 .next
19491 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19492 .next
19493 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19494 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19495 .next
19496 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19497 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19498 .next
19499 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19500 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19501 .next
19502 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19503 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19504 .endlist
19505
19506
19507
19508
19509 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19510 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19511 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19512
19513 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19514 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19515 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19516 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19517 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19518 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19519 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19520
19521
19522 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19523 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19524 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19525 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19526 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19527 required. For example,
19528 .code
19529 check_srv = smtp
19530 .endd
19531 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19532 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19533 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19534 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19535 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19536 normal way.
19537
19538 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19539 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19540 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19541 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19542 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19543 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19544
19545 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19546 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19547 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19548 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19549 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19550 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19551 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19552 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19553
19554 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19555 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19556
19557
19558
19559
19560 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19561 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19562 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19563 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19564 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19565 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19566 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19567 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19568 also being queued.
19569
19570
19571 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19572 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19573 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19574 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19575 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19576 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19577 only A records are used.
19578
19579 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19580 .cindex IPv4 preference
19581 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19582 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19583 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19584 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19585 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19586
19587 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19588 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19589 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19590 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19591 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19592 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19593 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19594 setting:
19595 .code
19596 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19597 .endd
19598 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19599 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19600 the address record.
19601
19602
19603 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19604 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19605 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19606 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19607
19608
19609
19610
19611 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19612 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19613 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19614 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19615 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19616 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19617 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19618 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19619 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19620 &'resolv.conf'&.
19621
19622
19623
19624 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19625 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19626 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19627 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19628 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19629 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19630 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19631 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19632 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19633 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19634 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19635
19636 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19637 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19638 sense.
19639
19640 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19641 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19642 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19643 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19644 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19645 header rewriting.
19646
19647
19648 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19649 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19650 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19651 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19652 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19653 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19654 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19655 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19656
19657 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19658 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19659 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19660 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19661 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19662 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19663 without processing them independently,
19664 provided the following conditions are met:
19665
19666 .ilist
19667 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19668 &%headers_remove%&.
19669 .next
19670 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19671 the domain.
19672 .endlist
19673
19674
19675
19676
19677 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19678 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19679 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19680 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19681 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19682 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19683 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19684 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19685 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19686 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19687
19688 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19689 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19690 local wildcard.
19691
19692
19693
19694 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19695 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19696 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19697 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19698
19699
19700
19701
19702 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19703 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19704 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19705 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19706 if
19707 .code
19708 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19709 .endd
19710 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19711 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19712 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19713 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19714 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19715 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19716
19717
19718 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19719 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19720 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19721 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19722 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19723
19724 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19725 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19726 such as that implied by
19727 .code
19728 domains = @mx_any
19729 .endd
19730 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19731 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19732 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19733 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19734
19735
19736
19737
19738
19739
19740
19741
19742
19743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19745
19746 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19747 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19748 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19749 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19750 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19751 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19752 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19753 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19754 router handles the address
19755 .code
19756 root@[192.168.1.1]
19757 .endd
19758 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19759 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19760 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19761 .code
19762 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19763 .endd
19764 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19765 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19766
19767 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19768 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19769 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19770 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19771
19772 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19773 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19774 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19775 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19776
19777
19778
19779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19780 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19781
19782 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19783 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19784 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19785 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19786 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19787 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19788 must set
19789 .code
19790 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19791 .endd
19792 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19793
19794 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19795 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19796 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19797 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19798 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19799 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19800 must not be specified for it.
19801
19802 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19803 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19804 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19805 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19806 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19807 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19808 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19809
19810
19811 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19812 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19813 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19814 delivery to the address is deferred.
19815
19816
19817 .option port iplookup integer 0
19818 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19819 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19820 call.
19821
19822
19823 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19824 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19825 protocols is to be used.
19826
19827
19828 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19829 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19830 default value is:
19831 .code
19832 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19833 .endd
19834 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19835 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19836
19837
19838 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19839 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19840 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19841 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19842 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19843 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19844 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19845 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19846
19847
19848 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19849 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19850 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19851 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19852 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19853 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19854 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19855 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19856 following could be used:
19857 .code
19858 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19859 reroute = $local_part@$1
19860 .endd
19861
19862 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19863 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19864 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19865 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19866
19867
19868
19869
19870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19871 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19872
19873 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19874 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19875 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19876 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19877 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19878 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19879 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19880 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19881 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19882 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19883
19884 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19885 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19886 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19887 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19888 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19889 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19890 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19891
19892 .vindex "&$host$&"
19893 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19894 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19895 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19896 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19897 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19898 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19899 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19900 text string.
19901
19902 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19903 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19904 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19905 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19906 below, following the list of private options.
19907
19908
19909 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19910
19911 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19912 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19913
19914 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19915 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19916
19917 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19918 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19919 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19920 of the following values:
19921 .code
19922 decline
19923 defer
19924 fail
19925 freeze
19926 ignore
19927 pass
19928 .endd
19929 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19930 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19931 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19932 &%pass_router%&),
19933 .oindex "&%more%&"
19934 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19935 router only if &%more%& is true.
19936
19937 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19938 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19939 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19940 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19941
19942 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19943 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19944 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19945
19946
19947 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19948 .cindex "randomized host list"
19949 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19950 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19951 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19952 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19953 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19954 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19955 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19956 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19957
19958 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19959 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19960 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19961 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19962 .code
19963 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19964 .endd
19965 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19966 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19967 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19968 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19969 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19970
19971
19972 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19973 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19974 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19975 example:
19976 .code
19977 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19978 .endd
19979 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19980 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19981 deferred.
19982
19983
19984 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19985 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19986 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19987 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19988
19989
19990 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19991 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19992 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19993 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19994 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19995 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19996 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19997 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19998
19999 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20000 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20001 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20002 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20003 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20004 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20005 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20006 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20007
20008
20009
20010
20011 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20012 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20013 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20014 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20015 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20016 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20017 .display
20018 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20019 .endd
20020 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20021 no options:
20022 .code
20023 route_list = \
20024 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20025 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20026 .endd
20027 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20028 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20029 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20030 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20031 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20032 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20033 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20034 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20035 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20036 in a &%route_list%&).
20037
20038 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20039 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20040 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20041 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20042
20043
20044
20045 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20046 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20047 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20048 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20049 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20050 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20051 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20052 like this:
20053 .code
20054 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20055 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20056 .endd
20057 This data can be accessed by setting
20058 .code
20059 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20060 .endd
20061 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20062 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20063 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20064 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20065 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20066
20067
20068
20069
20070 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20071 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20072 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20073 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20074 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20075 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20076 The format of each item
20077 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20078 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20079
20080 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20081 variables are set during its expansion:
20082
20083 .ilist
20084 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20085 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20086 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20087 .code
20088 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20089 .endd
20090 .next
20091 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20092 .next
20093 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20094
20095 .next
20096 .vindex "&$value$&"
20097 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20098 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20099 .code
20100 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20101 .endd
20102 .endlist
20103
20104 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20105 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20106
20107
20108
20109 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20110 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20111 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20112 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20113 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20114 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20115
20116 .ilist
20117 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20118 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20119 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20120 .code
20121 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20122 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20123 .endd
20124 .next
20125 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20126 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20127 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20128 number follows. For example:
20129 .code
20130 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20131 .endd
20132 .endlist
20133
20134 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20135 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20136 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20137 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20138 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20139 transport.
20140
20141 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20142 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20143 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20144 records in the DNS. For example:
20145 .code
20146 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20147 .endd
20148 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20149 example:
20150 .code
20151 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20152 .endd
20153 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20154 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20155 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20156 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20157 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20158 happens is controlled by the
20159 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20160 &%self%& option of the router.
20161
20162 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20163 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20164 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20165 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20166 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20167 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20168 defined by MX preferences.
20169
20170 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20171 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20172 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20173
20174 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20175 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20176 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20177 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20178
20179 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20180 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20181 router.
20182
20183 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20184 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20185 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20186
20187 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20188 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20189
20190
20191
20192 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20193 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20194 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20195 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20196 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20197 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20198 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20199
20200 .ilist
20201 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20202 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20203 .next
20204 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20205 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20206 .next
20207 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20208 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20209 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20210 .next
20211 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20212 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20213 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20214 .next
20215 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20216 .next
20217 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20218 .endlist
20219
20220 For example:
20221 .code
20222 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20223 domain2 host4:host5
20224 .endd
20225 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20226 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20227 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20228 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20229 call.
20230
20231 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20232 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20233 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20234 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20235 function called.
20236
20237 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20238 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20239 option specified.
20240
20241
20242
20243 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20244 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20245
20246 .vindex "&$host$&"
20247 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20248 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20249
20250
20251
20252 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20253 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20254 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20255
20256 .ilist
20257 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20258 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20259 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20260 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20261 .code
20262 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20263 .endd
20264 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20265 your first router something like this:
20266 .code
20267 smart_route:
20268 driver = manualroute
20269 domains = !+local_domains
20270 transport = remote_smtp
20271 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20272 .endd
20273 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20274 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20275 they are tried in order
20276 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20277 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20278 .code
20279 smart_route:
20280 driver = manualroute
20281 transport = remote_smtp
20282 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20283 .endd
20284 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20285 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20286 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20287 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20288 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20289 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20290 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20291 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20292
20293 .next
20294 .cindex "mail hub example"
20295 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20296 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20297 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20298 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20299 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20300 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20301 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20302 lookup is easier to manage.
20303
20304 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20305 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20306 example:
20307 .code
20308 hub_route:
20309 driver = manualroute
20310 transport = remote_smtp
20311 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20312 .endd
20313 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20314 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20315 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20316 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20317 domain can be used to find the host:
20318 .code
20319 through_firewall:
20320 driver = manualroute
20321 transport = remote_smtp
20322 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20323 .endd
20324 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20325 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20326 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20327 next router.
20328
20329 .next
20330 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20331 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20332 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20333 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20334 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20335 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20336 .code
20337 save_in_file:
20338 driver = manualroute
20339 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20340 route_list = saved.domain.example
20341 .endd
20342 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20343 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20344 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20345 .code
20346 save_in_file:
20347 driver = manualroute
20348 route_list = \
20349 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20350 *.saved.domain2.example \
20351 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20352 batch_pipe
20353 .endd
20354 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20355 .vindex "&$host$&"
20356 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20357 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20358 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20359 the address if the lookup fails.
20360
20361 .next
20362 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20363 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20364 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20365 one way it can be done:
20366 .code
20367 # Transport
20368 uucp:
20369 driver = pipe
20370 user = nobody
20371 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20372 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20373 return_fail_output = true
20374
20375 # Router
20376 uucphost:
20377 transport = uucp
20378 driver = manualroute
20379 route_data = \
20380 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20381 .endd
20382 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20383 .code
20384 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20385 .endd
20386 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20387 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20388 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20389 .endlist
20390 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20391 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20392
20393
20394
20395
20396
20397
20398
20399
20400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20402
20403 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20404 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20405 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20406 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20407 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20408 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20409 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20410 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20411 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20412 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20413 options:
20414 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20415
20416 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20417 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20418 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20419 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20420 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20421
20422
20423 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20424 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20425 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20426 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20427 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20428 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20429
20430
20431 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20432 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20433 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20434 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20435 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20436 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20437 not set, a value for the gid also.
20438
20439 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20440 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20441 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20442 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20443 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20444 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20445 gid.
20446
20447
20448 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20449 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20450 before running the command.
20451
20452
20453 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20454 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20455 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20456 timeout.
20457
20458
20459 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20460 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20461 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20462 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20463 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20464
20465 .ilist
20466 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20467 below).
20468 .next
20469 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20470 &%no_more%& is set.
20471 .next
20472 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20473 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20474 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20475 included in the SMTP response.
20476 .next
20477 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20478 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20479 included in any SMTP response.
20480 .next
20481 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20482 .next
20483 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20484 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20485 .next
20486 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20487 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20488 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20489 .endlist
20490
20491 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20492 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20493 the page):
20494 .code
20495 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20496 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20497 .endd
20498 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20499 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20500 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20501 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20502
20503 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20504 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20505 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20506 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20507 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20508
20509 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20510 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20511 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20512 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20513 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20514
20515 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20516 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20517 variable. For example, this return line
20518 .code
20519 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20520 .endd
20521 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20522 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20523 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20524 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20525
20526
20527
20528
20529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20531
20532 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20533 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20534 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20535 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20536 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20537 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20538 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20539 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20540 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20541 redirected in several different ways:
20542
20543 .ilist
20544 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20545 independently.
20546 .next
20547 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20548 .next
20549 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20550 .next
20551 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20552 .next
20553 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20554 .next
20555 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20556 .next
20557 It can be discarded.
20558 .endlist
20559
20560 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20561 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20562 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20563 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20564
20565 If success DSNs have been requested
20566 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20567 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20568 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20569
20570
20571
20572 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20573 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20574 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20575 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20576 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20577 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20578 .code
20579 system_aliases:
20580 driver = redirect
20581 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20582 .endd
20583 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20584 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20585 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20586 cause delivery to be deferred.
20587
20588 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20589 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20590 .code
20591 userforward:
20592 driver = redirect
20593 check_local_user
20594 file = $home/.forward
20595 no_verify
20596 .endd
20597 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20598 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20599 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20600 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20601 comments.
20602
20603 .new
20604 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20605 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
20606 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20607
20608 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20609 directly for redirection,
20610 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20611 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20612 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20613 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20614 .wen
20615
20616
20617
20618 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20619 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20620 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20621 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20622
20623 .ilist
20624 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20625 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20626 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20627 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20628 .next
20629 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20630 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20631 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20632 saves some resources.
20633 .endlist
20634
20635
20636
20637
20638
20639
20640 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20641 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20642 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20643 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20644 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20645
20646 .ilist
20647 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20648 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20649 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20650 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20651 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20652 document is intended for use by end users.
20653 .next
20654 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20655 described in the next section.
20656 .endlist
20657
20658 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20659 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20660 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20661 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20662 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20663
20664
20665
20666 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20667 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20668 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20669 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20670 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20671 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20672 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20673 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20674 commas or newlines.
20675 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20676 quotes.
20677
20678 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20679 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20680 next newline character is ignored.
20681
20682 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20683 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20684 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20685 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20686 removed.
20687
20688 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20689 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20690 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20691 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20692 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20693 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20694 setting:
20695 .code
20696 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20697 .endd
20698
20699
20700 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20701 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20702 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20703 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20704 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20705 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20706 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20707 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20708 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20709 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20710 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20711
20712 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20713 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20714 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20715 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20716 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20717 .code
20718 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20719 .endd
20720 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20721 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20722 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20723 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20724 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20725 synonymously.
20726
20727 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20728 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20729 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20730 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20731 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20732
20733 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20734 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20735 contains:
20736 .code
20737 Sam.Reman: spqr
20738 .endd
20739 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20740 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20741 this forward file:
20742 .code
20743 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20744 .endd
20745 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20746 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20747 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20748 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20749 should really contain
20750 .code
20751 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20752 .endd
20753 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20754 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20755 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20756
20757
20758
20759 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20760 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20761 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20762
20763 .ilist
20764 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20765 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20766 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20767 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20768 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20769 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20770 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20771
20772 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20773 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20774 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20775 in double quotes, for example:
20776 .code
20777 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20778 .endd
20779 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20780 quote just the command. An item such as
20781 .code
20782 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20783 .endd
20784 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20785
20786 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20787 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20788 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20789 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20790 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20791 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20792 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20793 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20794 an &%accept%& router.
20795
20796 .next
20797 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20798 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20799 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20800 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20801 .code
20802 /home/world/minbari
20803 .endd
20804 is treated as a filename, but
20805 .code
20806 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20807 .endd
20808 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20809 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20810 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20811 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20812
20813 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20814 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20815
20816 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20817 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20818 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20819 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20820
20821 .next
20822 .cindex "included address list"
20823 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20824 If an item is of the form
20825 .code
20826 :include:<path name>
20827 .endd
20828 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20829 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20830 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20831 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20832 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20833 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20834 .code
20835 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20836 .endd
20837 It must be given as
20838 .code
20839 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20840 .endd
20841 .new
20842 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20843 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
20844 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20845 .wen
20846 .next
20847 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20848 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20849 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20850 .cindex "black hole"
20851 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20852 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20853 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20854 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20855 .code
20856 :blackhole:
20857 .endd
20858 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20859 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20860 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20861
20862 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20863 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20864 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20865 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20866 &_/dev/null_&.
20867
20868 .next
20869 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20870 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20871 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20872 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20873 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20874 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20875 redirection items of the form
20876 .code
20877 :defer:
20878 :fail:
20879 .endd
20880 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20881 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20882 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20883 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20884 .code
20885 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20886 .endd
20887 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20888 of a
20889 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20890 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20891 default.
20892 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20893 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20894 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20895
20896 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20897 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20898 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20899 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20900 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20901 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20902 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20903 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20904 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20905 ignored.
20906
20907 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20908 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20909 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20910 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20911
20912 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20913 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20914 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20915 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20916 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20917
20918 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20919 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20920 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20921 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20922 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20923 rules still apply.
20924
20925 .next
20926 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20927 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20928 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20929 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20930 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20931 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20932 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20933 .endlist
20934
20935
20936 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20937 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20938 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20939 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20940 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20941 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20942 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20943 aliasing scheme of the type
20944 .code
20945 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20946 localpart1: pipe
20947 localpart2: pipe
20948 .endd
20949 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20950 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20951 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20952 such as
20953 .code
20954 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20955 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20956 .endd
20957 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20958 the pipes are distinct.
20959
20960
20961
20962 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20963 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20964 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20965 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20966 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20967 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20968 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20969 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20970 can be used to avoid this.
20971
20972
20973 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20974 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20975 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20976 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20977 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20978 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20979 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20980
20981
20982
20983 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20984
20985 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20986 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20987
20988
20989 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20990 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20991 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20992
20993
20994 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20995 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20996 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20997 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20998
20999
21000 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21001 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21002 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21003 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21004 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21005 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21006 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21007
21008 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21009 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21010
21011
21012 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21013 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21014 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21015 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21016 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21017
21018
21019
21020 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21021 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21022 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21023 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21024 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21025 let ordinary users do.
21026
21027
21028
21029 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21030 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21031 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21032 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21033 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21034 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21035
21036 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21037 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21038 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21039 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21040 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21041 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21042 .code
21043 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21044 .endd
21045 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21046 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21047 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21048 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21049 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21050 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21051 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21052 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21053
21054
21055 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21056 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21057 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21058 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21059 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21060 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21061 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21062 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21063
21064
21065
21066 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21067 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21068 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21069 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21070 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21071 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21072
21073
21074 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21075 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21076 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21077 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21078 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21079 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21080
21081 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21082 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21083 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21084 .code
21085 data = #Exim filter\n\
21086 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21087 .endd
21088 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21089 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21090 choice into a newline.
21091
21092
21093 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21094 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21095 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21096 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21097 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21098
21099
21100 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21101 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21102 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21103 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21104 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21105 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21106 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21107 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21108
21109 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21110 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21111 runs a check on the containing directory,
21112 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21113 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21114 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21115 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21116 not, the router declines.
21117
21118
21119 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21120 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21121 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21122 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21123 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21124 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21125 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21126
21127
21128 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21129 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21130 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21131 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21132 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21133
21134
21135 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21136 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21137 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21138 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21139 redirection list.
21140
21141
21142 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21143 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21144 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21145 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21146 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21147
21148
21149
21150
21151 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21152 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21153 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21154 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21155 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21156 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21157 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21158 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21159 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21160 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21161 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21162
21163
21164 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21165 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21166 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21167 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21168 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21169 functions.
21170
21171 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21172 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21173 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21174 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21175 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21176 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21177
21178 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21179 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21180 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21181 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21182 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21183 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21184 &_.forward_& files).
21185
21186
21187 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21188 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21189 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21190 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21191 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21192
21193
21194 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21195 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21196 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21197 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21198 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21199 of the embedded Perl support.
21200
21201
21202 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21203 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21204 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21205 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21206 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21207
21208
21209 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21210 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21211 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21212 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21213 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21214
21215
21216 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21217 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21218 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21219 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21220 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21221 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21222 &%one_time%& is set.
21223
21224
21225 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21226 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21227 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21228 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21229 to make use of &%run%& items.
21230
21231
21232 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21233 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21234 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21235 If this option is true, items of the form
21236 .code
21237 :include:<path name>
21238 .endd
21239 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21240
21241
21242 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21243 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21244 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21245 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21246 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21247 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21248 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21249
21250
21251 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21252 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21253 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21254 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21255 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21256
21257
21258 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21259 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21260 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21261 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21262 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21263
21264
21265
21266
21267 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21268 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21269 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21270 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21271 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21272 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21273 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21274
21275
21276 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21277 .cindex "EACCES"
21278 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21279 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21280 file did not exist.
21281
21282
21283 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21284 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
21285 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21286 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21287 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21288
21289 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21290 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21291 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21292 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21293 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21294 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21295 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21296 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21297
21298
21299
21300 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21301 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21302 redirection list must start with this directory.
21303
21304
21305 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21306 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21307 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21308
21309
21310 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21311 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21312 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21313 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21314 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21315 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21316 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21317 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21318 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21319 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21320 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21321 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21322 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21323 before they subscribed.
21324
21325 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21326 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21327 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21328 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21329 attempt.
21330
21331 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21332 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21333 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21334 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21335
21336 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21337 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21338 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21339
21340 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21341 &%one_time%&.
21342
21343 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21344 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21345 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21346 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21347 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21348 expansion.
21349
21350
21351 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21352 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21353 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21354 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21355 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21356 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21357 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21358 See &%check_owner%& above.
21359
21360
21361 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21362 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21363 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21364 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21365
21366
21367 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21368 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21369 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21370 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21371 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21372 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21373 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21374
21375
21376 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21377 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21378 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21379 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21380 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21381 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21382 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21383 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21384
21385 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21386 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21387 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21388 addresses.
21389
21390 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21391 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21392 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21393 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21394 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21395 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21396 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21397 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21398 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21399 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21400
21401
21402 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21403 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21404 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21405 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21406 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21407 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21408
21409
21410 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21411 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21412 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21413 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21414 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21415 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21416
21417
21418 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21419 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21420 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21421 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21422 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21423
21424
21425 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21426 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21427 :subaddress part of an address.
21428
21429 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21430 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21431 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21432 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21433
21434
21435 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21436 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21437 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21438 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21439 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21440 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21441 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21442
21443
21444
21445 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21446 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21447 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21448 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21449 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21450 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21451 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21452 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21453 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21454 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21455 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21456 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21457 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21458 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21459 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21460 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21461
21462 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21463 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21464 the following routers.
21465
21466 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21467 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21468 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21469 so it is passed to the following routers.
21470
21471 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21472 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21473 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21474 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21475
21476 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21477 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21478 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21479 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21480 .code
21481 userforward:
21482 driver = redirect
21483 allow_filter
21484 check_local_user
21485 file = $home/.forward
21486 file_transport = address_file
21487 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21488 reply_transport = address_reply
21489 no_verify
21490 skip_syntax_errors
21491 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21492 syntax_errors_text = \
21493 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21494 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21495 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21496 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21497 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21498 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21499 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21500 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21501 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21502 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21503 .endd
21504 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21505 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21506 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21507 .code
21508 real_localuser:
21509 driver = accept
21510 check_local_user
21511 local_part_prefix = real-
21512 transport = local_delivery
21513 .endd
21514 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21515 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21516 .code
21517 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21518 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21519 .endd
21520
21521
21522 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21523 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21524
21525
21526 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21527 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21528 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21529 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21530
21531
21532
21533
21534
21535
21536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21537 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21538
21539 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21540 "Environment for local transports"
21541 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21542 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21543 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21544 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21545 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21546 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21547 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21548
21549 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21550 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21551 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21552 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21553
21554 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21555 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21556 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21557 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21558 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21559
21560
21561
21562 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21563 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21564 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21565 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21566 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21567 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21568 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21569 time.
21570
21571 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21572 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21573 .code
21574 my_transport:
21575 driver = pipe
21576 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21577 .endd
21578 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21579 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21580 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21581 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21582
21583
21584
21585
21586 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21587 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21588 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21589 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21590 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21591 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21592 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21593 group (set by the transport). For example:
21594 .code
21595 # Routers ...
21596 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21597 local_users:
21598 driver = accept
21599 check_local_user
21600 transport = group_delivery
21601
21602 # Transports ...
21603 # This transport overrides the group
21604 group_delivery:
21605 driver = appendfile
21606 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21607 group = mail
21608 .endd
21609 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21610 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21611 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21612 set.
21613
21614 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21615 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21616 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21617 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21618 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21619 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21620
21621 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21622 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21623 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21624 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21625 original gid is also used.
21626
21627 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21628 following that is set is used:
21629
21630 .ilist
21631 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21632 .next
21633 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21634 .next
21635 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21636 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21637 .next
21638 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21639 .next
21640 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21641 the uid is the creator's uid;
21642 .next
21643 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21644 .endlist
21645
21646 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21647 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21648 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21649 The first of the following that is set is used:
21650
21651 .ilist
21652 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21653 .next
21654 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21655 .next
21656 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21657 .next
21658 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21659 .next
21660 The Exim uid.
21661 .endlist
21662
21663 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21664 &%never_users%& list.
21665
21666
21667
21668
21669
21670 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21671 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21672 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21673 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21674 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21675 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21676 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21677 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21678 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21679 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21680
21681 .ilist
21682 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21683 .next
21684 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21685 .next
21686 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21687 .next
21688 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21689 .endlist
21690
21691 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21692
21693 .ilist
21694 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21695 .next
21696 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21697 .endlist
21698
21699
21700 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21701 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21702 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21703
21704
21705
21706 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21707 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21708 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21709 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21710 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21711 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21712 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21713 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21714 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21715 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21716 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21717 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21718 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21719 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21720
21721
21722
21723
21724
21725
21726
21727 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21729
21730 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21731 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21732 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21733 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21734 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21735
21736
21737 .option body_only transports boolean false
21738 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21739 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21740 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21741 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21742 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21743 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21744 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21745 automatically suppress them.
21746
21747
21748 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21749 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21750 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21751 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21752 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21753 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21754
21755
21756 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21757 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21758 deliveries by the transport or for any
21759 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21760 what you are doing.
21761
21762
21763 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21764 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21765 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21766 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21767 transport is run.
21768 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21769 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21770 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21771 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21772 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21773 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21774 one.
21775 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21776 transport and the router that called it.
21777
21778 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21779 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21780 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21781 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21782 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21783 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21784 safely be resent to other recipients.
21785
21786
21787 .option driver transports string unset
21788 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21789 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21790
21791
21792 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21793 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21794 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21795 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21796 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21797 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21798 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21799 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21800 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21801 resent to other recipients.
21802
21803
21804 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21805 .cindex events
21806 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21807 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21808
21809
21810 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21811 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21812 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21813 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21814 &%user%& (see below).
21815
21816
21817 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21818 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21819 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21820 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21821 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21822 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21823 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21824 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21825 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21826 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21827 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21828
21829 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21830 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21831
21832
21833 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21834 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21835 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21836 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21837 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21838 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21839 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21840 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21841
21842
21843 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21844 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21845 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21846 This option specifies a list of header names,
21847 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21848 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21849 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21850 routers.
21851 Each list item is separately expanded.
21852 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21853 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21854 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21855
21856 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21857 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21858
21859 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21860 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21861 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21862
21863
21864
21865 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21866 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21867 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21868 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21869 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21870 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21871 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21872 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21873 example,
21874 .code
21875 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21876 x@y w@z
21877 .endd
21878 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21879 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21880 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21881 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21882 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21883 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21884 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21885 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21886 change envelope recipients at this time.
21887
21888
21889 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21890 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21891 .vindex "&$home$&"
21892 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21893 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21894 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21895 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21896 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21897 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21898 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21899 deferred.
21900
21901
21902 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21903 .cindex "additional groups"
21904 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21905 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21906 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21907 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21908 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21909
21910
21911 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21912 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21913 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21914 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21915 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21916 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21917 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21918 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21919
21920 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21921 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21922 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21923 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21924 Obviously there is scope for
21925 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21926 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21927
21928 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21929 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21930 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21931 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21932 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21933
21934
21935 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21936 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21937 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21938 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21939 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21940 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21941 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21942 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21943 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21944 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21945 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21946 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21947 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21948 delivered.
21949
21950
21951
21952 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21953 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21954 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21955 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21956 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21957 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21958 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21959 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21960 that contains
21961 .code
21962 local_part_prefix = *-
21963 .endd
21964 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21965 is delivered with
21966 .code
21967 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21968 .endd
21969 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21970 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21971 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21972 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21973 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21974
21975
21976 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21977 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21978 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21979 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21980 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21981 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21982 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21983 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21984 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21985
21986 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21987 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21988 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21989 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21990
21991 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21992 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21993 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21994
21995
21996 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21997 .cindex "envelope sender"
21998 .cindex "envelope from"
21999 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22000 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22001 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22002 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22003 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22004 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22005 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22006 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22007 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22008
22009 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22010 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22011
22012 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22013 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22014 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22015 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22016 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22017 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22018 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22019
22020 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22021 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22022 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22023 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22024 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22025
22026
22027
22028 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22029 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
22030 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22031 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22032 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22033 have easy access to it.
22034
22035 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22036 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22037 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22038 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22039 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22040 recipients.
22041
22042
22043 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22044 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22045
22046
22047 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22048 .cindex "shadow transport"
22049 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22050 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22051 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22052
22053 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22054 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22055 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22056 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22057 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22058 cause a log line to be written.
22059
22060 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22061 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22062 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22063 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22064 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22065 of the form
22066 .code
22067 ST=<shadow transport name>
22068 .endd
22069 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22070 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22071 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22072 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22073 headers that some sites insist on.
22074
22075
22076 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22077 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22078 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22079 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22080 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22081 individual users or via a system filter.
22082 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22083
22084 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22085 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22086 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22087 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22088 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22089
22090 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22091 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22092 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22093 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22094 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22095 &(pipe)& transports.
22096
22097 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22098 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22099 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22100 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22101 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22102
22103 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22104 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22105 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22106 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22107
22108 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22109 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22110 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22111 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22112 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22113 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22114
22115 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22116 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22117 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22118 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22119 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22120 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22121 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22122 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22123
22124 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22125 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22126 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22127 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22128 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22129 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22130 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22131 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22132 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22133 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22134
22135 .vindex "&$host$&"
22136 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22137 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22138 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22139 which the message is being sent. For example:
22140 .code
22141 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22142 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22143 .endd
22144
22145 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22146 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22147 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22148 .ilist
22149 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22150 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22151 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22152 example:
22153 .code
22154 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22155 .endd
22156 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22157 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22158 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22159 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22160 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22161 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22162 .next
22163 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22164 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22165 arguments. Consider this example:
22166 .code
22167 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22168 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22169 .endd
22170 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22171 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22172 .code
22173 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22174 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22175 .endd
22176 .endlist
22177
22178 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22179 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22180 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22181 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22182 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22183 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22184 bounced from a transport filter.
22185
22186 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22187 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22188 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22189
22190
22191 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22192 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22193 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22194 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22195 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22196 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22197 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22198 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22199 becomes a temporary error.
22200
22201
22202 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22203 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22204 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22205 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22206 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22207 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22208 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22209 option is not set.
22210
22211 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22212 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22213 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22214
22215 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22216 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22217 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22218 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22219 retry data.
22220 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22221 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22222 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22223
22224
22225
22226
22227
22228
22229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22231
22232 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22233 "Address batching"
22234 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22235 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22236 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22237 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22238 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22239 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22240 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22241
22242 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22243 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22244 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22245 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22246 local transport, for example:
22247
22248 .ilist
22249 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22250 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22251 recipients saves space.
22252 .next
22253 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22254 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22255 .next
22256 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22257 to a scanner program or
22258 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22259 acceptable.
22260 .endlist
22261
22262 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22263 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22264 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22265
22266 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22267 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22268 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22269 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22270 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22271 to certain conditions:
22272
22273 .ilist
22274 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22275 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22276 batching is possible.
22277 .next
22278 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22279 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22280 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22281 .next
22282 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22283 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22284 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22285 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22286 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22287 from taking place.
22288 .next
22289 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22290 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22291 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22292 be the same.
22293 .endlist
22294
22295 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22296 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22297 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22298 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22299 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22300 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22301 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22302 .code
22303 check_string = "."
22304 escape_string = ".."
22305 .endd
22306 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22307 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22308 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22309
22310 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22311 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22312 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22313 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22314 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22315 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22316
22317 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22318 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22319 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22320 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22321 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22322 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22323 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22324 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22325 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22326
22327
22328
22329
22330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22332
22333 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22334 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22335 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22336 .cindex "directory creation"
22337 .cindex "creating directories"
22338 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22339 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22340 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22341 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22342 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22343 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22344 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22345 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22346 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22347 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22348
22349 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22350 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22351 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22352 included.
22353
22354 .cindex "quota" "system"
22355 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22356 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22357 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22358
22359 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22360 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22361 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22362 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22363
22364 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22365 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22366 private options.
22367
22368 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22369 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22370 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22371 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22372 option).
22373
22374
22375
22376 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22377 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22378 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22379 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22380 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22381
22382 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22383 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22384 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22385 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22386 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22387 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22388 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22389 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22390 operation. There are two cases:
22391
22392 .ilist
22393 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22394 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22395 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22396 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22397 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22398 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22399 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22400 .next
22401 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22402 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22403 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22404 .endlist
22405 .new
22406 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22407 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22408 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22409 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22410 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22411 which returns a path (or component).
22412 .wen
22413
22414
22415 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22416 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22417 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22418 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22419 form:
22420 .code
22421 save folder23
22422 .endd
22423 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22424 .code
22425 require "fileinto";
22426 fileinto "folder23";
22427 .endd
22428 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22429 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22430 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22431 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22432 way of handling this requirement:
22433 .code
22434 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22435 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22436 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22437 {$address_file} \
22438 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22439 }} \
22440 }
22441 .endd
22442 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22443 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22444 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22445
22446 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22447 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22448 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22449 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22450 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22451 path to the transport.
22452
22453 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22454 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22455
22456
22457
22458
22459 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22460 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22461
22462
22463
22464 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22465 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22466 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22467 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22468 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22469 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22470 delivery is deferred.
22471
22472
22473 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22474 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22475 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22476 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22477 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22478 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22479 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22480 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22481
22482
22483 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22484 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22485 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22486 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22487 file.
22488
22489
22490 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22491 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22492
22493
22494 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22495 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22496 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22497 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22498 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22499
22500
22501 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22502 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22503 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22504 process is running.
22505
22506
22507 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22508 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22509 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22510 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22511 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22512 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22513 contains is significant.
22514
22515 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22516 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22517 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22518 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22519 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22520
22521 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22522 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22523 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22524 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22525 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22526 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22527 .code
22528 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22529 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22530 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22531 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22532 .endd
22533 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22534 .cindex "directory creation"
22535 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22536 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22537 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22538
22539 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22540 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22541 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22542 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22543 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22544
22545
22546
22547 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22548 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22549 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22550 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22551 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22552 beneath.
22553
22554 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22555 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22556 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22557 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22558 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22559 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22560 &%file_must_exist%&.
22561
22562
22563 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22564 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22565 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22566 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22567
22568 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22569 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22570 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22571 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22572 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22573
22574
22575 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22576 .cindex "base62"
22577 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22578 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22579 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22580 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22581 .code
22582 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22583 .endd
22584 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22585 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22586 option.
22587
22588
22589 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22590 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22591 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22592
22593
22594 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22595 See &%check_string%& above.
22596
22597
22598 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22599 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22600 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22601 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22602 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22603 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22604 &%file%&.
22605
22606 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22607 .cindex "locking files"
22608 .cindex "lock files"
22609 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22610 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22611
22612 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22613 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22614 examples:
22615 .code
22616 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22617 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22618 file = $home/inbox
22619 .endd
22620 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22621 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22622 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22623 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22624 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22625 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22626
22627
22628
22629 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22630 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22631 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22632 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22633 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22634 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22635 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22636 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22637 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22638 this added to it:
22639 .code
22640 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22641 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22642 .endd
22643 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22644 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22645 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22646 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22647 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22648 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22649 delivery is deferred.
22650
22651
22652 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22653 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22654 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22655 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22656
22657
22658 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22659 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22660 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22661 .cindex "locking files"
22662 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22663 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22664 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22665 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22666 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22667 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22668 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22669 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22670
22671 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22672 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22673 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22674 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22675
22676 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22677 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22678 retries is
22679 .code
22680 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22681 .endd
22682 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22683 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22684 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22685
22686 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22687 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22688 .code
22689 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22690 .endd
22691
22692 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22693 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22694 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22695 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22696
22697
22698 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22699 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22700 for details of locking.
22701
22702
22703 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22704 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22705 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22706
22707
22708 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22709 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22710 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22711
22712
22713 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22714 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22715 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22716 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22717 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22718
22719
22720 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22721 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22722 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22723 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22724 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22725 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22726 external source that maintains the data.
22727
22728
22729 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22730 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22731 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22732 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22733 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22734 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22735 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22736 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22737
22738
22739
22740 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22741 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22742 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22743 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22744 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22745 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22746 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22747 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22748 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22749 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22750
22751
22752 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22753 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22754 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22755 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22756 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22757 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22758 calculation. The default value is:
22759 .code
22760 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22761 .endd
22762 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22763 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22764 &_Trash_&
22765 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22766 .code
22767 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22768 .endd
22769 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22770 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22771 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22772 directly into that directory.
22773
22774
22775 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22776 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22777 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22778
22779
22780 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22781 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22782 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22783
22784
22785 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22786 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22787 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22788 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22789 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22790 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22791 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22792 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22793
22794 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22795 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22796 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22797 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22798 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22799 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22800 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22801 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22802 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22803 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22804
22805
22806 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22807 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22808 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22809 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22810 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22811 below for further details.
22812
22813
22814 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22815 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22816 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22817
22818
22819 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22820 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22821 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22822
22823
22824 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22825 .cindex "locking files"
22826 .cindex "file" "locking"
22827 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22828 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22829 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22830 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22831 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22832 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22833 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22834
22835 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22836 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22837 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22838 combination:
22839 .code
22840 mbx_format = true
22841 message_prefix =
22842 message_suffix =
22843 .endd
22844 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22845 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22846 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22847 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22848 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22849 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22850 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22851 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22852
22853 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22854 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22855 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22856 append messages to it.
22857
22858
22859 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22860 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22861 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22862 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22863 in which case it is:
22864 .code
22865 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22866 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22867 .endd
22868 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22869 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22870
22871 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22872 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22873 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22874 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22875 setting
22876 .code
22877 message_suffix =
22878 .endd
22879 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22880 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22881
22882 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22883 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22884 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22885 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22886 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22887 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22888 value, and this option is ignored.
22889
22890
22891 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22892 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22893 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22894 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22895 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22896
22897
22898 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22899 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22900 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22901 on users about incoming mail.
22902
22903
22904 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22905 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22906 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22907 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22908 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22909 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22910 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22911 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22912 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22913
22914 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22915 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22916 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22917
22918 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22919 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22920 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22921 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22922 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22923 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22924
22925 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22926 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22927 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22928 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22929 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22930 be handled.
22931
22932 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22933 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22934
22935 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22936
22937 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22938 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22939 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22940 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22941 system quota failures.
22942
22943 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22944 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22945 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22946 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22947 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22948 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22949 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22950 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22951 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22952 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22953
22954
22955 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22956 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22957 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22958 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22959 delivery directory.
22960
22961
22962 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22963 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22964 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22965 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22966 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22967 &"no quota"&.
22968
22969 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22970 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22971
22972 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22973 See &%quota%& above.
22974
22975
22976 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22977 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22978 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22979 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22980 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22981 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22982 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22983
22984 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22985 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22986 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22987 the file length to the filename. For example:
22988 .code
22989 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22990 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22991 .endd
22992 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22993 number of lines in the message.
22994
22995 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22996 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22997 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22998
22999 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23000
23001 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23002 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23003 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23004 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23005 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23006 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23007
23008
23009 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23010 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23011 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23012 .code
23013 quota_warn_message = "\
23014 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23015 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23016 This message is automatically created \
23017 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23018 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23019 a warning threshold that is\n\
23020 set by the system administrator.\n"
23021 .endd
23022
23023
23024 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23025 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23026 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23027 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23028 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23029 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23030 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23031 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23032 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23033 sign. For example:
23034 .code
23035 quota = 10M
23036 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23037 .endd
23038 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23039 percent sign is ignored.
23040
23041 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23042 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23043 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23044 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23045 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23046 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23047 .code
23048 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23049 .endd
23050 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23051 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23052 option.
23053
23054 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23055 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23056 percentage.
23057
23058
23059 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23060 .cindex "envelope from"
23061 .cindex "envelope sender"
23062 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23063 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23064 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23065 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23066 for details of batch SMTP.
23067
23068
23069 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23070 .cindex "carriage return"
23071 .cindex "linefeed"
23072 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23073 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23074 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23075 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23076
23077 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23078 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23079 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23080 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23081 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23082 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23083
23084
23085 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23086 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23087 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23088 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23089 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23090 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23091
23092
23093 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23094 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23095 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23096 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23097 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23098
23099 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23100 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23101 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23102 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23103
23104 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23105 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23106 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23107 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23108 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23109 error.
23110
23111 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23112 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23113
23114
23115 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23116 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23117 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23118 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23119 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23120 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23121 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23122
23123 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23124 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23125 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23126 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23127 file corruption.
23128
23129 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23130 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23131 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23132
23133
23134 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23135 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23136 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23137 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23138 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23139 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23140 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23141 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23142 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23143
23144 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23145 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23146 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23147 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23148
23149
23150
23151
23152 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23153 .cindex "appending to a file"
23154 .cindex "file" "appending"
23155 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23156
23157 .ilist
23158 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23159 return is given.
23160
23161 .next
23162 .cindex "directory creation"
23163 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23164 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23165 &%directory_mode%& option.
23166
23167 .next
23168 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23169 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23170 transport.
23171
23172 .next
23173 .cindex "file" "locking"
23174 .cindex "locking files"
23175 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23176 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23177 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23178
23179 .olist
23180 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23181 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23182 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23183 .next
23184 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23185 .next
23186 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23187 Unlink the hitching post name.
23188 .next
23189 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23190 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23191 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23192 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23193 .next
23194 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23195 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23196 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23197 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23198 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23199 it before trying again.
23200 .endlist olist
23201
23202 .next
23203 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23204 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23205 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23206
23207 .next
23208 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23209 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23210 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23211 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23212 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23213 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23214 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23215 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23216 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23217 checked.
23218
23219 .next
23220 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23221 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23222 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23223 delivery is deferred.
23224
23225 .next
23226 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23227 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23228 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23229 permissions.
23230
23231 .next
23232 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23233 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23234 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23235
23236 .next
23237 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23238 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23239 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23240
23241 .next
23242 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23243 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23244 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23245 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23246 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23247 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23248 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23249 that prevents link following.
23250
23251 .next
23252 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23253 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23254 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23255 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23256 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23257
23258 .next
23259 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23260
23261 .next
23262 .cindex "file" "locking"
23263 .cindex "locking files"
23264 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23265 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23266 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23267 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23268 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23269 .code
23270 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23271 .endd
23272 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23273 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23274 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23275
23276 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23277 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23278 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23279
23280 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23281 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23282 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23283 delivery is deferred.
23284
23285 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23286 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23287 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23288 immediately. It retries up to
23289 .code
23290 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23291 .endd
23292 times (rounded up).
23293 .endlist
23294
23295 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23296 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23297
23298
23299 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23300 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23301 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23302 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23303 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23304 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23305 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23306 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23307 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23308 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23309
23310 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23311 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23312 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23313 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23314 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23315 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23316 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23317
23318 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23319 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23320 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23321 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23322
23323
23324 .cindex "maildir format"
23325 .cindex "mailstore format"
23326 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23327 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23328 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23329 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23330 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23331
23332 .cindex "directory creation"
23333 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23334 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23335 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23336 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23337 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23338 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23339 deferred.
23340
23341
23342
23343 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23344 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23345 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23346 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23347 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23348 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23349 &_new_& subdirectory.
23350
23351 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23352 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23353 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23354 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23355 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23356 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23357 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23358
23359 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23360 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23361 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23362 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23363 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23364 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23365 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23366 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23367
23368 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23369 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23370 folders. Consider this example:
23371 .code
23372 maildir_format = true
23373 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23374 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23375 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23376 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23377 .endd
23378 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23379 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23380 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23381 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23382 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23383 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23384
23385 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23386 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23387 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23388 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23389 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23390
23391 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23392 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23393 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23394
23395 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23396 .cindex "maildir++"
23397 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23398 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23399 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23400 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23401 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23402 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23403 amount of space used.
23404
23405 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23406 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23407 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23408 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23409 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23410 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23411
23412
23413
23414
23415 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23416 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23417 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23418 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23419 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23420 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23421
23422
23423 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23424 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23425 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23426 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23427 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23428 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23429 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23430 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23431 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23432 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23433 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23434 backwards compatibility).
23435
23436 For one common implementation, you might set:
23437 .code
23438 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23439 .endd
23440 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23441
23442 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23443 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23444 &[stat()]& each message file.
23445
23446
23447 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23448 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23449 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23450 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23451 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23452 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23453 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23454 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23455 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23456
23457 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23458 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23459 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23460 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23461 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23462 need to know the quota.
23463
23464 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23465 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23466
23467 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23468 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23469 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23470 details.
23471
23472
23473 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23474 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23475 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23476 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23477 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23478 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23479 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23480 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23481
23482 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23483 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23484 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23485 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23486 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23487 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23488
23489 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23490 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23491 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23492 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23493 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23494 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23495
23496 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23497 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23498 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23499 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23500
23501
23502 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23503 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23504 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23505 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23506 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23507 .code
23508 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23509 .endd
23510 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23511 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23512 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23513 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23514 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23515
23516
23517
23518
23519
23520
23521 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23522 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23523
23524 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23525 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23526 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23527 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23528 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23529 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23530 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23531 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23532
23533 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23534 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23535 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23536 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23537 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23538
23539
23540 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23541 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23542 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23543 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23544 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23545
23546 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23547 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23548 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23549 transport is run as a consequence of a
23550 &%mail%&
23551 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23552 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23553 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23554 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23555 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23556 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23557
23558 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23559 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23560 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23561 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23562
23563 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23564 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23565 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23566 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23567 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23568 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23569 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23570
23571 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23572 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23573 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23574 the transport defers.
23575 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23576 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23577
23578 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23579 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23580 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23581 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23582
23583 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23584 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23585 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23586 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23587 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23588 problems. They are just discarded.
23589
23590
23591
23592 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23593 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23594
23595 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23596 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23597 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23598
23599
23600 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23601 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23602 when the message is specified by the transport.
23603
23604
23605 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23606 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23607 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23608 string comes first.
23609
23610
23611 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23612 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23613 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23614
23615
23616 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23617 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23618 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23619
23620
23621 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23622 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23623 specified by the transport.
23624
23625
23626 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23627 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23628 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23629 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23630
23631
23632 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23633 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23634 the message is specified by the transport.
23635
23636
23637 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23638 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23639 used.
23640
23641
23642 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23643 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23644 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23645 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23646 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23647
23648
23649
23650 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23651 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23652 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23653 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23654
23655 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23656 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23657 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23658 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23659 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23660 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23661 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23662 infinity.
23663
23664 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23665 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23666 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23667 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23668 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23669
23670 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23671 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23672 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23673 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23674 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23675 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23676
23677
23678 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23679 See &%once%& above.
23680
23681
23682 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23683 See &%once%& above.
23684 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23685
23686
23687 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23688 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23689 specified by the transport.
23690
23691
23692 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23693 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23694 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23695 configuration option.
23696
23697
23698 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23699 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23700 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23701 automatic responses. For example:
23702 .code
23703 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23704 .endd
23705 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23706 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23707 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23708 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23709 small.
23710
23711
23712
23713 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23714 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23715 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23716 the text comes first.
23717
23718
23719 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23720 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23721 when the message is specified by the transport.
23722 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23723 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23724
23725
23726
23727
23728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23730
23731 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23732 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23733 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23734 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23735 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23736 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23737 specified command
23738 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23739 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23740 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23741 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23742 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23743 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23744 .code
23745 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23746 .endd
23747 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23748 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23749 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23750 as follows:
23751
23752 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23753 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23754
23755
23756 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23757 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23758 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23759 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23760 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23761
23762
23763 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23764 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23765 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23766 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23767 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23768 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23769 LMTP protocol.
23770
23771 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23772 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23773 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23774 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23775 in its response to the LHLO command.
23776
23777 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23778 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23779 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23780 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23781
23782
23783 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23784 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23785 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23786 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23787 LMTP transport:
23788 .code
23789 lmtp:
23790 driver = lmtp
23791 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23792 batch_max = 20
23793 user = exim
23794 .endd
23795 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23796 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23797
23798
23799
23800 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23802
23803 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23804 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23805 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23806 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23807 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23808 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23809 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23810 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23811 following ways:
23812
23813 .ilist
23814 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23815 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23816 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23817 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23818 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23819 .next
23820 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23821 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23822 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23823 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23824 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23825 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23826 that are routed to the transport.
23827 .next
23828 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23829 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23830 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23831 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23832 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23833 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23834 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23835 .endlist
23836
23837
23838 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23839 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23840 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23841
23842 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23843 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23844 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23845 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23846 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23847 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23848 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23849
23850 .new
23851 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
23852 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
23853 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
23854 .wen
23855
23856
23857 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23858 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23859 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23860 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23861 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23862 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23863 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23864
23865
23866
23867
23868 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23869 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23870 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23871 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23872 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23873 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23874 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23875 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23876 &"local delivery failed"&.
23877
23878 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23879 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23880 will be sent as normal.
23881
23882 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23883 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23884 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23885 apply in this case.
23886
23887 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23888 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23889 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23890 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23891
23892 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23893 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23894 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23895 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23896 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23897 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23898 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23899 &%temp_errors%&.
23900
23901
23902
23903 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23904 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23905 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23906 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23907 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23908 run.
23909
23910 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23911 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23912 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23913 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23914
23915 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23916 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23917 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23918 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23919 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23920 .code
23921 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23922 .endd
23923 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23924 arguments. You have to write
23925 .code
23926 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23927 .endd
23928 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23929 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23930 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23931 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23932 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23933 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23934 example:
23935 .code
23936 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23937 .endd
23938
23939 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23940 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23941 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23942 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23943 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23944 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23945 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23946 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23947 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23948 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23949 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23950
23951 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23952 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23953 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23954 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23955 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23956 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23957 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23958 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23959
23960 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23961 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23962 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23963 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23964 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23965 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23966 control what is done with it.
23967
23968 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23969 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23970 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23971 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23972 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23973 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23974 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23975 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23976 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23977 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23978 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23979
23980
23981
23982 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23983 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23984 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23985 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23986 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23987 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23988 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23989 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23990 .display
23991 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23992 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23993 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23994 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23995 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23996 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23997 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23998 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23999 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24000 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24001 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24002 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24003 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24004 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24005 &`USER `& see below
24006 .endd
24007 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24008 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24009 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24010 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24011 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24012 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24013 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24014
24015 .cindex "HOST"
24016 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24017 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24018 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24019 the router.
24020
24021 .cindex "HOME"
24022 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24023 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24024 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24025 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24026
24027
24028 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24029 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24030
24031
24032
24033 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24034 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24035 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24036 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24037 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24038 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24039 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24040 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24041 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24042 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24043 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24044 example, if
24045 .code
24046 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24047 .endd
24048 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24049 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24050 &%use_shell%& is set.
24051
24052
24053 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24054 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24055
24056
24057 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24058 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24059 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24060
24061
24062 .option check_string pipe string unset
24063 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24064 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24065 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24066 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24067 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24068 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24069 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24070 ignored.
24071
24072
24073 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24074 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24075 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24076 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24077 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24078 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24079 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24080
24081
24082 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24083 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24084 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24085 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24086 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24087 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24088 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24089
24090
24091 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24092 See &%check_string%& above.
24093
24094
24095 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24096 .cindex "exec failure"
24097 .cindex "failure of exec"
24098 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24099 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24100 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24101 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24102 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24103
24104
24105 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24106 .cindex "signal exit"
24107 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24108 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24109 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24110 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24111
24112
24113 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24114 .cindex "force command"
24115 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24116 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24117 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24118 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24119 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24120 command. For example:
24121 .code
24122 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24123 force_command
24124 .endd
24125
24126 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24127 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24128 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24129
24130
24131 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24132 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24133 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24134 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24135 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24136 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24137
24138 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24139 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24140
24141
24142 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24143 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24144 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24145 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24146 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24147 written to the main log.
24148
24149
24150 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24151 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24152 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24153 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24154 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24155 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24156 be set.
24157
24158
24159 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24160 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24161 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24162 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24163 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24164
24165
24166 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24167 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24168 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24169 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24170 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24171 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24172 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24173 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24174
24175
24176 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24177 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24178 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24179 .code
24180 message_prefix = \
24181 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24182 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24183 .endd
24184 .cindex "Cyrus"
24185 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24186 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24187 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24188 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24189 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24190 setting
24191 .code
24192 message_prefix =
24193 .endd
24194 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24195 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24196
24197
24198 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24199 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24200 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24201 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24202 .code
24203 message_suffix =
24204 .endd
24205 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24206 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24207
24208
24209 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24210 This option is expanded and
24211 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24212 variable of the subprocess.
24213 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24214 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24215 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24216
24217
24218 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24219 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24220 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24221 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24222 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24223 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24224 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24225 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24226 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24227
24228
24229 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24230 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24231 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24232 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24233 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24234 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24235 accept the message is used.
24236
24237
24238 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24239 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24240 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24241 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24242 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24243 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24244
24245
24246 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24247 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24248 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24249 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24250 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24251 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24252 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24253
24254
24255
24256 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24257 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24258 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24259 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24260 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24261 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24262 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24263 of them may be set.
24264
24265
24266
24267 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24268 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24269 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24270 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24271 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24272 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24273 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24274 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24275 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24276 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24277 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24278 and 73, respectively.
24279
24280
24281 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24282 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24283 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24284 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24285 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24286 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24287 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24288
24289 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24290 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24291 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24292 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24293 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24294 delivery to be deferred.
24295
24296 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24297 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24298
24299
24300 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24301 .cindex "envelope sender"
24302 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24303 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24304 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24305 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24306 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24307
24308 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24309 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24310 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24311 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24312 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24313 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24314 class database.
24315
24316
24317 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24318 .cindex "carriage return"
24319 .cindex "linefeed"
24320 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24321 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24322 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24323 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24324
24325 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24326 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24327 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24328 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24329 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24330
24331
24332 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24333 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24334 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24335 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24336 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24337 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24338 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24339 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24340 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24341 its &%-c%& option.
24342
24343
24344
24345 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24346 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24347 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24348 .cindex "external local delivery"
24349 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24350 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24351 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24352 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24353 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24354 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24355 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24356 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24357 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24358 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24359 .code
24360 # transport
24361 procmail_pipe:
24362 driver = pipe
24363 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24364 return_path_add
24365 delivery_date_add
24366 envelope_to_add
24367 check_string = "From "
24368 escape_string = ">From "
24369 umask = 077
24370 user = $local_part
24371 group = mail
24372
24373 # router
24374 procmail:
24375 driver = accept
24376 check_local_user
24377 transport = procmail_pipe
24378 .endd
24379 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24380 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24381 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24382 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24383 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24384 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24385
24386 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24387 .code
24388 IFS=" "
24389 .endd
24390 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24391 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24392
24393 .cindex "Cyrus"
24394 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24395 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24396 .code
24397 # transport
24398 local_delivery_cyrus:
24399 driver = pipe
24400 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24401 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24402 user = cyrus
24403 group = mail
24404 return_output
24405 log_output
24406 message_prefix =
24407 message_suffix =
24408
24409 # router
24410 local_user_cyrus:
24411 driver = accept
24412 check_local_user
24413 local_part_suffix = .*
24414 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24415 .endd
24416 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24417 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24418 sender.
24419 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24420 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24421
24422
24423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24424 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24425
24426 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24427 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24428 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24429 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24430 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24431 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24432 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24433 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24434
24435
24436 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24437 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24438 two ways:
24439
24440 .ilist
24441 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24442 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24443 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24444 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24445 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24446 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24447 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24448 .next
24449 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24450 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24451 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24452 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24453 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24454 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24455 process.
24456 .endlist
24457
24458
24459 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24460 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24461 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24462
24463
24464
24465 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24466 .vindex "&$host$&"
24467 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24468 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24469 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24470 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24471 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24472 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24473 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24474 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24475
24476
24477 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24478 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24479 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24480 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24481 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24482 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24483 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24484 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24485 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24486 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24487 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24488 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24489 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24490 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24491
24492 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24493 and will be removed in a future release.
24494
24495
24496 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24497 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24498 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24499
24500
24501 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24502 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24503 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24504 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24505 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24506 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24507 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24508 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24509
24510 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24511 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24512 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24513 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24514 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24515 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24516 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24517 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24518 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24519
24520
24521 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24522 .cindex "Cyrus"
24523 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24524 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24525 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24526 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24527 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24528 ignored.
24529
24530 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24531 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24532 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24533 particular connection.
24534
24535 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24536 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24537 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24538 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24539
24540 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24541 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24542 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24543 .code
24544 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24545 .endd
24546 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24547 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24548
24549 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24550 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24551 value.
24552
24553
24554 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24555 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24556 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24557 authenticated as a client.
24558
24559
24560 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24561 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24562 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24563 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24564
24565
24566 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24567 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24568 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24569 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24570 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24571 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24572 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24573
24574
24575 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24576 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24577 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24578 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24579 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24580 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24581 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24582 option.
24583
24584
24585 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24586 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24587 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24588 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24589 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24590 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24591 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24592 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24593 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24594 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24595 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24596 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24597 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24598 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24599
24600
24601 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24602 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24603 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24604 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24605
24606
24607 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24608 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24609 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24610 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24611 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24612 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24613 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24614 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24615 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24616 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24617 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24618 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24619 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24620 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24621 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24622 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24623 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24624 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24625
24626
24627 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24628 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24629 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24630 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24631 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24632 cutoff times.
24633
24634 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24635 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24636 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24637 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24638 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24639 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24640
24641 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24642 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24643 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24644 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24645 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24646 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24647 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24648 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24649 to them.
24650
24651
24652 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24653 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24654 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24655 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24656 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24657
24658
24659 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24660 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24661 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24662 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24663 details.
24664
24665
24666 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24667 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24668 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24669 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24670 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24671 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24672 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24673 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24674 router option.
24675
24676
24677
24678 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24679 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24680 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24681 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24682 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24683 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24684 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24685 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24686 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24687
24688
24689
24690 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24691 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24692 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24693 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24694 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24695 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24696 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24697
24698 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24699 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24700 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24701 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24702 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24703
24704
24705 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24706 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24707 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24708 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24709 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24710 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24711 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24712 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24713
24714 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24715 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24716 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24717 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24718 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24719 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24720
24721 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24722 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24723 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24724 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24725 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24726
24727 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24728 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24729 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24730 copy of the message is sent.
24731
24732 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24733 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24734 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24735 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24736 fails"& facility.
24737
24738
24739 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24740 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24741 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24742 zero.
24743
24744 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24745 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24746 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24747 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24748 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24749 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24750
24751 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24752 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24753 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24754 implementations of TLS.
24755
24756 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24757 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24758 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24759 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24760 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24761 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24762 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24763 option is:
24764 .code
24765 $primary_hostname
24766 .endd
24767 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24768 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24769 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24770 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24771 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24772 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24773 interface address, you could use this:
24774 .code
24775 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24776 {$primary_hostname}}
24777 .endd
24778 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24779 callouts.
24780
24781 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24782 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24783 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24784 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24785 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24786 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24787
24788 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24789 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24790 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24791 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24792
24793 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24794 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24795 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24796 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24797 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24798 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24799 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24800
24801 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24802 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24803 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24804 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24805 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24806 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24807 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24808 address are used.
24809
24810 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24811 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24812
24813
24814 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24815 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24816 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24817 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24818 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24819 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24820 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24821 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24822 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24823 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24824
24825
24826 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24827 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24828 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24829 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24830
24831 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24832 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24833 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24834 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24835 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24836 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24837
24838 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24839 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24840 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24841 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24842 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24843
24844 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24845
24846 Note:
24847 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24848 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24849 is filled in.
24850 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24851 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24852 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24853 You have been warned.
24854
24855
24856 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24857 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24858 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24859 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24860
24861 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24862 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24863 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24864 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24865 to any host that matches this list.
24866
24867
24868 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24869 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24870 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24871 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24872 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24873 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24874 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24875 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24876
24877
24878 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24879 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24880 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24881 why it exists.
24882
24883
24884
24885 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24886 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24887 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24888 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24889 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24890 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24891 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24892 explanation of when this might be needed.
24893
24894 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24895 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24896 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24897 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24898 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24899 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24900 message on the same session.
24901
24902 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24903 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24904 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24905 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24906 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24907 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24908 logging.
24909
24910
24911
24912 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24913 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24914 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24915 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24916 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24917
24918
24919 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24920 .cindex "randomized host list"
24921 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24922 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24923 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24924 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24925 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24926 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24927 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24928 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24929
24930 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24931 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24932 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24933 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24934 .code
24935 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24936 .endd
24937 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24938 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24939 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24940
24941 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24942 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24943 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24944 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24945 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24946 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24947 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24948 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24949 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24950
24951
24952 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24953 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24954 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24955 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24956 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24957
24958 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24959 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24960 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24961 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24962 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24963 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24964 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24965 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24966 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24967
24968 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24969 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24970 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24971 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24972 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24973
24974 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24975 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24976 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24977 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24978 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24979 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24980
24981 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24982 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24983 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24984 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24985 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24986 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24987 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24988
24989 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24990 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24991 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24992 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24993 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24994 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24995 .new
24996 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
24997 .wen
24998 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24999
25000 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25001 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25002 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25003 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25004 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25005 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25006 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25007 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25008 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25009
25010 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25011 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25012 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25013 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25014 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25015 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25016 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25017 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25018 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25019 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25020
25021 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25022 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25023
25024 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25025 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25026 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25027 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25028 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25029
25030 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25031 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25032 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25033 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25034 for multi-recipient messages.
25035 The option can usually be left as default.
25036
25037 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25038 .cindex "bind IP address"
25039 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25040 .vindex "&$host$&"
25041 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25042 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25043 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25044 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25045 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25046 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25047 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25048 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25049 unknown.
25050
25051 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25052 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25053 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25054 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25055 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25056 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25057 For example:
25058 .code
25059 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25060 .endd
25061 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25062 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25063 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25064 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25065
25066
25067 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25068 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25069 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25070 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25071 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25072 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25073 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25074 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25075 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25076 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25077 unreachable hosts.
25078
25079
25080 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25081 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25082 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25083 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25084 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25085
25086 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25087 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25088 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25089 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25090 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25091 permits this.
25092
25093
25094 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25095 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25096 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25097 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25098 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25099 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25100 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25101 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25102
25103 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25104 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25105 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25106
25107 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25108 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25109 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25110 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25111 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25112 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25113 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25114 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25115
25116 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25117 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25118 normally &"smtp"&,
25119 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25120 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25121 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25122 is deferred.
25123
25124 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25125 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25126
25127
25128
25129 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25130 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25131 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25132 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25133 .vindex "&$port$&"
25134 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25135 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25136 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25137 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25138 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25139
25140 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25141 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25142 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25143 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25144 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25145 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25146
25147
25148 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25149 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25150 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25151 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25152 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25153 addresses is not affected.
25154
25155 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25156 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25157 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25158 Exim to use only the host name.
25159 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25160
25161
25162 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25163 .cindex "serializing connections"
25164 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25165 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25166 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25167 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25168 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25169 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25170 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25171
25172 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25173 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25174 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25175 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25176 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25177 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25178
25179 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25180 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25181 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25182 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25183 are used for ETRN serialization.
25184
25185 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25186
25187
25188 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25189 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25190 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25191 .cindex "size" "of message"
25192 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25193 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25194 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25195 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25196 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25197 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25198 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25199 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25200
25201 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25202 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25203
25204
25205 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25206 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25207 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25208 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25209
25210
25211 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25212 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25213 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25214 .vindex "&$host$&"
25215 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25216 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25217 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25218 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25219 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25220 details of TLS.
25221
25222 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25223 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25224 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25225 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25226 client.
25227
25228
25229 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25230 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25231 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25232 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25233 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25234
25235
25236 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25237 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25238 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25239 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25240 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25241 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25242 will fail.
25243
25244 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25245
25246
25247 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25248 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25249 .vindex "&$host$&"
25250 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25251 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25252 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25253 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25254 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25255 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25256 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25257 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25258
25259
25260 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25261 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25262 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25263 .vindex "&$host$&"
25264 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25265 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25266 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25267 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25268 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25269 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25270 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25271 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25272 ciphers is a preference order.
25273
25274
25275
25276 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25277 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25278 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25279 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25280 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25281 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25282 certificate and private key for the session.
25283
25284 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25285
25286 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25287 TLS extensions.
25288
25289
25290
25291
25292 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25293 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25294 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25295 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25296 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25297 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25298 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25299 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25300 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25301 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25302 in clear.
25303
25304
25305 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25306 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25307 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25308 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25309 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25310 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25311 Note that unless the host is in this list
25312 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25313 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25314 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25315 certificate verification succeeds.
25316
25317
25318 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25319 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25320 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25321 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25322 while verifying the server certificate,
25323 checks will be included on the host name
25324 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25325 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25326 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25327
25328 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25329
25330
25331 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25332 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25333 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25334 .vindex "&$host$&"
25335 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25336 The value of this option must be either the
25337 word "system"
25338 or the absolute path to
25339 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25340 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25341
25342 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25343 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25344 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25345 must be specified.
25346
25347 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25348 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25349
25350 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25351 explicitly
25352 either by file or directory
25353 are added to those given by the system default location.
25354
25355 The values of &$host$& and
25356 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25357 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25358
25359 For back-compatibility,
25360 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25361 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25362 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25363
25364
25365 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25366 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25367 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25368 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25369 certificate verification must succeed.
25370 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25371 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25372 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25373
25374 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25375 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25376 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25377 If built with internationalization support,
25378 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25379 to a-label form.
25380 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25381
25382
25383
25384
25385 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25386 "SECTvalhosmax"
25387 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25388 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25389 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25390 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25391 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25392
25393
25394 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25395 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25396 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25397 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25398 retrying.
25399
25400 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25401 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25402 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25403
25404 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25405 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25406 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25407 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25408 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25409
25410 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25411 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25412 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25413 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25414 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25415 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25416 see below for an exception).
25417
25418 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25419 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25420 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25421 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25422 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25423
25424 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25425 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25426 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25427 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25428 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25429 reached their retry times.
25430
25431 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25432 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25433 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25434 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25435 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25436 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25437 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25438 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25439 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25440 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25441 reached.
25442
25443 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25444 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25445 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25446 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25447 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25448 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25449
25450 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25451 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25452 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25453 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25454 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25455 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25456
25457
25458
25459
25460
25461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25463
25464 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25465 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25466 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25467 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25468 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25469 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25470
25471 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25472 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25473 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25474 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25475 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25476 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25477 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25478
25479 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25480 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25481 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25482 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25483
25484
25485 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25486 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25487 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25488 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25489
25490 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25491 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25492 facility; you do not have to use it.
25493
25494 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25495 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25496 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25497 address to which it applies.
25498
25499 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25500 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25501 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25502 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25503 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25504 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25505 rules.
25506
25507 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25508 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25509 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25510 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25511
25512
25513 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25514 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25515 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25516 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25517 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25518 discouraged.
25519
25520 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25521 illustrated by these examples:
25522
25523 .ilist
25524 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25525 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25526 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25527 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25528 .next
25529 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25530 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25531 .endlist
25532
25533
25534
25535 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25536 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25537 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25538 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25539 message's processing.
25540
25541 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25542 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25543 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25544 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25545 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25546 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25547 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25548 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25549 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25550
25551 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25552 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25553 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25554 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25555 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25556 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25557 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25558 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25559 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25560 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25561
25562 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25563 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25564 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25565 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25566 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25567 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25568
25569 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25570 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25571 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25572
25573 .cindex "envelope from"
25574 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25575 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25576 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25577 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25578 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25579 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25580 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25581 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25582 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25583
25584 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25585 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25586 transport time.
25587
25588
25589
25590
25591 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25592 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25593 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25594 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25595 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25596 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25597 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25598 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25599 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25600 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25601 .code
25602 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25603 .endd
25604 might produce the output
25605 .code
25606 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25607 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25608 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25609 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25610 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25611 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25612 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25613 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25614 .endd
25615 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25616 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25617 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25618 set for a particular transport.
25619
25620
25621 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25622 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25623 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25624 rules in the form
25625 .display
25626 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25627 .endd
25628 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25629 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25630 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25631 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25632
25633 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25634 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25635 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25636 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25637 ignored.
25638
25639 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25640 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25641 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25642
25643 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25644 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25645 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25646 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25647 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25648 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25649 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25650
25651 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25652 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25653 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25654 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25655 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25656 .code
25657 *@* ${lookup ...
25658 .endd
25659 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25660 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25661
25662
25663 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25664 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25665 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25666 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25667 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25668 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25669 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25670 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25671 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25672
25673 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25674 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25675 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25676
25677 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25678 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25679 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25680 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25681 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25682 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25683 of pattern they are set as follows:
25684
25685 .ilist
25686 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25687 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25688 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25689 pattern
25690 .code
25691 *queen@*.fict.example
25692 .endd
25693 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25694 .code
25695 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25696 $1 = hearts-
25697 $2 = wonderland
25698 .endd
25699 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25700 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25701
25702 .next
25703 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25704 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25705 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25706 rewriting rule of the form
25707 .display
25708 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25709 .endd
25710 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25711 .code
25712 $1 = foo
25713 $2 = bar
25714 $3 = baz.example
25715 .endd
25716 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25717 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25718 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25719 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25720 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25721 .endlist
25722
25723
25724 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25725 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25726 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25727 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25728 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25729 .code
25730 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25731 .endd
25732 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25733 &'From:'& headers.
25734
25735 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25736 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25737 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25738 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25739 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25740 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25741 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25742 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25743 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25744 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25745 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25746 entry written to the panic log.
25747
25748
25749
25750 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25751 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25752
25753 .ilist
25754 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25755 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25756 .next
25757 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25758 .next
25759 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25760 .endlist
25761
25762 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25763 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25764
25765
25766
25767 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25768 "SECID154"
25769 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25770 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25771 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25772 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25773 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25774 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25775 .display
25776 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25777 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25778 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25779 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25780 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25781 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25782 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25783 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25784 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25785 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25786 .endd
25787 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25788 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25789 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25790
25791 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25792 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25793
25794
25795 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25796 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25797 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25798 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25799 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25800 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25801 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25802 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25803 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25804
25805 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25806 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25807 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25808 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25809 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25810 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25811 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25812 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25813
25814
25815 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25816 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25817 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25818 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25819
25820 .ilist
25821 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25822 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25823 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25824 .next
25825 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25826 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25827 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25828 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25829 .next
25830 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25831 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25832 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25833 .next
25834 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25835 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25836 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25837 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25838 .code
25839 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25840 .endd
25841 into
25842 .code
25843 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25844 .endd
25845 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25846 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25847 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25848 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25849 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25850 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25851 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25852 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25853 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25854
25855 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25856 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25857 .endlist
25858
25859
25860 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25861 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25862 .code
25863 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25864 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25865 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25866 .endd
25867 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25868 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25869 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25870 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25871 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25872 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25873 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25874 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25875
25876 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25877 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25878 .code
25879 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25880 .endd
25881 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25882 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25883
25884 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25885 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25886 messages that originate outside the local host:
25887 .code
25888 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25889 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25890 .endd
25891 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25892 space.
25893
25894 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25895 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25896 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25897 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25898 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25899 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25900 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25901 components. For example, the rule
25902 .code
25903 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25904 .endd
25905 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25906 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25907 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25908 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25909 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25910 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25911 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25912 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25913
25914
25915
25916
25917
25918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25920
25921 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25922 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25923 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25924 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25925 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25926 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25927 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25928 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25929 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25930 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25931 address, domain and error.
25932
25933 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25934 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25935 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25936 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25937 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25938 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25939 log selector is set, the message
25940 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25941 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25942 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25943 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25944
25945 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25946 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25947 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25948 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25949 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25950 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25951 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25952 domain are maintained independently.
25953
25954 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25955 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25956 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25957 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25958 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25959 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25960 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25961 the local address is reached.
25962
25963 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25964 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25965 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25966 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25967 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25968
25969 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25970 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25971 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25972 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25973 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25974 messages that it should now be retaining.
25975
25976
25977
25978 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25979 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25980 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25981 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25982 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25983 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25984 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25985 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25986 message's sender, respectively.
25987
25988
25989 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25990 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25991 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25992 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25993 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25994 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25995 example,
25996 .code
25997 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25998 .endd
25999 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26000 whereas
26001 .code
26002 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26003 .endd
26004 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26005 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26006 part.
26007
26008 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26009 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26010 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26011 expressions work in address lists.
26012 .display
26013 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26014 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26015 .endd
26016
26017
26018 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26019 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26020 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26021 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26022 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26023 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26024 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26025 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26026 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26027
26028 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26029 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26030 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26031 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26032 local transports).
26033
26034 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26035 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26036 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26037 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26038 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26039 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26040 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26041 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26042 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26043 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26044 commands.
26045
26046
26047
26048 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26049 "SECID160"
26050 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26051 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26052 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26053 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26054 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26055 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26056 .code
26057 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26058 MX 6 p.q.r.example
26059 MX 7 m.n.o.example
26060 .endd
26061 and the retry rules are
26062 .code
26063 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26064 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26065 .endd
26066 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26067 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26068 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26069 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26070 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26071 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26072
26073 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26074 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26075 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26076 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26077
26078 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26079 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26080 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26081 .code
26082 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26083 .endd
26084 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26085 textual form of the IP address.
26086
26087 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26088 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26089 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26090 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26091
26092 .vlist
26093 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26094 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26095 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26096
26097 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26098 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26099 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26100
26101 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26102 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26103
26104 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26105 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26106 .endlist
26107
26108 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26109 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26110 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26111 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26112 retry rule of this form:
26113 .code
26114 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26115 .endd
26116 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26117 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26118
26119 .vlist
26120 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26121 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26122 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26123 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26124
26125 .vitem &%lookup%&
26126 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26127 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26128 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26129 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26130 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26131
26132 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26133 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26134
26135 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26136 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26137
26138 .vitem &%refused%&
26139 A connection was refused.
26140
26141 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26142 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26143
26144 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26145 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26146
26147 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26148 A connection attempt timed out.
26149
26150 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26151 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26152 obtained from an MX record.
26153
26154 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26155 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26156 obtained from an MX record.
26157
26158 .vitem &%timeout%&
26159 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26160
26161 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26162 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26163 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26164 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26165
26166 .vitem &%quota%&
26167 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26168 transport.
26169
26170 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26171 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26172 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26173 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26174 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26175 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26176 for four days.
26177 .endlist
26178
26179 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26180 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26181 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26182 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26183 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26184 heuristic rules:
26185
26186 .ilist
26187 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26188 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26189 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26190 .next
26191 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26192 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26193 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26194 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26195 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26196 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26197 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26198 .next
26199 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26200 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26201 .endlist
26202
26203 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26204 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26205 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26206 error).
26207
26208
26209
26210 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26211 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26212 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26213 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26214 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26215 form:
26216 .display
26217 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26218 .endd
26219 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26220 .code
26221 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26222 .endd
26223 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26224 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26225 For example:
26226 .code
26227 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26228 .endd
26229 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26230 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26231 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26232 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26233 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26234
26235 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26236 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26237 .code
26238 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26239 .endd
26240 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26241 list is never matched.
26242
26243
26244
26245
26246
26247 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26248 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26249 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26250 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26251 .display
26252 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26253 .endd
26254 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26255 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26256 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26257 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26258 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26259
26260 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26261 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26262 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26263 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26264 The available algorithms are:
26265
26266 .ilist
26267 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26268 the interval.
26269 .next
26270 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26271 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26272 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26273 .next
26274 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26275 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26276 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26277 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26278 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26279 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26280 queue processing times.
26281 .endlist
26282
26283 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26284 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26285 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26286 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26287 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26288 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26289 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26290 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26291 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26292 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26293 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26294 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26295
26296 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26297 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26298 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26299 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26300 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26301 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26302 time.
26303
26304 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26305 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26306 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26307 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26308 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26309 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26310 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26311 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26312 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26313 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26314 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26315 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26316
26317 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26318 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26319 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26320 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26321 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26322 deliveries that have been deferred.
26323
26324
26325 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26326 Here are some example retry rules:
26327 .code
26328 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26329 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26330 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26331 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26332 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26333 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26334 .endd
26335 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26336 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26337 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26338 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26339 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26340 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26341 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26342 days.
26343
26344 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26345 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26346 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26347 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26348 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26349
26350 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26351 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26352 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26353 were not obtained from an MX record.
26354
26355 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26356 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26357 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26358 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26359 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26360
26361
26362
26363 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26364 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26365 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26366 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26367 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26368 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26369 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26370 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26371 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26372 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26373 failing for the first time.
26374
26375 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26376 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26377 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26378 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26379
26380 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26381 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26382 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26383
26384
26385
26386
26387 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26388 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26389 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26390 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26391 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26392 default retry rule:
26393 .code
26394 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26395 .endd
26396 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26397 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26398 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26399
26400 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26401 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26402 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26403 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26404 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26405
26406 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26407 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26408 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26409
26410 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26411 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26412 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26413 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26414 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26415 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26416 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26417 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26418 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26419 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26420 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26421
26422 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26423 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26424 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26425 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26426 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26427 notice.
26428
26429 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26430 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26431 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26432 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26433 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26434 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26435 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26436 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26437 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26438 true.
26439
26440 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26441 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26442 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26443 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26444 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26445 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26446 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26447 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26448 reached.
26449
26450 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26451 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26452 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26453 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26454 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26455 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26456 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26457 time out the address.
26458
26459 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26460 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26461 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26462 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26463 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26464 considered immediately.
26465 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26466 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26467
26468
26469
26470
26471
26472
26473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26474 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26475
26476 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26477 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26478 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26479 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26480 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26481 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26482 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26483 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26484 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26485 other.
26486
26487 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26488 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26489
26490 .ilist
26491 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26492 the client's EHLO command.
26493 .next
26494 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26495 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26496 .next
26497 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26498 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26499 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26500 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26501 with the AUTH command.
26502 .next
26503 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26504 .next
26505 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26506 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26507 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26508 connection.
26509 .next
26510 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26511 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26512 unauthenticated connection.
26513 .endlist
26514
26515 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26516 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26517 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26518 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26519 .display
26520 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26521 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26522 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26523 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26524 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26525 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26526 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26527 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26528 &`250-PIPELINING`&
26529 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26530 &`250 HELP`&
26531 .endd
26532 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26533 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26534 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26535 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26536 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26537 included by setting
26538 .code
26539 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26540 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26541 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26542 AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26543 AUTH_GSASL=yes
26544 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26545 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26546 AUTH_SPA=yes
26547 AUTH_TLS=yes
26548 .endd
26549 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26550 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26551 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26552 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26553 work via a socket interface.
26554 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26555 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26556 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26557 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26558 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26559 supporting setting a server keytab.
26560 The seventh can be configured to support
26561 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26562 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26563 The eighth authenticator
26564 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26565 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26566 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26567
26568 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26569 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26570 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26571 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26572 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26573 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26574 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26575
26576 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26577 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26578 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26579 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26580 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26581 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26582 .code
26583 cram:
26584 driver = cram_md5
26585 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26586 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26587 client_name = ph10
26588 client_secret = secret2
26589 .endd
26590 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26591 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26592
26593 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26594 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26595 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26596 in Exim.
26597
26598 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26599 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26600 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26601 authenticating data.
26602
26603 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26604 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26605 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26606 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26607 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26608 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26609 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26610 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26611 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26612 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26613 choose to honour.
26614
26615 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26616 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26617 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26618 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26619
26620
26621
26622 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26623 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26624 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26625
26626 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26627 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26628 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26629 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26630 encrypted by a setting such as:
26631 .code
26632 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26633 .endd
26634
26635
26636 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26637 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26638 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26639 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26640
26641
26642 .option driver authenticators string unset
26643 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26644 authenticators is to be used.
26645
26646
26647 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26648 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26649 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26650 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26651 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26652 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26653
26654
26655 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26656 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26657 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26658 mechanism is not advertised.
26659 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26660 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26661 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26662
26663
26664 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26665 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26666 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26667 for details.
26668
26669 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26670 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26671
26672 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26673 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26674 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26675 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26676 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26677 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26678 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26679 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26680 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26681 the error text.
26682
26683
26684 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26685 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26686 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26687 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26688 out the values of variables.
26689 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26690 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26691
26692
26693 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26694 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26695 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26696 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26697 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26698 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26699 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26700 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26701 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26702 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26703 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26704 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26705
26706
26707 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26708 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26709 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26710 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26711 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26712 remembered for later use.
26713 How it is used is described in the following section.
26714
26715
26716
26717
26718
26719 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26720 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26721 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26722 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26723 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26724 message:
26725
26726 .ilist
26727 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26728 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26729 .next
26730 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26731 .next
26732 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26733 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26734 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26735 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26736 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26737 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26738 given for the MAIL command.
26739 .next
26740 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26741 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26742 authenticated.
26743 .next
26744 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26745 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26746 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26747 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26748 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26749 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26750 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26751 message.
26752 .endlist
26753
26754
26755 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26756 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26757 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26758 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26759
26760 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26761 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26762 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26763 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26764 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26765 ACL is run.
26766
26767
26768
26769 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26770 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26771 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26772 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26773 conditions:
26774
26775 .ilist
26776 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26777 .next
26778 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26779 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26780 .endlist
26781
26782 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26783 the mechanisms are advertised.
26784
26785 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26786 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26787 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26788 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26789 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26790 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26791 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26792 .code
26793 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26794 .endd
26795 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26796
26797 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26798 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26799 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26800 such as:
26801 .code
26802 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26803 .endd
26804 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26805 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26806 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26807
26808 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26809 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26810 command. This is the case if
26811
26812 .ilist
26813 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26814 .next
26815 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26816 .next
26817 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26818 server authenticators.
26819 .endlist
26820
26821
26822 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26823 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26824 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26825
26826 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26827 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26828 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26829 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26830 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26831 rejected with a 504 error.
26832
26833 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26834 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26835 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26836 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26837 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26838 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26839 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26840 no successful authentication.
26841
26842 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26843 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26844 &%authresults%& expansion item.
26845
26846
26847
26848
26849 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26850 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26851 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26852 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26853 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26854 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26855 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26856 script:
26857 .code
26858 use MIME::Base64;
26859 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26860 .endd
26861 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26862 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26863 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26864 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26865 command line to run this script on such data might be
26866 .code
26867 encode '\0user\0password'
26868 .endd
26869 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26870 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26871 whose code value is zero.
26872
26873 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26874 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26875 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26876 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26877
26878 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26879 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26880 example, a command such as
26881 .code
26882 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26883 .endd
26884 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26885
26886 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26887 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26888 .code
26889 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26890 .endd
26891 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26892 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26893 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26894 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26895
26896
26897
26898 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26899 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26900 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26901 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26902 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26903 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26904
26905 .ilist
26906 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26907 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26908 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26909 of the authenticator.
26910 .next
26911 .vindex "&$host$&"
26912 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26913 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26914 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26915 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26916 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26917 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26918 delivery to be deferred.
26919 .next
26920 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26921 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26922 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26923 usual way.
26924 .next
26925 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26926 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26927 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26928 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26929 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26930 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26931 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26932 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26933 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26934 .endlist
26935
26936 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26937 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26938 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26939 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26940 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26941 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26942 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26943 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26944
26945 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26946
26947 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26948 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26949 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26950 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26951 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26952 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26953 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26954 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26955 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26956 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26957 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26958 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26959 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26960
26961
26962
26963
26964
26965
26966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26968
26969 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26970 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26971 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26972 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26973 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26974 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26975 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26976 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26977 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26978 connections as you do for login accounts.
26979
26980 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
26981 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
26982 TLS is not being used:
26983 .code
26984 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
26985 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
26986 .endd
26987
26988 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
26989 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
26990 (including their names) have been properly verified.
26991
26992 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
26993 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26994 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26995
26996 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26997 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26998 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26999
27000 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27001 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27002 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27003 given.
27004
27005 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27006 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27007 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27008 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27009 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27010 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27011 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27012
27013 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27014 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27015 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27016 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27017 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27018 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27019 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27020
27021 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27022 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27023 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27024 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27025
27026 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27027 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27028 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27029
27030 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27031 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27032 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27033 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27034 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27035 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27036 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27037 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27038 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27039 string as the error text.
27040
27041 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27042 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27043 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27044
27045
27046
27047 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27048 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27049 .cindex authentication PLAIN
27050 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27051 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27052 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27053 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27054 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27055
27056 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27057 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27058 configured as follows:
27059 .code
27060 fixed_plain:
27061 driver = plaintext
27062 public_name = PLAIN
27063 server_prompts = :
27064 server_condition = \
27065 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27066 server_set_id = $auth2
27067 .endd
27068 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27069 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27070 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27071 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27072
27073 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27074 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27075 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27076 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27077 .code
27078 250-AUTH PLAIN
27079 .endd
27080 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27081 .code
27082 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27083 .endd
27084 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27085 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27086 .code
27087 AUTH PLAIN
27088 .endd
27089 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27090 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27091
27092 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27093 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27094 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27095 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27096 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27097
27098 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27099 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27100 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27101
27102 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27103 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27104 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27105 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27106 This is an incorrect example:
27107 .code
27108 server_condition = \
27109 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27110 .endd
27111 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27112 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27113 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27114 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27115 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27116 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27117 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27118 .code
27119 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27120 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27121 .endd
27122 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27123 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27124 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27125 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27126 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27127
27128
27129 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27130 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27131 .cindex authentication LOGIN
27132 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27133 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27134 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27135 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27136 .code
27137 fixed_login:
27138 driver = plaintext
27139 public_name = LOGIN
27140 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27141 server_condition = \
27142 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27143 server_set_id = $auth1
27144 .endd
27145 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27146 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27147 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27148 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27149
27150 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27151 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27152 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27153 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27154 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27155 .code
27156 login:
27157 driver = plaintext
27158 public_name = LOGIN
27159 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27160 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27161 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27162 ldapauth{\
27163 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27164 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27165 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27166 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27167 .endd
27168 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27169 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27170 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27171 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27172 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27173 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27174 uninterpreted string.
27175
27176
27177 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27178 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27179 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27180 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27181 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27182 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27183
27184
27185
27186
27187 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27188 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27189 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27190
27191 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27192 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27193 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27194 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27195 usual.
27196
27197 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27198 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27199 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27200 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27201 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27202 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27203 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27204 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27205 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27206 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27207 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27208 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27209
27210 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27211 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27212
27213 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27214 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27215 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27216 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27217 the string.
27218
27219 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27220 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27221 .code
27222 fixed_plain:
27223 driver = plaintext
27224 public_name = PLAIN
27225 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27226 .endd
27227 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27228 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27229 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27230 .code
27231 fixed_login:
27232 driver = plaintext
27233 public_name = LOGIN
27234 client_send = : username : mysecret
27235 .endd
27236 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27237 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27238 prompts.
27239 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27240 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27241
27242
27243
27244
27245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27247
27248 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27249 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27250 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27251 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27252 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27253 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27254 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27255 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27256 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27257 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27258 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27259 available in plain text at either end.
27260
27261
27262 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27263 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27264 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27265 authenticator as a server:
27266
27267 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27268 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27269 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27270 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27271 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27272 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27273 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27274 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27275 returned to the client.
27276
27277 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27278 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27279 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27280 numeric variables for other things.
27281
27282 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27283 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27284 user name, authentication fails.
27285 .code
27286 fixed_cram:
27287 driver = cram_md5
27288 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27289 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27290 server_set_id = $auth1
27291 .endd
27292 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27293 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27294 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27295 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27296 .code
27297 lookup_cram:
27298 driver = cram_md5
27299 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27300 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27301 {$value}fail}
27302 server_set_id = $auth1
27303 .endd
27304 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27305 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27306
27307 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27308 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27309 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27310 realm, with:
27311 .code
27312 cyrusless_crammd5:
27313 driver = cram_md5
27314 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27315 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27316 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27317 server_set_id = $auth1
27318 .endd
27319
27320 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27321 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27322 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27323
27324
27325
27326 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27327 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27328 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27329
27330
27331 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27332 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27333 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27334
27335
27336 .vindex "&$host$&"
27337 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27338 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27339 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27340 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27341 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27342 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27343 send the message to the current server.
27344
27345 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27346 strings, is:
27347 .code
27348 fixed_cram:
27349 driver = cram_md5
27350 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27351 client_name = ph10
27352 client_secret = secret
27353 .endd
27354 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27355 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27356
27357
27358
27359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27361
27362 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27363 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27364 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27365 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27366 .cindex "Kerberos"
27367 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27368 at A L Digital Ltd.
27369
27370 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27371 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27372 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27373 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27374 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27375
27376 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27377 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27378 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27379 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27380
27381 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27382 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27383 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27384 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27385 depending on the driver you are using.
27386
27387 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27388 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27389 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27390 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27391 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27392 implementation.
27393
27394 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27395 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27396 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27397 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27398 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27399 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27400 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27401 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27402
27403
27404 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27405 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27406 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27407 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27408 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27409 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27410 things.
27411
27412
27413 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27414 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27415 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27416 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27417
27418
27419 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27420 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27421 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27422 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27423 example:
27424 .code
27425 sasl:
27426 driver = cyrus_sasl
27427 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27428 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27429 server_set_id = $auth1
27430 .endd
27431
27432 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27433 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27434
27435
27436 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27437 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27438
27439
27440 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27441 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27442 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27443 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27444 .code
27445 sasl_cram_md5:
27446 driver = cyrus_sasl
27447 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27448 server_set_id = $auth1
27449
27450 sasl_plain:
27451 driver = cyrus_sasl
27452 public_name = PLAIN
27453 server_set_id = $auth2
27454 .endd
27455 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27456 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27457 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27458 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27459 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27460
27461
27462
27463
27464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27466 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27467 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27468 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27469 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27470 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27471 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27472 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27473 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27474 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27475
27476 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27477
27478 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27479 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27480 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27481 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27482 .code
27483 dovecot_plain:
27484 driver = dovecot
27485 public_name = PLAIN
27486 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27487 server_set_id = $auth1
27488
27489 dovecot_ntlm:
27490 driver = dovecot
27491 public_name = NTLM
27492 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27493 server_set_id = $auth1
27494 .endd
27495 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27496 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27497 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27498 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27499 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27500 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27501
27502 .new
27503 The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27504 something like:
27505 .code
27506 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27507
27508 service auth {
27509 ...
27510 #SASL
27511 unix_listener auth-client {
27512 mode = 0660
27513 user = mail
27514 }
27515 ...
27516 }
27517
27518 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27519
27520 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27521 .endd
27522 .wen
27523
27524 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27525 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27526
27527
27528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27530 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27531 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27532 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27533 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27534 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27535 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27536 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27537 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27538 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27539 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27540 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27541 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
27542 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27543 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27544 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27545 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27546 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27547 without code changes in Exim.
27548
27549 .new
27550 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27551 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27552 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27553 when this happens.
27554
27555
27556 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27557 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27558 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27559 by &%client_username%& option.
27560 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27561 which is the common case.
27562
27563 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27564 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27565
27566 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27567 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27568 the password to be used, in clear.
27569
27570 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27571 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27572 the account name to be used.
27573 .wen
27574
27575 .new
27576 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
27577 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
27578 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
27579 The value after expansion should be
27580 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
27581 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
27582 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
27583 supplied by the server.
27584 .wen
27585
27586
27587
27588 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27589 Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27590 without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27591
27592 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27593 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27594 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27595 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27596 context.
27597
27598 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27599 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27600 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27601
27602 .new
27603 This is
27604 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27605 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27606 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27607 .wen
27608
27609 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27610 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27611 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27612
27613 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27614 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27615 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27616
27617
27618 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27619 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27620 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27621 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27622
27623
27624 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27625 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27626 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27627 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27628 example:
27629 .code
27630 sasl:
27631 driver = gsasl
27632 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27633 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27634 server_set_id = $auth1
27635 .endd
27636
27637
27638 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27639 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27640 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27641 the password itself.
27642
27643 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27644 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27645 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27646 if available, else the empty string.
27647 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27648 else the empty string.
27649
27650 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27651
27652 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27653 option to be simply "true".
27654
27655
27656 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27657 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27658 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27659
27660
27661 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27662 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27663 .new
27664 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27665 when this option is expanded.
27666
27667 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27668 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27669 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27670 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27671 either the iteration count or the salt).
27672 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27673 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
27674 .wen
27675
27676 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27677 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27678 .new
27679 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27680 when this option is expanded.
27681 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
27682 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
27683 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27684 protocol conversation.
27685 .wen
27686
27687
27688 .new
27689 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
27690 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
27691 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
27692 to provide stored information related to a password,
27693 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
27694
27695 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
27696 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
27697
27698 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
27699 When this is so, the macros
27700 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
27701 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
27702 will be defined.
27703
27704 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
27705
27706 If set, the results of expansion should for each
27707 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
27708 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
27709 &%server_password%& option.
27710 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
27711
27712 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
27713 to generate these values.
27714 .wen
27715
27716
27717 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27718 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27719 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27720
27721
27722 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27723 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27724 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27725 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27726
27727 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27728 meanings for these variables:
27729
27730 .ilist
27731 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27732 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27733 .next
27734 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27735 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27736 .next
27737 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27738 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27739 .endlist
27740
27741 On a per-mechanism basis:
27742
27743 .ilist
27744 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27745 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27746 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27747 .next
27748 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27749 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27750 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27751 .next
27752 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27753 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27754 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27755 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27756 .endlist
27757
27758 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27759 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27760 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27761
27762
27763 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27764 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27765 .code
27766 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27767 driver = gsasl
27768 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27769 server_realm = imap.example.org
27770 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27771 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27772 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27773 server_condition = yes
27774 .endd
27775
27776
27777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27779
27780 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27781 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27782 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27783 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27784 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27785 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27786 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27787 reliably.
27788
27789 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27790 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27791 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27792 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27793
27794 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27795 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27796 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27797 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27798
27799 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27800 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27801 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27802 from the keytab.
27803
27804
27805 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27806 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27807 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27808 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27809
27810 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27811 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27812 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27813 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27814
27815 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27816 .ilist
27817 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27818 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27819 .next
27820 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27821 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27822 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27823 GSS Display Name.
27824 .endlist
27825
27826
27827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27828 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27829
27830 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27831 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27832 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27833 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27834 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27835 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27836 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27837 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27838 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27839 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27840 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27841 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27842 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27843 follows:
27844
27845 .ilist
27846 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27847 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27848 .next
27849 The server sends back a challenge.
27850 .next
27851 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27852 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27853 .endlist
27854
27855 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27856
27857
27858
27859 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27860 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27861 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27862
27863 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27864 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27865 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27866 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27867 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27868 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27869 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27870 for other things. For example:
27871 .code
27872 spa:
27873 driver = spa
27874 public_name = NTLM
27875 server_password = \
27876 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27877 .endd
27878 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27879 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27880
27881
27882
27883
27884
27885 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27886 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27887 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27888
27889
27890
27891 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27892 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27893
27894
27895 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27896 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27897
27898
27899 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27900 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27901 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27902 &'msn.com'&:
27903 .code
27904 msn:
27905 driver = spa
27906 public_name = MSN
27907 client_username = msn/msn_username
27908 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27909 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27910 .endd
27911 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27912 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27913
27914
27915
27916
27917
27918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27920
27921 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27922 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27923 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27924 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27925 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27926 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27927 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27928 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27929 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27930 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27931 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27932 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27933 by the server configuration.
27934
27935 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27936 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27937 and for clients to only attempt,
27938 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27939
27940 One possible use, compatible with the
27941 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27942 is for using X509 client certificates.
27943
27944 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27945 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27946 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27947 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27948 client certificates only.
27949
27950 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27951 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27952
27953 The client must present a certificate,
27954 for which it must have been requested via the
27955 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27956 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27957 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27958 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27959
27960 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27961 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27962 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27963
27964 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27965 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27966 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27967 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27968 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27969 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27970 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27971
27972 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27973
27974 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27975 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27976 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27977 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27978 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27979 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27980
27981 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27982 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27983 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27984 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27985 an identity for authentication and
27986 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27987
27988 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27989 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27990 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27991 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27992
27993 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27994 Once an identity has been received,
27995 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27996 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27997 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27998 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27999 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28000 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28001 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28002 string as the error text.
28003
28004 Example:
28005 .code
28006 ext_ccert_san_mail:
28007 driver = external
28008 public_name = EXTERNAL
28009
28010 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28011 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28012 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28013 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28014 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28015 server_set_id = $auth1
28016 .endd
28017 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28018 of your configured trust-anchors
28019 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28020 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28021
28022 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28023 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28024 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28025 in this way.
28026
28027
28028 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28029 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28030 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28031
28032 .option client_send external string&!! unset
28033 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28034 identity being asserted.
28035
28036 Example:
28037 .code
28038 ext_ccert:
28039 driver = external
28040 public_name = EXTERNAL
28041
28042 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28043 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28044 .endd
28045
28046
28047 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
28048 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
28049
28050
28051
28052
28053
28054 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28055 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28056
28057 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28058 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28059 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28060 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28061 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28062 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28063 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28064 authentication based on client certificates.
28065
28066 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28067 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28068 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28069 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28070 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28071 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28072
28073 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28074 for which it must have been requested via the
28075 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28076 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28077
28078 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28079 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28080 and can authenticate the connection.
28081 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28082
28083 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28084
28085
28086 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28087 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28088
28089 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28090 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28091 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28092 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28093 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28094 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28095
28096 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28097 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28098 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28099
28100 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28101
28102
28103 Example:
28104 .code
28105 tls:
28106 driver = tls
28107 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28108 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28109 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28110 {forany {$auth1} \
28111 {!= {0} \
28112 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28113 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28114 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28115 } } } }}}
28116 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28117 .endd
28118 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28119 of your configured trust-anchors
28120 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28121 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28122
28123 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28124 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28125 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28126 in this way.
28127 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28128
28129 . An alternative might use
28130 . .code
28131 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28132 . .endd
28133 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28134 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28135 . This would help for per-device use.
28136 .
28137 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28138 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28139
28140 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28141 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28142
28143
28144 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28145 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28146 a connect- or helo-ACL.
28147
28148
28149
28150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28152
28153 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28154 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28155 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28156 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28157 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28158 .cindex "OpenSSL"
28159 .cindex "GnuTLS"
28160 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28161 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28162 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28163 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28164 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28165 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28166 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28167 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28168 certificates are used.
28169
28170 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28171 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28172 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28173 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28174 between them is encrypted.
28175
28176 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28177 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28178 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28179 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28180 encryption state.
28181
28182 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28183 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28184 in order to get TLS to work.
28185
28186
28187
28188 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28189 "SECID284"
28190 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28191 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28192 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28193 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28194 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28195 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28196 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28197 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28198 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28199 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28200 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28201
28202 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28203 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28204 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28205
28206 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28207 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28208 reassigned for other use.
28209 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28210 this port.
28211 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28212 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28213 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28214
28215 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28216 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28217 the most common use is expected to be:
28218 .code
28219 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28220 .endd
28221 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28222 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28223 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28224 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28225 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28226 defined elsewhere.
28227
28228 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28229 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28230
28231
28232
28233
28234
28235
28236 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28237 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28238 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28239 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28240 .code
28241 USE_OPENSSL=yes
28242 .endd
28243 in Local/Makefile.
28244
28245 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28246 .code
28247 USE_GNUTLS=yes
28248 .endd
28249 in Local/Makefile.
28250
28251 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28252 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28253
28254 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28255
28256 .ilist
28257 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28258 cannot be the path of a directory
28259 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28260 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28261 .next
28262 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28263 .next
28264 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28265 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28266 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28267 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28268 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28269 .next
28270 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28271 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28272 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28273 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28274 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28275 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28276 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28277 option).
28278 .next
28279 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28280 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28281 .next
28282 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28283 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28284 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28285 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28286 .next
28287 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28288 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28289 .next
28290 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28291 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28292 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28293 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28294 .endlist
28295
28296
28297 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28298 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28299 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28300 but not the chosen filename.
28301 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28302 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28303
28304 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28305 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28306 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28307 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28308 of bits requested.
28309 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28310 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28311 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28312 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28313 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28314 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28315 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28316
28317 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28318 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28319 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28320 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28321 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28322
28323 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28324 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28325 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28326 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28327 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28328 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28329
28330 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28331 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28332 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28333
28334 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28335 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28336 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28337 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28338 .code
28339 # ls
28340 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28341 # rm -f new-params
28342 # touch new-params
28343 # chown exim:exim new-params
28344 # chmod 0600 new-params
28345 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28346 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28347 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28348 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28349 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28350 # chmod 0400 new-params
28351 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28352 .endd
28353 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28354 stalling is removed.
28355
28356 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28357 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28358 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28359 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28360 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28361 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28362 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28363 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28364 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28365 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28366 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28367
28368 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28369 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28370 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28371 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28372
28373 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28374 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28375 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28376 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28377 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28378
28379
28380 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28381 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28382 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28383 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28384 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28385 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28386 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28387 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28388 directly to this function call.
28389 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28390 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28391 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28392 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28393
28394 .ilist
28395 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28396 .next
28397 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28398 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28399 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28400 SSL v3 algorithms.
28401 .next
28402 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28403 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28404 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28405 algorithms.
28406 .endlist
28407
28408 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28409 &`-`& or &`+`&.
28410 .ilist
28411 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28412 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28413 stated.
28414 .next
28415 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28416 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28417 .next
28418 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28419 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28420 .endlist
28421
28422 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28423 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28424 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28425 not be moved to the end of the list.
28426 .endlist
28427
28428 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28429 string:
28430 .code
28431 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28432 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28433 .endd
28434
28435 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28436 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28437 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28438 choice of clients used:
28439 .code
28440 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28441 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28442 {DEFAULT}\
28443 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28444 .endd
28445
28446 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28447 .code
28448 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28449 .endd
28450
28451 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28452 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28453 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28454 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28455
28456 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28457 .code
28458 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28459 .endd
28460
28461
28462 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28463 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28464 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28465 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28466 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28467 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28468 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28469 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28470 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28471 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28472 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28473 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28474
28475 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28476 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28477
28478 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28479 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28480 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28481 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28482 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28483 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28484
28485 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28486 "Priority strings". This is online as
28487 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28488 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28489 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28490 then the example code
28491 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28492 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28493
28494 For example:
28495 .code
28496 # Disable older versions of protocols
28497 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28498 .endd
28499
28500 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28501 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28502 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28503
28504 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28505 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28506 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28507 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28508 used:
28509 .code
28510 # GnuTLS variant
28511 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28512 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28513 {SECURE128}}
28514 .endd
28515
28516
28517 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28518 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28519 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28520 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28521 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28522 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28523 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28524
28525 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28526 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28527
28528 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28529 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28530 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28531 with the error
28532 .code
28533 554 Security failure
28534 .endd
28535 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28536 rejected with a 554 error code.
28537
28538 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28539 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28540
28541 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28542 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28543 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28544 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28545
28546 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28547
28548 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28549 .code
28550 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28551 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28552 .endd
28553 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28554 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28555 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28556 that goes with it. These files need to be
28557 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28558 always be given as full path names.
28559 The key must not be password-protected.
28560 They can be the same file if both the
28561 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28562 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28563 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28564 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28565 the server's certificate.
28566
28567 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28568 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28569 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28570 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28571 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28572 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28573
28574 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28575 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28576 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28577
28578 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28579 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28580 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28581 transport.
28582
28583 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28584 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28585 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28586 .code
28587 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28588 .endd
28589 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28590 with the parameters contained in the file.
28591 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28592 available:
28593 .code
28594 tls_dhparam = none
28595 .endd
28596 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28597 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28598 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28599 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28600
28601 See the command
28602 .code
28603 openssl dhparam
28604 .endd
28605 for a way of generating file data.
28606
28607 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28608 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28609 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28610 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28611 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28612
28613 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28614 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28615 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28616 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28617 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28618 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28619 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28620 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28621 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28622
28623 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28624 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28625 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28626 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28627 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28628 documentation for more details.
28629
28630 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28631 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28632
28633
28634 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28635 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28636 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28637 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28638 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28639 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28640 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28641 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28642 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28643 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28644 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28645 an explicit file or,
28646 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28647 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28648
28649 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28650 directory is used
28651 (OpenSSL only),
28652 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28653 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28654 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28655 .code
28656 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28657 .endd
28658 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28659
28660 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28661 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28662
28663 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28664 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28665 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28666 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28667 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28668 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28669 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28670 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28671 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28672 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28673
28674 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28675 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28676 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28677 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28678
28679 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28680 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28681 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28682 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28683 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28684 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28685
28686
28687 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28688 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28689 .cindex "revocation list"
28690 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28691 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28692 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28693 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28694 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28695 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28696 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28697 CRL in PEM format.
28698 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28699 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28700
28701 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28702 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28703 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28704 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28705 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28706 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28707
28708 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28709 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28710 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28711 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28712
28713 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28714 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28715 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28716 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28717 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28718 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28719 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28720 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28721
28722 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28723 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28724 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28725
28726 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28727 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28728 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28729 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28730 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28731
28732 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28733 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28734 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28735 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28736 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28737 next connection.
28738
28739 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28740 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28741 ignored.
28742
28743 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28744 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28745 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28746 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28747 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28748 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28749
28750 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28751 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28752
28753 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28754
28755 .code
28756 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28757 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28758 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28759
28760 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28761 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28762 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28763 .endd
28764
28765
28766
28767
28768 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28769 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28770 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28771 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28772 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28773 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28774 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28775 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28776 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28777
28778 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28779 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28780 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28781 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28782 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28783
28784 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28785 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28786 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28787 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28788 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28789 usual way.
28790
28791 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28792 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28793 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28794 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28795 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28796 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28797 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28798 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28799 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28800 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28801 unencrypted.
28802
28803 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28804 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28805 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28806 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28807
28808 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28809 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28810 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28811 in failed connections.
28812
28813 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28814 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28815 These may be
28816 the system default set (depending on library version),
28817 a file,
28818 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28819 The client verifies the server's certificate
28820 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28821 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28822 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28823 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28824
28825 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28826 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28827 or need not succeed respectively.
28828
28829 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28830 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28831 is valid for the certificate.
28832 The option defaults to always checking.
28833
28834 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28835 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28836 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28837 value is empty.
28838 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28839 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28840 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28841 otherwise.
28842
28843 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28844 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28845 for OCSP to be relevant.
28846
28847 If
28848 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28849 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28850 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28851 alternative hosts, if any.
28852
28853 &*Note*&:
28854 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28855 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28856 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28857 client.
28858
28859 .vindex "&$host$&"
28860 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28861 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28862 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28863 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28864 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28865
28866 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28867 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28868 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28869 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28870 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28871 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28872 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28873 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28874 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28875 outgoing connection.
28876
28877
28878
28879 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28880 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28881 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28882 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28883 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28884 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28885 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28886 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28887 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28888 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28889 for this session.
28890
28891 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28892 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28893 address.
28894
28895 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28896 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28897 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28898 be of limited use in that environment.
28899
28900 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28901 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28902 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28903 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28904 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28905
28906 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28907 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28908 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28909 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28910 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28911
28912 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28913 received from a client.
28914 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28915
28916 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28917 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28918 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28919
28920 .ilist
28921 &%tls_certificate%&
28922 .next
28923 &%tls_crl%&
28924 .next
28925 &%tls_privatekey%&
28926 .next
28927 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28928 .next
28929 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
28930 .endlist
28931
28932 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28933 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28934 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28935 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28936 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28937 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28938 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28939
28940 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28941 are re-expanded.
28942
28943 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28944 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28945 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28946 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28947
28948 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28949 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28950 built, then you have SNI support).
28951
28952
28953
28954 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28955 "SECTmulmessam"
28956 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28957 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28958 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28959 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28960 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28961 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28962 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28963 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28964 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28965 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28966
28967 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28968 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28969 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28970 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28971 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28972 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28973 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28974
28975 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28976 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28977 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28978 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28979 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28980 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28981 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28982 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28983 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28984
28985 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28986 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28987 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28988 information is recorded.
28989
28990 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28991 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28992 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28993
28994
28995
28996
28997 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28998 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28999 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29000 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29001 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29002 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29003
29004 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29005 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29006 document is currently at
29007 .display
29008 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29009 .endd
29010 and their FAQ is at
29011 .display
29012 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29013 .endd
29014
29015 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
29016 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29017 descriptions.
29018 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29019 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29020 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29021 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29022
29023
29024 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29025 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29026 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29027 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29028 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29029 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29030 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29031 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29032 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29033 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29034 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29035 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29036 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29037
29038 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29039 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29040 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29041 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29042
29043
29044
29045 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29046 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29047 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29048 with OpenSSL, like this:
29049 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29050 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29051 .code
29052 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29053 -days 9999 -nodes
29054 .endd
29055 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29056 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29057 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29058 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29059 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29060 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29061 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29062
29063 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29064 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29065 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29066 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29067 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29068 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29069 . ==== -pdp, 2012
29070 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29071 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29072 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29073 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29074 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29075 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29076 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29077 be a sensible resolution).
29078
29079 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29080 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29081 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29082
29083 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29084 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29085 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29086 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29087 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29088 signed with that self-signed certificate.
29089
29090 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29091 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29092 Open-source PKI book, available online at
29093 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29094 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29095 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29096
29097
29098
29099 .section DANE "SECDANE"
29100 .cindex DANE
29101 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29102 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29103 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29104 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29105 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29106 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29107
29108 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29109 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29110 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29111
29112 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29113 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29114
29115 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29116 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29117 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29118
29119 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29120 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29121 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29122 DNSSEC.
29123 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
29124 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29125
29126 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29127 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29128 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29129 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29130
29131 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29132 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29133 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29134 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29135
29136 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29137 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29138 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29139 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29140 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29141 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29142 well-known one.
29143 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29144 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29145 does require careful arrangement.
29146 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29147 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29148 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29149 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29150 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29151
29152 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29153 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29154 your certificate.
29155 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29156 "MTA-STS", described below.
29157
29158 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29159 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29160 connections to you.
29161 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29162 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29163 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29164 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29165 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29166 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29167
29168 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29169 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29170 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29171 random serial numbers.
29172 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29173 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29174 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29175 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29176
29177 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29178 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29179
29180 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29181
29182 .code
29183 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29184 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29185 | openssl sha512 \
29186 | awk '{print $2}'
29187 .endd
29188
29189 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29190
29191 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29192
29193 .code
29194 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29195 .endd
29196
29197 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29198 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29199
29200
29201 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29202
29203 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29204 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29205 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29206 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29207 libraries.
29208 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29209 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29210
29211 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29212 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29213 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29214
29215 .code
29216 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29217 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29218 {*}{}}
29219 .endd
29220
29221 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29222 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29223 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29224 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29225 control the OCSP request.
29226
29227 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29228 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29229
29230
29231 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29232 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29233 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29234 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29235 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29236
29237 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29238
29239 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29240 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29241 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29242 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29243
29244 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29245 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29246 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29247 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29248 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29249 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29250 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29251
29252 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29253 .code
29254 hosts_require_tls
29255 tls_verify_hosts
29256 tls_try_verify_hosts
29257 tls_verify_certificates
29258 tls_crl
29259 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29260 .endd
29261
29262 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29263 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29264
29265 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29266 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29267
29268 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29269
29270 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29271 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29272 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29273 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29274
29275 .cindex DANE reporting
29276 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29277 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29278 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29279 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29280 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29281 Section 4.3 of that document.
29282
29283 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29284
29285 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29286 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29287 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29288 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29289 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29290 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29291 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29292 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29293 information.
29294
29295 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29296 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29297 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29298
29299 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29300 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29301 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29302 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29303 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29304 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29305 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29306
29307
29308
29309 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29311
29312 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29313 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29314 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29315 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29316 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29317 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29318 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29319 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29320 one very small ACL:
29321 .code
29322 begin acl
29323 small_acl:
29324 accept hosts = one.host.only
29325 .endd
29326 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29327 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29328
29329 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29330 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29331 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29332 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29333 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29334 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29335 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29336 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29337
29338
29339 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29340 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29341 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29342
29343
29344 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29345 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29346 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29347 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29348 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29349 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29350 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29351 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29352 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29353 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29354 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29355 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29356 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29357 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29358 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29359 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29360 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29361 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29362 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29363 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29364
29365 .table2 140pt
29366 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29367 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29368 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29369 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29370 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29371 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29372 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29373 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29374 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29375 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29376 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29377 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29378 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29379 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29380 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29381 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29382 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29383 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29384 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29385 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29386 .endtable
29387
29388 For example, if you set
29389 .code
29390 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29391 .endd
29392 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29393 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29394 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29395 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29396 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29397 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29398 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29399
29400
29401 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29402 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29403 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29404 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29405 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29406 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29407 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29408 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29409 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29410 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29411 in any of these ACLs.
29412
29413 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29414 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29415 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29416 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29417 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29418 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29419 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29420 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29421 .code
29422 control = suppress_local_fixups
29423 .endd
29424 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29425 run, it is too late.
29426
29427 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29428 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29429
29430 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29431 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29432 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29433
29434
29435 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29436 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29437 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29438 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29439 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29440 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29441 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29442 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29443 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29444
29445
29446 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29447 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29448 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29449 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29450 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29451 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29452 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29453 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29454 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29455
29456 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29457 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29458 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29459
29460 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29461 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29462 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29463 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29464 an EHLO response.
29465
29466
29467 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29468 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29469 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29470 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29471 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29472 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29473 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29474 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29475 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29476 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29477
29478 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29479 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29480 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29481 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29482 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29483 associated with the DATA command.
29484
29485 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29486 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29487 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29488 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29489 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29490 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29491 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29492 the data specified is received.
29493
29494 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29495 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29496 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29497 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29498 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29499 your resources.
29500
29501 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29502 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29503 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29504 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29505
29506 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29507 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29508 enabled (which is the default).
29509
29510 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29511 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29512 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29513
29514 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29515
29516 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29517
29518
29519 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29520 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29521 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29522
29523 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29524
29525
29526 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29527 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29528 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29529 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29530 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29531 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29532 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29533 has been accepted.
29534
29535 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29536 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29537 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29538 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29539 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29540 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29541 for some or all recipients.
29542
29543 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29544 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29545 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29546 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29547 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29548 is &"yes"&.
29549 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29550 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29551 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29552
29553 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29554 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29555
29556 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29557 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29558 the feature was not requested by the client.
29559
29560 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29561 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29562 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29563 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29564 does not in fact control any access.
29565 For this reason, it may only accept
29566 or warn as its final result.
29567
29568 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29569 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29570 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29571 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29572
29573 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29574 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29575
29576 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29577 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29578 response to QUIT.
29579
29580 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29581 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29582 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29583 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29584 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29585
29586
29587 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29588 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29589 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29590 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29591 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29592 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29593 situation even worse.
29594
29595 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29596 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29597 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29598 and &%warn%&.
29599
29600 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29601 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29602 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29603 connection. The possible values are:
29604 .table2
29605 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29606 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29607 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29608 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29609 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29610 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29611 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29612 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29613 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29614 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29615 .endtable
29616 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29617 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29618 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29619 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29620 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29621 used.
29622
29623
29624 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29625 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29626 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29627 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29628 .code
29629 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29630 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29631 .endd
29632 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29633 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29634 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29635 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29636 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29637
29638 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29639 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29640 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29641
29642 .ilist
29643 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29644 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29645 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29646 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29647 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29648 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29649 .code
29650 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29651 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29652 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29653 .endd
29654 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29655 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29656 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29657 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29658 .next
29659 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29660 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29661 matches the string.
29662 .next
29663 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29664 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29665 want to have something like
29666 .code
29667 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29668 .endd
29669 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29670 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29671 .endlist
29672
29673
29674
29675
29676 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29677 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29678 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29679 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29680 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29681 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29682 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29683 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29684 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29685
29686 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29687 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29688 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29689
29690
29691 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29692 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29693 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29694 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29695
29696 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29697 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29698 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29699 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29700 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29701 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29702 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29703
29704 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29705 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29706
29707
29708 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29709 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29710 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29711
29712
29713
29714 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29715 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29716 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29717 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29718 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29719 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29720
29721 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29722 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29723 used to accept or reject anything.
29724
29725 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29726 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29727 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29728 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29729
29730 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29731 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29732 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29733 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29734 configuration file.
29735
29736
29737
29738
29739 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29740 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29741 .vindex &$domain$&
29742 .vindex &$local_part$&
29743 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29744 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29745 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29746 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29747 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29748 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29749 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29750 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29751 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29752
29753 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29754 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29755 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29756 how it is used.
29757
29758 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29759 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29760 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29761 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29762 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29763 received).
29764
29765 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29766 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29767 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29768 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29769 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29770 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29771 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29772 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29773
29774
29775
29776
29777
29778 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29779 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29780 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29781 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29782 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29783 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29784 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29785 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29786 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29787 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29788 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29789 unencrypted connections.
29790 .code
29791 acl_check_auth:
29792 accept encrypted = *
29793 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29794 {CRAM-MD5}}
29795 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29796 .endd
29797 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29798 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29799 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29800 option to do this.)
29801
29802
29803
29804 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29805 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29806 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29807 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29808 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29809 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29810 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29811
29812 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29813 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29814 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29815 example:
29816 .code
29817 deny dnslists = list1.example
29818 dnslists = list2.example
29819 .endd
29820 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29821 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29822 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29823 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29824 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29825
29826
29827 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29828 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29829
29830 .ilist
29831 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29832 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29833 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29834 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29835 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29836 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29837 check a RCPT command:
29838 .code
29839 accept domains = +local_domains
29840 endpass
29841 verify = recipient
29842 .endd
29843 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29844 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29845 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29846 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29847 &%endpass%&.
29848
29849 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29850 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29851 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29852 configuration.
29853
29854 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29855 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29856 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29857 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29858 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29859 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29860 .display
29861 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29862 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29863 .endd
29864 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29865 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29866 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29867
29868 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29869 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29870 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29871 of &%endpass%&.
29872
29873
29874 .next
29875 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29876 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29877 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29878 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29879 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29880 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29881 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29882
29883
29884 .next
29885 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29886 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29887 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29888 example,
29889 .code
29890 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29891 .endd
29892 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29893
29894
29895 .next
29896 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29897 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29898 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29899 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29900 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29901 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29902 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29903 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29904 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29905
29906 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29907 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29908 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29909
29910
29911 .next
29912 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29913 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29914 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29915 .code
29916 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29917 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29918 .endd
29919 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29920 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29921
29922 .next
29923 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29924 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29925 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29926 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29927 .code
29928 require message = Sender did not verify
29929 verify = sender
29930 .endd
29931 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29932 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29933 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29934 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29935
29936 .next
29937 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29938 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29939 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29940 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29941 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29942 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29943 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29944
29945 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29946 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29947 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29948 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29949 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29950
29951 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29952 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29953 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29954 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29955 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29956 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29957 onwards.
29958
29959
29960 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29961 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29962 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29963 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29964 .code
29965 warn !verify = sender
29966 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29967 .endd
29968 .endlist
29969
29970 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29971
29972 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29973 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29974 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29975 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29976 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29977
29978
29979
29980 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29981 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29982 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29983 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29984 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29985 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29986 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29987 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29988 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29989 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29990 .ilist
29991 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29992 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29993 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29994 on the same SMTP connection.
29995 .next
29996 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29997 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29998 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29999 .endlist
30000
30001 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30002 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30003 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30004 .code
30005 accept hosts = whatever
30006 set acl_m4 = some value
30007 accept authenticated = *
30008 set acl_c_auth = yes
30009 .endd
30010 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30011 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30012 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30013
30014 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30015 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30016 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30017 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30018 error is generated.
30019
30020 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30021 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30022
30023
30024 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30025 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30026 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30027 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30028 .code
30029 deny domains = *.dom.example
30030 !verify = recipient
30031 .endd
30032 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30033 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30034 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30035 two statements are equivalent:
30036 .code
30037 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30038 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30039 .endd
30040 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30041 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30042
30043 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30044 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30045 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30046 .code
30047 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30048 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30049 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30050 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30051 .endd
30052 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30053 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30054 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30055 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30056 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30057 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30058 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30059
30060 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30061 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30062 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30063 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30064 message is handled.
30065
30066 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30067 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30068 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30069 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30070 .code
30071 require message = Can't verify sender
30072 verify = sender
30073 message = Can't verify recipient
30074 verify = recipient
30075 message = This message cannot be used
30076 .endd
30077 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30078 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30079 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30080 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30081 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30082 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30083
30084 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30085 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30086 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30087 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30088 .code
30089 deny hosts = ...
30090 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30091 message = Invalid sender from client host
30092 .endd
30093 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30094 by which time Exim has set up the message.
30095
30096
30097
30098 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30099 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30100 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30101
30102 .vlist
30103 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30104 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30105 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30106 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30107
30108 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30109 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30110 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30111 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30112 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30113 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30114 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30115 write rather ugly lines like this:
30116 .display
30117 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30118 .endd
30119 Instead, all you need is
30120 .display
30121 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30122 .endd
30123
30124 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30125 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30126 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30127 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30128 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30129 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30130 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30131 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30132
30133 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30134 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30135 in several different ways. For example:
30136
30137 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30138 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30139 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30140 . ==== way.
30141
30142 .ilist
30143 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30144 .code
30145 accept ...some conditions
30146 control = queue_only
30147 .endd
30148 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30149 other words, when the conditions are all true.
30150
30151 .next
30152 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30153 .code
30154 accept ...some conditions...
30155 control = queue_only
30156 ...some more conditions...
30157 .endd
30158 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30159 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30160 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30161 to be relevant.
30162
30163 .next
30164 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30165 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30166 example:
30167 .code
30168 warn ...some conditions...
30169 control = freeze
30170 accept ...
30171 .endd
30172 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30173 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30174 log entry.
30175
30176 .next
30177 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30178 &%require%& verb. For example:
30179 .code
30180 require control = no_multiline_responses
30181 .endd
30182 .endlist
30183
30184 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30185 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30186 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
30187 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30188 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30189 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30190 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30191 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30192 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30193
30194 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30195 example:
30196 .code
30197 deny ...some conditions...
30198 delay = 30s
30199 .endd
30200 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30201 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
30202 .code
30203 deny delay = 30s
30204 ...some conditions...
30205 .endd
30206 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30207 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30208 .code
30209 warn ...some conditions...
30210 delay = 2m
30211 control = freeze
30212 accept ...
30213 .endd
30214
30215 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30216 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30217 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30218 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30219 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30220 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30221 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30222
30223
30224 .vitem &*endpass*&
30225 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30226 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30227 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30228 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30229 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30230 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30231 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30232
30233
30234 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30235 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30236 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30237 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30238 .code
30239 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30240 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30241 .endd
30242 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30243 example:
30244 .display
30245 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30246 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30247 .endd
30248 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30249 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30250 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30251 message.
30252
30253 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30254 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30255 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30256 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30257 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30258 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30259 ignored.
30260
30261 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30262 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30263 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30264 error message.
30265
30266 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30267 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30268 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30269 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30270 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30271 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30272
30273 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30274 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30275 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30276 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30277 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30278 logging rejections.
30279
30280
30281 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30282 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30283 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30284 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30285 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30286 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30287 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30288 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30289 .display
30290 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30291 &` log_reject_target =`&
30292 .endd
30293 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30294 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30295 current ACL.
30296
30297
30298 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30299 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30300 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30301 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30302 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30303 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30304 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30305 ACLs. For example:
30306 .display
30307 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30308 &` control = freeze`&
30309 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30310 .endd
30311 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30312 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30313 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30314 example:
30315 .code
30316 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30317 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30318 .endd
30319
30320
30321 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30322 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30323 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30324 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30325 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30326 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30327 &%accept%& for details.)
30328
30329 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30330 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30331 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30332 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30333 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30334 .code
30335 require message = Host not recognized
30336 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30337 .endd
30338 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30339 processed.)
30340
30341 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30342 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30343 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30344 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30345 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30346 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30347 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30348 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30349 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30350 EHLO options.
30351
30352 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30353 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30354 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30355 .code
30356 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30357 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30358 .endd
30359 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30360 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30361 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30362 2&'xx'&.
30363
30364 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30365 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30366
30367 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30368 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30369 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30370 response.
30371
30372 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30373 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30374 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30375
30376 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30377 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30378 However, the original message is available in the variable
30379 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30380 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30381 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30382 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30383
30384 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30385 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30386 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30387 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30388 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30389 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30390 effect.
30391
30392
30393 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30394 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30395 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30396 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30397 for the message.
30398 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30399 the DATA ACL).
30400 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30401 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30402 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30403 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30404
30405
30406 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30407 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30408 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30409 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30410
30411
30412 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30413 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30414 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30415 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30416
30417
30418 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30419 .cindex "UDP communications"
30420 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30421 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30422 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30423 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30424 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30425 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30426 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30427 when:
30428 .code
30429 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30430 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30431 .endd
30432 .endlist
30433
30434
30435
30436
30437 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30438 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30439 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30440
30441 .vlist
30442 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30443 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30444 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30445 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30446 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30447 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30448 not work without it. For example:
30449 .code
30450 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30451 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30452 .endd
30453 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30454 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30455 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30456 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30457 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30458
30459
30460 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30461 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30462 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30463 .cindex "case of local parts"
30464 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30465 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30466 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30467 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30468 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30469 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30470 is encountered.
30471
30472 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30473 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30474 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30475 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30476 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30477
30478 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30479 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30480 spam score:
30481 .code
30482 warn control = caseful_local_part
30483 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30484 $acl_m4 + \
30485 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30486 }
30487 control = caselower_local_part
30488 .endd
30489 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30490 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30491
30492
30493 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30494 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30495 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30496 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30497
30498 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30499 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30500 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30501 is used for all recipients of the message,
30502 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30503 and data is copied from one to the other.
30504
30505 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30506 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30507 If a recipient-verify callout
30508 (with use_sender)
30509 connection is subsequently
30510 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30511 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30512 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30513
30514 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30515 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30516 Note also that headers cannot be
30517 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30518 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30519 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30520 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30521 this will affect the timestamp.
30522
30523 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30524 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30525 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30526 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30527 message body.
30528
30529 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30530 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30531 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30532 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30533 or CHUNKING
30534 options in use.
30535
30536 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30537 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30538 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30539 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30540 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30541
30542 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30543 usual fashion.
30544 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30545 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30546 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30547 and does not queue the message.
30548 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30549
30550 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30551 (possibly faked)
30552 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30553
30554
30555 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30556 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30557 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30558 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30559 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30560 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30561 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30562 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30563 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30564 option.
30565 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30566 with the &'kill'& option.
30567 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30568 contexts):
30569 .code
30570 control = debug
30571 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30572 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30573 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30574 control = debug/kill
30575 .endd
30576
30577
30578 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30579 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30580 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30581 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30582 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30583
30584
30585 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30586 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30587 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30588 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30589 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30590
30591
30592 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30593 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30594 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30595 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30596 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30597 strings or to numeric value.
30598 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30599 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30600 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30601
30602 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30603 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30604 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30605 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30606 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30607
30608
30609 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30610 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30611 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30612 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30613 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30614 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30615 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30616 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30617
30618 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30619 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30620 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30621 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30622 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30623 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30624 work with.
30625
30626
30627 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30628 .cindex "fake defer"
30629 .cindex "defer, fake"
30630 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30631 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30632 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30633 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30634 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30635
30636 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30637 .cindex "fake rejection"
30638 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30639 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30640 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30641 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30642 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30643 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30644 the same SMTP connection.
30645
30646 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30647 message is supplied, the following is used:
30648 .code
30649 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30650 550-kept for evaluation.
30651 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30652 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30653 .endd
30654 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30655
30656 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30657 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30658 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30659 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30660 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30661 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30662 SMTP connection.
30663
30664 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30665 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30666 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30667 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30668
30669 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30670 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30671 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30672 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30673 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30674 disables such output flushing.
30675
30676 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30677 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30678 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30679 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30680 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30681 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30682
30683 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30684 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30685 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30686 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30687 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30688 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30689 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30690 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30691 to be useful in production.
30692
30693 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30694 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30695 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30696 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30697 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30698
30699 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30700 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30701 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30702 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30703 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30704 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30705
30706 .ilist
30707 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30708 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30709 verification failed"&) is sent.
30710 .next
30711 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30712 line is output.
30713 .endlist
30714
30715 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30716 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30717
30718 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30719 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30720 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30721 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30722 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30723 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30724 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30725
30726 .new
30727 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
30728 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30729 .oindex "&%queue%&"
30730 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30731 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30732 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
30733 .cindex "first pass routing"
30734 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30735 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30736 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30737 runner.
30738 If used with no options set,
30739 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30740 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
30741
30742 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
30743 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
30744 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
30745 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
30746 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
30747 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
30748
30749 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
30750 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30751 .wen
30752
30753 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30754 .cindex "message" "submission"
30755 .cindex "submission mode"
30756 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30757 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30758 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30759 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30760 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30761 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30762 late (the message has already been created).
30763
30764 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30765 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30766 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30767 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30768 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30769
30770 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30771 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30772 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30773 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30774 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30775
30776 .ilist
30777 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30778 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30779 .next
30780 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30781 .next
30782 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30783 .endlist ilist
30784
30785 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30786 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30787 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30788 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30789 data is read.
30790
30791 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30792 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30793
30794 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30795 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30796 to a-label form.
30797 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30798 .endlist vlist
30799
30800
30801 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30802 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30803
30804 .ilist
30805 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30806 .next
30807 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30808 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30809 .next
30810 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30811 .next
30812 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30813 .endlist
30814
30815
30816
30817 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30818 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30819 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30820 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30821 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30822 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30823 .code
30824 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30825 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30826 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30827 .endd
30828 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30829 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30830 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30831 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30832 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30833 RCPT ACL).
30834
30835 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30836 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30837
30838 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30839 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30840 contains one or more newlines that
30841 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30842 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30843 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30844
30845 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30846 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30847 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30848 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30849 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30850 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30851 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30852 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30853 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30854 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30855 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30856
30857 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30858 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30859 of message headers
30860 until they are added to the
30861 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30862 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30863 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30864 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30865 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30866 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30867 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30868
30869 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30870
30871 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30872 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30873 .display
30874 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30875 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30876
30877 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30878 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30879 .endd
30880 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30881 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30882 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30883 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30884 honoured.
30885
30886 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30887 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30888 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30889 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30890 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30891 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30892 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30893 specifications.
30894
30895 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30896 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30897 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30898 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30899 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30900
30901 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30902 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30903 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30904 to be a header name first.) For example:
30905 .code
30906 warn add_header = \
30907 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30908 .endd
30909 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30910 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30911 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30912 up in reverse order.
30913
30914 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30915 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30916 system filter or in a router or transport.
30917
30918
30919
30920 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30921 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30922 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30923 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30924 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30925 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30926 .code
30927 warn message = Remove internal headers
30928 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30929 .endd
30930 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30931 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30932 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30933 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30934 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30935 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30936
30937 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30938 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30939
30940 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30941 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30942 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30943 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30944 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30945 .code
30946 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30947 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30948 warn message = Remove internal headers
30949 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30950 .endd
30951 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30952 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30953 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30954 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30955 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30956 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30957 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30958 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30959 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30960 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30961 would have been removed.
30962
30963 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30964 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30965 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30966 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30967 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30968 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30969 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30970 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30971 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30972
30973 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30974 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30975 .display
30976 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30977 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30978
30979 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30980 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30981 .endd
30982 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30983 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30984 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30985 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30986 are honoured.
30987
30988 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30989 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30990 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30991
30992
30993
30994
30995 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30996 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30997 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30998 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30999 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31000 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31001
31002 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31003 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31004 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31005 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31006 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31007 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31008 The conditions are as follows:
31009
31010
31011 .vlist
31012 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31013 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31014 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31015 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31016 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31017 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31018 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31019 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31020 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31021 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31022 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31023 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31024
31025 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31026 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31027 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31028 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31029 The name and values are expanded separately.
31030 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31031 will act as argument separators.
31032
31033 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31034 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31035 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31036 conditions are tested.
31037
31038 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31039 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31040 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31041 for different local users or different local domains.
31042
31043 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31044 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31045 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31046 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31047 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31048 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31049 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31050 .code
31051 authenticated = *
31052 .endd
31053
31054 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31055 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31056 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31057 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31058 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31059 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31060 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31061 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31062 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31063 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31064 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31065 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31066 negative.
31067
31068 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31069 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31070 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31071 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31072 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31073 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31074 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31075 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31076
31077 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31078 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31079 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31080 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31081 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31082 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31083 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31084 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31085 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31086 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31087
31088 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31089 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31090 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31091 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31092 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31093 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31094 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31095 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31096 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31097 &%domains%& test.
31098
31099 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31100 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31101
31102
31103 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31104 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31105 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31106 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31107 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31108 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31109 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
31110 .code
31111 encrypted = *
31112 .endd
31113
31114
31115 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
31116 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
31117 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
31118 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
31119 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
31120 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
31121 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
31122 .code
31123 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31124 .endd
31125 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31126 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31127 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31128
31129 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31130 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31131 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31132 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31133 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31134 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31135
31136 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31137 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31138 .code
31139 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31140 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31141 .endd
31142 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31143 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31144 statement can then check the IP address.
31145
31146 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
31147 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31148 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31149 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31150 .code
31151 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31152 message = $host_data
31153 .endd
31154 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31155
31156 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31157 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31158 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31159 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31160 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31161 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31162 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31163 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31164 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31165 the next &%local_parts%& test.
31166
31167 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31168 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31169 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31170 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31171 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31172 content-scanning extension
31173 and only after a DATA command.
31174 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31175 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31176
31177 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31178 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31179 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31180 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31181 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31182 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31183 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31184 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31185
31186 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31187 .cindex "rate limiting"
31188 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31189 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31190
31191 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31192 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31193 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31194 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31195 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31196 recipient address against a list of recipients.
31197
31198 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31199 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31200 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31201 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31202 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31203 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31204 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31205
31206 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31207 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31208 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31209 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31210 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31211 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31212 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31213 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31214 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31215 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31216 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31217 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31218 influence the sender checking.
31219
31220 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31221 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31222
31223 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31224 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31225 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31226 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31227 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31228 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31229 .code
31230 senders = :
31231 .endd
31232 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31233 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31234
31235 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31236 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31237 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31238 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31239 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31240 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31241
31242 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31243 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31244 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31245 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31246 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31247 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31248 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31249 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31250 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31251 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31252
31253 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31254 .cindex "CSA verification"
31255 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31256 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31257 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31258
31259 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31260 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31261 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31262 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31263 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31264 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31265 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31266 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31267 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31268 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31269
31270 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31271 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31272 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31273
31274 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31275 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31276 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31277 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31278 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31279 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31280 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31281 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31282 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31283 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31284 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31285 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31286 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31287 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31288 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31289
31290 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31291 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31292 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31293 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31294 .code
31295 deny senders = :
31296 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31297 !verify = header_sender
31298 .endd
31299
31300 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31301 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31302 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31303 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31304 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31305 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31306 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31307 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31308 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31309 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31310 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31311 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31312 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31313 appropriate.
31314
31315 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31316 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31317 .code
31318 To: @
31319 .endd
31320 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31321 common as they used to be.
31322
31323 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31324 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31325 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31326 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31327 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31328 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31329 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31330 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31331 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31332 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31333 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31334 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31335 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31336
31337 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31338 option), this condition is always true.
31339
31340
31341 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31342 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31343 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31344 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31345 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31346 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31347 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31348 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31349 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31350
31351 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31352 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31353
31354 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31355 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31356
31357
31358 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31359 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31360 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31361 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31362 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31363 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31364 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31365 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31366 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31367 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31368 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31369 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31370 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31371 value for the child address.
31372
31373 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31374 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31375 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31376 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31377 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31378 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31379 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31380 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31381 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31382 original IP address.
31383
31384 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31385 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31386
31387 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31388 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31389
31390 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31391 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31392 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31393 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31394 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31395 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31396 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31397 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31398 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31399
31400 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31401 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31402 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31403 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31404 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31405 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31406 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31407
31408 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31409 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31410 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31411
31412 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31413 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31414 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31415 verified as a sender.
31416
31417 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31418 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31419 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31420 .code
31421 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31422 .endd
31423 .endlist
31424
31425
31426
31427 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31428 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31429 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31430 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31431 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31432 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31433 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31434 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31435 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31436 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31437 .code
31438 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31439 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31440 .endd
31441 the following records are looked up:
31442 .code
31443 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31444 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31445 .endd
31446 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31447 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31448 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31449 use two separate conditions:
31450 .code
31451 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31452 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31453 .endd
31454 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31455 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31456 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31457 processed.
31458
31459 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31460 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31461 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31462 following special items in the list:
31463 .display
31464 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31465 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31466 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31467 .endd
31468 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31469 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31470 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31471 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31472 .code
31473 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31474 .endd
31475 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31476 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31477 .code
31478 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31479 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31480 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31481 .endd
31482 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31483 .cindex DNS TTL
31484 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31485 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31486 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31487 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31488 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31489 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31490
31491 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31492 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31493 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31494
31495
31496
31497 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31498 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31499 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31500 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31501 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31502 .code
31503 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31504 .endd
31505 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31506 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31507 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31508 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31509
31510
31511
31512
31513 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31514 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31515 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31516 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31517 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31518 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31519 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31520 .code
31521 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31522 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31523 .endd
31524 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31525 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31526 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31527 up by this example is
31528 .code
31529 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31530 .endd
31531 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31532 addresses. For example:
31533 .code
31534 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31535 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31536 .endd
31537 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31538 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31539
31540
31541
31542
31543 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31544 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31545 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31546 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31547 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31548 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31549 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31550 either to double the separators like this:
31551 .code
31552 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31553 .endd
31554 or to change the separator character, like this:
31555 .code
31556 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31557 .endd
31558 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31559 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31560 occurs. Consider this condition:
31561 .code
31562 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31563 .endd
31564 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31565 .code
31566 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31567 a.domain.black.list.tld
31568 .endd
31569 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31570 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31571 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31572 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31573 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31574 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31575 error for a previous item.
31576
31577 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31578 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31579 .code
31580 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31581 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31582 .endd
31583 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31584 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31585 .code
31586 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31587 $sender_address_domain \
31588 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31589 see $dnslist_text.
31590 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31591 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31592 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31593 .endd
31594 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31595 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31596 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31597 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31598 .code
31599 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31600 .endd
31601 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31602 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31603
31604 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31605 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31606
31607
31608
31609
31610 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31611 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31612 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31613 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31614 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31615 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31616 .display
31617 127.1.0.1 RBL
31618 127.1.0.2 DUL
31619 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31620 127.1.0.4 RSS
31621 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31622 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31623 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31624 .endd
31625 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31626 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31627 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31628
31629
31630 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31631 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31632 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31633 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31634 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31635 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31636 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31637 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31638 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31639 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31640 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31641 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31642 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31643 cases, for example:
31644 .code
31645 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31646 .endd
31647 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31648 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31649 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31650 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31651 .code
31652 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31653 .endd
31654 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31655 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31656
31657 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31658 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31659 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31660 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31661 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31662 information.
31663
31664 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31665 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31666 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31667 .code
31668 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31669 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31670 at $dnslist_domain
31671 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31672 .endd
31673
31674
31675
31676 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31677 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31678 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31679 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31680 For example,
31681 .code
31682 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31683 .endd
31684 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31685 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31686 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31687 describes how multiple records are handled.
31688
31689 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31690 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31691 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31692 .code
31693 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31694 .endd
31695 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31696 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31697 first. For example:
31698 .code
31699 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31700 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31701 .endd
31702
31703 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31704 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31705 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31706 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31707 tested. For example:
31708 .code
31709 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31710 .endd
31711 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31712 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31713 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31714 .code
31715 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31716 .endd
31717 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31718 an odd number.
31719
31720
31721
31722 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31723 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31724 condition. Whereas
31725 .code
31726 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31727 .endd
31728 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31729 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31730 .code
31731 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31732 .endd
31733 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31734 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31735 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31736 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31737
31738 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31739 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31740
31741 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31742 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31743 .code
31744 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31745 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31746 .endd
31747 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31748 Consider this example:
31749 .code
31750 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31751 list.dsbl.org : \
31752 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31753 relays.ordb.org
31754 .endd
31755 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31756 .code
31757 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31758 list.dsbl.org
31759 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31760 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31761 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31762 .endd
31763 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31764
31765
31766
31767
31768 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31769 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31770 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31771 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31772 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31773 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31774 .code
31775 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31776 .endd
31777 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31778 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31779 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31780 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31781 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31782 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31783
31784 .ilist
31785 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31786 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31787 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31788 .next
31789 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31790 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31791 changed to:
31792 .code
31793 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31794 .endd
31795 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31796 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31797 .code
31798 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31799 .endd
31800 for the condition to be true.
31801 .endlist
31802
31803 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31804 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31805 .ilist
31806 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31807 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31808 .code
31809 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31810 .endd
31811 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31812 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31813 .next
31814 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31815 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31816 .code
31817 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31818 .endd
31819 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31820 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31821 .code
31822 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31823 .endd
31824 for the condition to be false.
31825 .endlist
31826 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31827 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31828
31829
31830
31831
31832 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31833 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31834 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31835 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31836 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31837 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31838 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31839 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31840 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31841 lists.
31842
31843 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31844 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31845 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31846 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31847 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31848 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31849 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31850 .code
31851 deny message = \
31852 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31853 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31854 dnslists = \
31855 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31856 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31857 .endd
31858 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31859 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31860 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31861 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31862 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31863 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31864
31865 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31866 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31867 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31868 .code
31869 deny dnslists = \
31870 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31871 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31872 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31873 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31874 .endd
31875 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31876 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31877 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31878
31879
31880
31881 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31882 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31883 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31884 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31885 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31886 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31887 .code
31888 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31889 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31890 .endd
31891 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31892 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31893 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31894 .code
31895 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31896 .endd
31897 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31898 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31899
31900 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31901 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31902 .code
31903 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31904 dnslists = some.list.example
31905 .endd
31906
31907 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31908 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31909 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31910 .code
31911 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31912 .endd
31913
31914 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31915 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31916 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31917 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31918 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31919 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31920 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31921 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31922 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31923 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31924 .display
31925 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31926 .endd
31927 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31928 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31929
31930 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31931 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31932 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31933 of &'p'&.
31934
31935 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31936 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31937 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31938 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31939 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31940 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31941 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31942 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31943 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31944
31945 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31946 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31947 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31948 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31949
31950 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31951 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31952 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31953 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31954 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31955 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31956 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31957 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31958 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31959 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31960
31961 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31962 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31963 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31964 ACL.
31965
31966 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31967 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31968 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31969 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31970 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31971 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31972
31973 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31974 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31975 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31976 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31977 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31978 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31979 the &%count=%& option.
31980
31981
31982 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31983 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31984 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31985 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31986 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31987
31988 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31989 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31990 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31991 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31992
31993 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31994 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31995 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31996 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31997 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31998 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31999 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32000
32001 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32002 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32003 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
32004 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32005 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32006 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32007 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32008
32009 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32010 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32011 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32012 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32013 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
32014
32015 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32016 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32017 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32018 multiple different commands.
32019
32020 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32021 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32022 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32023 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32024 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32025
32026 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32027
32028
32029 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32030 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32031 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32032 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32033 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32034
32035 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32036 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32037
32038 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32039 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32040 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32041 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32042 new rate.
32043 .code
32044 acl_check_connect:
32045 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32046 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32047 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32048 # ...
32049 acl_check_mail:
32050 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32051 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32052 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32053 .endd
32054
32055 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32056 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32057 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32058 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32059 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32060 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32061 checks.
32062
32063 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32064 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32065 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32066 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32067 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32068
32069
32070 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32071 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32072 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32073 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32074 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32075 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32076 rest of the ACL.
32077
32078 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32079 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32080 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32081 up to the given limit.
32082 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32083 consists of refusing the message, and
32084 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32085 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32086 likely not what is wanted.
32087
32088 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32089 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32090 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32091 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32092 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32093 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32094 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32095 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32096 .code
32097 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
32098 .endd
32099
32100
32101 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
32102 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
32103 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
32104 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
32105 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
32106 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
32107 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
32108 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
32109 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
32110
32111 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
32112 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
32113 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
32114 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
32115 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
32116 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
32117
32118 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
32119 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
32120 rate.
32121
32122 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
32123 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
32124 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32125 required increases with larger limits.
32126
32127 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32128 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32129 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32130 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32131 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32132 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32133 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32134 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32135 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32136 as intended.
32137
32138
32139 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32140 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32141 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32142 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32143 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32144 message. For example:
32145 .code
32146 # Log all senders' rates
32147 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32148 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32149
32150 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32151 # at the decimal point.
32152 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32153 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32154 $sender_rate_limit }s
32155
32156 # Keep authenticated users under control
32157 deny authenticated = *
32158 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32159
32160 # System-wide rate limit
32161 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32162 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32163
32164 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32165 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32166 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32167 messages per $sender_rate_period
32168 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32169 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32170 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32171 .endd
32172 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32173 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32174 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32175 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32176 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32177 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32178 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32179
32180
32181
32182 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32183 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32184 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32185 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32186 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32187 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32188 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32189 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32190 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32191 .code
32192 verify = sender/callout
32193 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32194 .endd
32195 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32196 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32197 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32198 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32199 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32200 The available options are as follows:
32201
32202 .ilist
32203 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32204 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32205 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32206 .next
32207 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32208 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32209 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32210 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32211 .next
32212 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32213 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32214 .next
32215 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32216 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32217 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32218 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32219 .endlist
32220
32221 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32222 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32223 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32224 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32225 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32226 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32227 coding like this:
32228 .code
32229 warn !verify = sender
32230 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32231 .endd
32232 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32233 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32234 verification failure.
32235
32236 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32237 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32238
32239 .ilist
32240 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32241 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32242 .next
32243 &%route%&: Routing failed.
32244 .next
32245 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32246 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32247 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32248 .next
32249 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32250 .next
32251 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32252 .endlist
32253
32254 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32255 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32256
32257 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32258 address verification to:
32259
32260 .ilist
32261 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32262 .endlist
32263
32264
32265
32266
32267 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32268 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32269 .cindex "callout" "verification"
32270 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32271 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32272 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32273 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32274 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32275 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32276 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32277 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32278 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32279 sender's domain.
32280
32281 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32282 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32283 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32284 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32285 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32286 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32287
32288 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32289 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32290 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32291 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32292 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32293
32294 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32295 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32296 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32297 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32298 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32299 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32300 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32301 supplies a host list.
32302 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32303
32304 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32305 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32306 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32307 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32308 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32309 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32310 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32311
32312 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32313 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32314 following SMTP commands are sent:
32315 .display
32316 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32317 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32318 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32319 &`QUIT`&
32320 .endd
32321 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32322 set to &"lmtp"&.
32323
32324 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32325 settings.
32326
32327 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32328 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32329 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32330 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32331 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32332 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32333
32334 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32335 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32336 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32337 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32338 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32339
32340 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32341 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32342 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32343 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32344 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32345
32346
32347
32348
32349 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32350 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32351 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32352 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32353 .code
32354 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32355 .endd
32356 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32357 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32358 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32359
32360
32361 .vlist
32362 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32363 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32364 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32365 For example:
32366 .code
32367 verify = sender/callout=5s
32368 .endd
32369 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32370 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32371 the &%connect%& parameter.
32372
32373
32374 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32375 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32376 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32377 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32378 .code
32379 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32380 .endd
32381 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32382
32383 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32384 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32385 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32386 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32387 updated in this circumstance.
32388
32389 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32390 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32391 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32392 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32393 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32394 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32395
32396
32397 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32398 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32399 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32400 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32401 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32402 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32403 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32404 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32405 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32406 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32407 .code
32408 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32409 .endd
32410 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32411
32412
32413 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32414 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32415 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32416 For example:
32417 .code
32418 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32419 .endd
32420 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32421 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32422 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32423 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32424 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32425
32426
32427 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32428 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32429 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32430 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32431
32432 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32433 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32434 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32435 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32436 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32437 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32438 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32439 made, until the cache record expires.
32440
32441 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32442 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32443 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32444 For example:
32445 .code
32446 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32447 .endd
32448 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32449 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32450 .code
32451 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32452 .endd
32453 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32454 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32455 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32456 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32457
32458
32459 .vitem &*random*&
32460 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32461 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32462 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32463 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32464 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32465 .code
32466 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32467 .endd
32468 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32469 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32470 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32471 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32472 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32473
32474 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32475 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32476 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32477 .code
32478 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32479 .endd
32480 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32481 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32482 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32483 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32484 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32485
32486 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32487 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32488 .code
32489 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32490 .endd
32491 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32492 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32493 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32494 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32495 usefulness of callout caching.
32496
32497 .vitem &*hold*&
32498 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32499 .code
32500 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32501 .endd
32502 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32503 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32504 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32505 when that is used for the connections.
32506 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32507 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32508 if the use_sender option is used,
32509 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32510 and if no other callouts intervene.
32511 .endlist
32512
32513 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32514 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32515 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32516 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32517 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32518 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32519 these circumstances.
32520
32521 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32522 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32523 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32524 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32525 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32526 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32527 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32528
32529 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32530 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32531 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32532 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32533
32534
32535
32536
32537 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32538 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32539 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32540 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32541 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32542 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32543 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32544 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32545 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32546 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32547
32548 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32549 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32550 is not available.
32551
32552 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32553 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32554 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32555
32556 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32557 commands up to and including
32558 .code
32559 MAIL FROM:<>
32560 .endd
32561 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32562 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32563 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32564 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32565 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32566 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32567 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32568
32569 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32570 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32571 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32572 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32573 will eventually be noticed.
32574
32575 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32576 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32577 behaviour will be the same.
32578
32579
32580
32581 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32582 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32583 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32584 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32585 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32586 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32587 you might see:
32588 .code
32589 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32590 250 OK
32591 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32592 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32593 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32594 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32595 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32596 550 Sender verification failed
32597 .endd
32598 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32599 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32600 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32601 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32602 example:
32603 .code
32604 verify = sender/no_details
32605 .endd
32606
32607 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32608 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32609 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32610 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32611 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32612 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32613 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32614
32615 .ilist
32616 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32617 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32618 verification also fails.
32619 .next
32620 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32621 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32622 .endlist
32623
32624 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32625 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32626 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32627 .code
32628 A.Wol: aw123
32629 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32630 .endd
32631 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32632 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32633 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32634 verification to succeed.
32635
32636 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32637 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32638 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32639 option. For example:
32640 .code
32641 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32642 .endd
32643 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32644 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32645
32646 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32647 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32648 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32649 address and a report is output for each of them.
32650
32651
32652
32653 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32654 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32655 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32656 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32657 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32658 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32659 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32660 .code
32661 verify = csa
32662 .endd
32663 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32664 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32665 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32666 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32667 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32668 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32669
32670 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32671 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32672 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32673 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32674
32675 .ilist
32676 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32677 .next
32678 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32679 .next
32680 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32681 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32682 .next
32683 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32684 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32685 .endlist
32686
32687 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32688 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32689 .code
32690 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32691 .endd
32692 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32693 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32694 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32695 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32696 meaningful to say:
32697 .code
32698 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32699 .endd
32700 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32701 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32702 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32703
32704 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32705 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32706 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32707 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32708 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32709 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32710 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32711 of legitimate HELO domains.
32712
32713 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32714 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32715 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32716 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32717 lookup such as:
32718 .code
32719 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32720 .endd
32721 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32722 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32723 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32724
32725
32726
32727
32728 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32729 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32730 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32731 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32732 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32733 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32734 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32735 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32736
32737 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32738 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32739 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32740 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32741 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32742 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32743 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32744 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32745
32746 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32747 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32748 like this:
32749 .code
32750 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32751 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32752 }{$value}}
32753 .endd
32754 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32755 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32756 use this:
32757 .code
32758 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32759 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32760 senders = :
32761 recipients = +batv_senders
32762
32763 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32764 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32765 senders = :
32766 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32767 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32768 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32769 .endd
32770 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32771 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32772 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32773 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32774 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32775
32776 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32777 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32778 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32779 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32780 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32781 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32782 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32783
32784 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32785 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32786 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32787 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32788 .code
32789 batv_redirect:
32790 driver = redirect
32791 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32792 .endd
32793 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32794 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32795 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32796 local addresses.
32797
32798 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32799 can be used:
32800 .code
32801 external_smtp_batv:
32802 driver = smtp
32803 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32804 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32805 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32806 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32807 {$value}fail}}}
32808 .endd
32809 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32810
32811
32812
32813 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32814 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32815 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32816 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32817 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32818 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32819 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32820 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32821 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32822 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32823
32824 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32825 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32826 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32827 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32828 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32829 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32830 . ///
32831 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32832 . ///
32833 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32834 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32835 system to arbitrary domains.
32836
32837
32838 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32839 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32840 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32841 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32842
32843 .ilist
32844 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32845 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32846 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32847 .next
32848 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32849 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32850 .next
32851 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32852 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32853 .endlist
32854
32855
32856 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32857 .code
32858 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32859 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32860 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32861 .endd
32862 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32863 command:
32864 .code
32865 acl_check_rcpt:
32866 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32867 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32868 .endd
32869 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32870 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32871 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32872 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32873 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32874 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32875 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32876
32877
32878
32879 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32880 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32881 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32882 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32883 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32884 .ecindex IIDacl
32885
32886
32887
32888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32890
32891 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32892 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32893 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32894 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32895 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32896 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32897 specification.
32898
32899 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32900 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32901 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32902 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32903 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32904
32905 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32906 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32907 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32908
32909 .ilist
32910 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32911 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32912 .next
32913 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32914 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32915 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32916 .next
32917 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32918 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32919 .next
32920 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32921 conditions.
32922 .next
32923 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32924 .endlist
32925
32926 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32927 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32928 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32929 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32930 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32931 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32932
32933 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32934 temporarily created in a file called:
32935 .display
32936 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32937 .endd
32938 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32939 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32940 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32941 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32942 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32943 .code
32944 control = no_mbox_unspool
32945 .endd
32946 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32947 same directory by default.
32948
32949
32950
32951 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32952 .cindex "virus scanning"
32953 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32954 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32955 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32956 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32957 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32958 in memory and thus are much faster.
32959
32960 Since message data needs to have arrived,
32961 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32962 &%acl_smtp_data%&,
32963 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32964 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32965 &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
32966
32967 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32968 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32969
32970 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32971 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32972 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32973 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32974 .display
32975 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32976 .endd
32977 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32978 .code
32979 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32980 .endd
32981 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32982 before use.
32983 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32984 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32985 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32986
32987 .vlist
32988 .vitem &%avast%&
32989 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32990 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32991 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32992 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32993 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32994 This scanner type takes one option,
32995 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32996 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32997 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32998 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32999 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33000 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33001 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33002
33003 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33004 If &`pass_unscanned`&
33005 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33006 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33007 care.
33008
33009 For example:
33010 .code
33011 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33012 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33013 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33014 .endd
33015 If you omit the argument, the default path
33016 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33017 is used.
33018 If you use a remote host,
33019 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33020 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33021 For information about available commands and their options you may use
33022 .code
33023 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33024 FLAGS
33025 SENSITIVITY
33026 PACK
33027 .endd
33028
33029 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33030 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33031 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33032
33033 .vitem &%aveserver%&
33034 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33035 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33036 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33037 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33038 example:
33039 .code
33040 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33041 .endd
33042
33043
33044 .vitem &%clamd%&
33045 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33046 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33047 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33048 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33049 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33050
33051 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33052 a UNIX socket specification,
33053 a TCP socket specification,
33054 or a (global) option.
33055
33056 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
33057 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
33058 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
33059 and the second a port number,
33060 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
33061 These per-server options are supported:
33062 .code
33063 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33064 .endd
33065
33066 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33067 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
33068
33069 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
33070
33071 Examples:
33072 .code
33073 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
33074 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
33075 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
33076 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
33077 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
33078 .endd
33079 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
33080 &`local`&
33081 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
33082 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
33083 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
33084 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
33085
33086 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
33087 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
33088 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
33089 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
33090 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
33091 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
33092 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
33093 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
33094 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
33095 .code
33096 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
33097 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
33098 (Connection refused)
33099 .endd
33100
33101 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
33102 contributing the code for this scanner.
33103
33104 .vitem &%cmdline%&
33105 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
33106 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
33107 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
33108 type takes 3 mandatory options:
33109
33110 .olist
33111 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
33112 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
33113
33114 .next
33115 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
33116 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
33117 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
33118 the &"trigger"& expression.
33119
33120 .next
33121 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
33122 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
33123 &"name"& expression.
33124 .endlist olist
33125
33126 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33127 .code
33128 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33129 .endd
33130 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33131 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33132 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33133 configuration setting:
33134 .code
33135 av_scanner = cmdline:\
33136 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33137 found in file:'(.+)'
33138 .endd
33139 .vitem &%drweb%&
33140 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33141 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33142 takes one option,
33143 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33144 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33145 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33146 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33147 For example:
33148 .code
33149 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33150 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33151 .endd
33152 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33153 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33154
33155 .vitem &%f-protd%&
33156 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33157 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33158 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33159 (or port-range).
33160 For example:
33161 .code
33162 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33163 .endd
33164 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33165
33166 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33167 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33168 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33169 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33170 For example:
33171 .code
33172 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33173 .endd
33174 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33175
33176 .vitem &%fsecure%&
33177 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33178 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33179 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33180 .code
33181 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33182 .endd
33183 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33184 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33185
33186 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33187 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33188 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33189 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33190 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33191 For example:
33192 .code
33193 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33194 .endd
33195 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33196
33197 .vitem &%mksd%&
33198 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33199 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33200 though some documentation was available in English.
33201 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33202 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33203 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33204 to integrate.
33205 The only option for this scanner type is
33206 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33207 provided that mksd has
33208 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33209 .code
33210 av_scanner = mksd:2
33211 .endd
33212 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33213
33214 .vitem &%sock%&
33215 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33216 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33217 running on the local machine.
33218 There are four options:
33219 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33220 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33221 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33222 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33223 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33224 For example:
33225 .code
33226 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33227 .endd
33228 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33229 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33230 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33231 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33232 specify an empty element to get this.
33233
33234 .vitem &%sophie%&
33235 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33236 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33237 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33238 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33239 client communication. For example:
33240 .code
33241 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33242 .endd
33243 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33244 the option.
33245 .endlist
33246
33247 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33248 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33249 ACL.
33250
33251 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33252 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33253 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33254 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33255 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33256 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33257 message.
33258
33259 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33260 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33261 The first element can then be one of
33262
33263 .ilist
33264 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33265 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33266 recommended usage.
33267 .next
33268 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33269 the condition fails immediately.
33270 .next
33271 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33272 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33273 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33274 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33275 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33276 .endlist
33277
33278 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33279 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33280 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33281
33282 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33283 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33284 For example:
33285 .code
33286 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33287 .endd
33288 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33289
33290 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33291 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33292 is set to record the actual address used.
33293
33294 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33295 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33296 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33297 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33298 logging data.
33299
33300 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33301 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33302
33303 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33304 .code
33305 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33306 malware = *
33307 .endd
33308 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33309 .code
33310 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33311 malware = */defer_ok
33312 .endd
33313 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33314 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33315 .code
33316 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33317 .endd
33318 in the main Exim configuration.
33319 .code
33320 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33321 set acl_m0 = sophie
33322 malware = *
33323
33324 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33325 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33326 malware = *
33327 .endd
33328
33329
33330 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33331 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33332 .cindex "spam scanning"
33333 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33334 .cindex "Rspamd"
33335 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33336 score and a report for the message.
33337 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33338
33339 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33340 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33341 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33342
33343 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33344 .code
33345 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33346 .endd
33347 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33348 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33349 nicely, however.
33350
33351 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33352 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33353 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33354 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33355 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33356 configuration as follows (example):
33357 .code
33358 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33359 .endd
33360 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33361 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33362 iptables firewall, consider setting
33363 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33364 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33365 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33366 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33367 soon.
33368
33369
33370 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33371 on TCP port 11333)
33372 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33373 .code
33374 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33375 .endd
33376
33377 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33378 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33379 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33380 .code
33381 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33382 .endd
33383 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33384 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33385 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33386 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33387 .code
33388 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33389 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33390 192.168.2.12 783
33391 .endd
33392 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33393 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33394 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33395 condition defers.
33396
33397 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33398 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33399 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33400 take care to not double the separator.
33401
33402 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33403 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33404 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33405 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33406
33407 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33408 are options.
33409 The supported options are:
33410 .code
33411 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33412 weight=<value> Selection bias
33413 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33414 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33415 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33416 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33417 .endd
33418
33419 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33420 higher values being tried first.
33421 The default priority is 1.
33422
33423 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33424 Within a priority set
33425 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33426 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33427
33428 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33429 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33430 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33431 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33432
33433 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33434 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33435
33436 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33437 The default value is two minutes.
33438
33439 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33440 a failed connect is made.
33441 The default is to not retry.
33442
33443 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33444 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33445 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33446 expansion.
33447
33448 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33449 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33450 is set to record the actual address used.
33451
33452 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33453 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33454 .code
33455 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33456 spam = joe
33457 .endd
33458 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33459 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33460 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33461 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33462 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33463 right-hand side.
33464
33465 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33466 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33467 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33468 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33469 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33470 are not set.
33471 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33472 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33473 after the first),
33474 or the use of PRDR,
33475 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33476 are needed to use this feature.
33477
33478 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33479 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33480 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33481
33482
33483 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33484 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33485 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33486 example:
33487 .code
33488 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33489 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33490 spam = nobody
33491 .endd
33492
33493 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33494 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33495 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33496 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33497
33498 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33499 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33500 variables.
33501 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33502 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33503 available for use at delivery time.
33504
33505 .vlist
33506 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33507 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33508 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33509
33510 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33511 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33512 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33513 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33514 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33515
33516 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33517 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33518 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33519 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33520 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33521 spam bar is 50 characters.
33522
33523 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33524 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33525 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33526 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33527 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33528 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33529 unencoded in headers.
33530
33531 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33532 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33533 spam score versus threshold.
33534 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33535
33536 .endlist
33537
33538 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33539 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33540 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33541
33542 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33543 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33544 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33545 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33546 spam condition, like this:
33547 .code
33548 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33549 spam = joe/defer_ok
33550 .endd
33551 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33552
33553 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33554 condition:
33555 .code
33556 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33557 warn spam = nobody:true
33558 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33559 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33560
33561 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33562 # is over threshold
33563 warn spam = nobody
33564 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33565
33566 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33567 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33568 spam = nobody:true
33569 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33570 .endd
33571
33572
33573
33574 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33575 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33576 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33577 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33578 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33579 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33580 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33581 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33582 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33583 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33584 cases.
33585
33586 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33587 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33588 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33589 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33590 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33591 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33592 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33593
33594 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33595 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33596 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33597 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33598 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33599
33600 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33601 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33602 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33603 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33604 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33605 syntax is:
33606 .display
33607 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33608 .endd
33609 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33610 the value can be:
33611
33612 .olist
33613 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33614 .next
33615 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33616 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33617 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33618 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33619 .next
33620 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33621 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33622 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33623 the full path and filename.
33624 .next
33625 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33626 filename, and the default path is then used.
33627 .endlist
33628 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33629 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33630 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33631 .code
33632 decode = $mime_filename
33633 .endd
33634 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33635 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33636 automatically unlinked.
33637
33638 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33639 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33640 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33641 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33642 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33643
33644 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33645 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33646 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33647
33648 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33649 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33650 available in the MIME ACL:
33651
33652 .vlist
33653 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33654 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33655 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33656 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33657 contains the empty string.
33658
33659 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33660 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33661 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33662 .code
33663 us-ascii
33664 gb2312 (Chinese)
33665 iso-8859-1
33666 .endd
33667 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33668 case-insensitively.
33669
33670 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33671 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33672 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33673 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33674 only used for display purposes.
33675
33676 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33677 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33678 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33679
33680 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33681 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33682 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33683
33684 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33685 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33686 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33687 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33688 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33689
33690 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33691 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33692 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33693 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33694
33695 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33696 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33697 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33698 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33699 .code
33700 text/plain
33701 text/html
33702 application/octet-stream
33703 image/jpeg
33704 audio/midi
33705 .endd
33706 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33707 empty string.
33708
33709 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33710 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33711 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33712 containing the decoded data.
33713 .endlist
33714
33715 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33716 .vlist
33717 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33718 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33719 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33720 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33721 RFC2047
33722 or RFC2231
33723 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33724 If no filename was
33725 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33726
33727 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33728 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33729 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33730 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33731
33732 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33733 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33734 follows:
33735
33736 .olist
33737 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33738
33739 .next
33740 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33741 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33742
33743 .next
33744 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33745 and the rest are attachments.
33746
33747 .next
33748 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33749 .endlist olist
33750
33751 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33752 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33753 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33754 .code
33755 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33756 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33757 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33758 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33759 .endd
33760 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33761 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33762 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33763 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33764 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33765
33766 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33767 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33768 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33769 decoding is fully recursive.
33770
33771 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33772 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33773 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33774 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33775 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33776 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33777 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33778 .endlist
33779
33780
33781
33782 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33783 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33784 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33785 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33786 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33787
33788 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33789 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33790 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33791 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33792 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33793
33794 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33795 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33796 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33797 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33798 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33799 32K characters are checked.
33800
33801 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33802 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33803 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33804 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33805 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33806 .code
33807 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33808 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33809 .endd
33810 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33811 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33812 matching regular expression.
33813 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33814 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33815
33816 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33817 CPU-intensive.
33818
33819 .ecindex IIDcosca
33820
33821
33822
33823
33824 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33825 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33826
33827 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33828 "Local scan function"
33829 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33830 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33831 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33832 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33833 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33834
33835 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33836 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33837 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33838 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33839 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33840
33841 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33842 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33843 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33844 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33845
33846 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33847 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33848 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33849 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33850
33851 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33852 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33853 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33854 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33855 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33856 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33857 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33858 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33859 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33860
33861
33862
33863 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33864 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33865 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33866 function is before building Exim, by setting
33867 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33868 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33869 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33870 directory, so you might set
33871 .code
33872 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33873 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33874 .endd
33875 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
33876 .new
33877 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
33878 and then #include "local_scan.h".
33879 .wen
33880 It is called by
33881 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33882 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33883 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33884 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33885 _src/local_scan.c_.
33886
33887 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33888 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33889 .code
33890 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33891 .endd
33892 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33893
33894
33895
33896
33897 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33898 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33899 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33900 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33901 .code
33902 #include "local_scan.h"
33903 .endd
33904 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33905 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33906 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33907 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33908 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33909 strings and pointers to character strings:
33910 .code
33911 #define CS (char *)
33912 #define CCS (const char *)
33913 #define CSS (char **)
33914 #define US (unsigned char *)
33915 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33916 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33917 .endd
33918 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33919 .code
33920 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33921 .endd
33922 The arguments are as follows:
33923
33924 .ilist
33925 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33926 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33927 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33928
33929 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33930 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33931 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33932 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33933 case this changes in some future version.
33934 .next
33935 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33936 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33937 .endlist
33938
33939 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33940
33941 .vlist
33942 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33943 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33944 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33945 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33946 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33947 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33948
33949 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33950 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33951 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33952
33953 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33954 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33955 queued without immediate delivery.
33956
33957 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33958 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33959 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33960 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33961 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33962 used.
33963
33964 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33965 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33966 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33967 problem"& is used.
33968
33969 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33970 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33971 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33972 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33973 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33974 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33975 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33976
33977 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33978 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33979 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33980 .endlist
33981
33982 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33983 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33984 &%-oe%& command line options.
33985
33986
33987
33988 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33989 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33990 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33991 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33992 want to do this, you must have the line
33993 .code
33994 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33995 .endd
33996 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33997 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33998 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33999 to define them.
34000
34001 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34002 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34003 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34004 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34005 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34006 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34007 .code
34008 static int my_integer_option = 42;
34009 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34010
34011 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34012 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34013 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34014 };
34015
34016 int local_scan_options_count =
34017 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34018 .endd
34019 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34020 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34021 .code
34022 begin local_scan
34023 my_integer = 99
34024 my_string = some string of text...
34025 .endd
34026 The available types of option data are as follows:
34027
34028 .vlist
34029 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
34030 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34031 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34032 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
34033 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
34034 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
34035 values.)
34036
34037 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
34038 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
34039 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
34040 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
34041
34042 .vitem &*opt_int*&
34043 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
34044 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
34045 Exim.
34046
34047 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
34048 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
34049 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
34050 printed with the suffix K or M.
34051
34052 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
34053 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
34054 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
34055 always output in octal.
34056
34057 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
34058 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
34059 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
34060
34061 .vitem &*opt_time*&
34062 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
34063 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
34064 .endlist
34065
34066 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
34067 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
34068
34069
34070
34071 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
34072 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
34073 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
34074 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
34075 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
34076 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
34077 C variables are as follows:
34078
34079 .vlist
34080 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
34081 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
34082 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34083
34084 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
34085 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
34086 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34087
34088 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
34089 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
34090 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
34091 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
34092
34093 .ilist
34094 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
34095 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
34096 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
34097
34098 .next
34099 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
34100 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
34101 of debugging bits.
34102 .endlist ilist
34103
34104 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
34105 selected, you should use code like this:
34106 .code
34107 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34108 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34109 .endd
34110 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
34111 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
34112 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
34113
34114 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
34115 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
34116 discussed below.
34117
34118 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
34119 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
34120
34121 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
34122 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
34123
34124 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34125 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34126 &%-bh%& command line option.
34127
34128 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34129 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34130 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34131
34132 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34133 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34134 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34135 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34136
34137 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34138 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34139 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34140
34141 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34142 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34143
34144 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34145 The number of accepted recipients.
34146
34147 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34148 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34149 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34150 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34151 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34152 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34153 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34154 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34155 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34156 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34157 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34158 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34159
34160 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34161 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34162
34163 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34164 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34165 locally-submitted messages.
34166
34167 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34168 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34169 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34170
34171 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34172 The name of the sending host, if known.
34173
34174 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34175 The port on the sending host.
34176
34177 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34178 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34179
34180 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34181 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34182
34183 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34184 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34185 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34186 .endlist
34187
34188
34189 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34190 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34191 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34192 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34193 their type to *.
34194
34195
34196 .vlist
34197 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34198 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34199
34200 .vitem &*int&~type*&
34201 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34202 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34203 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34204 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34205 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34206 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34207
34208 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
34209 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34210 internal newlines.
34211
34212 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34213 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34214 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34215 .endlist
34216
34217
34218
34219 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34220 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34221
34222 .vlist
34223 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34224 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34225
34226 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
34227 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34228 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34229 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34230
34231 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34232 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34233 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34234 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34235 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34236 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34237 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34238 is NULL for all recipients.
34239 .endlist
34240
34241
34242
34243 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34244 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34245 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34246 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34247 release:
34248
34249 .vlist
34250 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34251 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34252
34253 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34254 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34255 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34256 for the process in &%newumask%&.
34257
34258 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34259 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34260 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34261 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34262 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34263
34264 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34265
34266 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34267 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34268 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34269 return value is as follows:
34270
34271 .ilist
34272 >= 0
34273
34274 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34275 ending status.
34276
34277 .next
34278 < 0 and > &--256
34279
34280 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34281 signal number.
34282
34283 .next
34284 &--256
34285
34286 The process timed out.
34287 .next
34288 &--257
34289
34290 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34291 .endlist
34292
34293 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34294 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34295 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34296 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34297 forks a subprocess that is running
34298 .code
34299 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34300 .endd
34301 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34302 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34303 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34304 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34305
34306 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34307 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34308 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34309 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34310
34311
34312 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34313 *sender_authentication)*&
34314 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34315 that it runs is:
34316 .display
34317 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34318 .endd
34319 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34320
34321
34322 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34323 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34324 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34325 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34326 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34327 .code
34328 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34329 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34330 .endd
34331
34332 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34333 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34334 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34335 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34336 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34337 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34338 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34339 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34340
34341 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34342 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34343 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34344 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34345 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34346 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34347
34348 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34349 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34350 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34351 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34352
34353 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34354 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34355 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34356 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34357 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34358 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34359 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34360 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34361 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34362 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34363 .code
34364 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34365 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34366 .endd
34367 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34368 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34369
34370
34371 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34372 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34373 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34374 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34375 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34376
34377
34378 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34379 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34380 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34381 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34382 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34383 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34384 .code
34385 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34386 .endd
34387 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34388 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34389 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34390 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34391 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34392 zero-terminated.
34393
34394 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34395 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34396 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34397 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34398 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34399 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34400 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34401 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34402
34403 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34404 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34405 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34406 .display
34407 &`OK `& match succeeded
34408 &`FAIL `& match failed
34409 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34410 .endd
34411 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34412 inability to contact a database.
34413
34414 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34415 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34416 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34417 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34418 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34419
34420 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34421 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34422 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34423 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34424 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34425
34426 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34427 uschar&~*list)*&"
34428 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34429 expected to be
34430 .code
34431 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34432 .endd
34433 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34434 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34435 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34436 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34437 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34438 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34439 failed.
34440
34441 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34442 *format,&~...)*&"
34443 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34444 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34445 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34446 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34447 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34448 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34449
34450
34451 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34452 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34453 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34454 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34455
34456 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34457 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34458 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34459 value afterwards. For example:
34460 .code
34461 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34462 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34463 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34464 .endd
34465
34466 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34467 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34468 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34469 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34470 address.
34471 .endlist
34472
34473
34474 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34475 .vlist
34476 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34477 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34478 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34479 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34480 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34481 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34482 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34483 binary string is returned with an error message.
34484
34485 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34486 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34487 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34488
34489 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34490 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34491 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34492 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34493 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34494
34495 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34496 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34497 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34498
34499 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34500 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34501 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34502 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34503 with translation.
34504
34505
34506 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34507 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34508 below.
34509
34510 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34511 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34512 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34513 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34514 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34515 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34516 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34517 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34518 is involved.
34519
34520 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34521 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34522
34523 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34524 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34525 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34526 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34527
34528 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34529 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34530 ABI version number was incremented.
34531
34532 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34533 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34534 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34535 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34536 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34537 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34538 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34539 .code
34540 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34541 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34542 .endd
34543 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34544 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34545 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34546 multiple output lines.
34547
34548 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34549 does not
34550 guarantee a flush of
34551 pending output, and therefore does not test
34552 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34553 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34554 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34555 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34556 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34557 is an error.
34558
34559 .new
34560 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34561 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34562 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34563 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34564 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34565 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34566 Exim bombs out if it ever
34567 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34568 .wen
34569
34570 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34571 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34572 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34573
34574 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34575 See below.
34576
34577 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34578 See below.
34579
34580 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34581 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34582 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34583 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34584 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34585 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34586 more discussion.
34587 .endlist
34588
34589
34590
34591 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34592 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34593 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34594 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34595 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34596 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34597 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34598 terminates.
34599
34600 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34601 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34602 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34603 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34604
34605 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34606 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34607 .code
34608 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34609 .endd
34610 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34611 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34612 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34613 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34614
34615 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34616 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34617 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34618 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34619 &%store_pool%&.
34620 .ecindex IIDlosca
34621
34622
34623
34624
34625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34627
34628 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34629 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34630 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34631 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34632 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34633 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34634 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34635 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34636
34637 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34638 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34639 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34640 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34641 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34642
34643 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34644 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34645 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34646 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34647 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34648 prevent it happening on retries.
34649
34650 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34651 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34652 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34653 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34654 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34655 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34656 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34657 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34658
34659
34660 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34661 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34662 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34663 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34664 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34665 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34666 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34667 .code
34668 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34669 system_filter_user = exim
34670 .endd
34671 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34672 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34673 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34674 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34675 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34676 by the &%reply%& command.
34677
34678
34679 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34680 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34681 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34682 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34683
34684 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34685 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34686
34687
34688
34689 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34690 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34691 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34692 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34693 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34694 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34695 they cause errors.
34696
34697 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34698 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34699 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34700 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34701 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34702 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34703 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34704
34705 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34706 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34707 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34708 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34709 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34710
34711 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34712 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34713 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34714 to which users' filter files can refer.
34715
34716
34717
34718 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34719 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34720 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34721 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34722 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34723
34724
34725
34726 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34727 .cindex "freezing messages"
34728 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34729 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34730 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34731 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34732 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34733 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34734 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34735 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34736 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34737 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34738 .code
34739 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34740 .endd
34741 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34742
34743 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34744 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34745 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34746 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34747 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34748 run.
34749
34750 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34751 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34752 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34753 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34754
34755 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34756 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34757 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34758 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34759 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34760 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34761 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34762 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34763 message. For example:
34764 .code
34765 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34766 because it contains attachments that we are \
34767 not prepared to receive."
34768 .endd
34769
34770 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34771 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34772 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34773 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34774 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34775 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34776 use, for example
34777 .code
34778 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34779 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34780 .endd
34781 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34782 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34783 generated by the filter.
34784
34785 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34786 &%defer%&,
34787 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34788 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34789 as
34790 .code
34791 mail ...
34792 freeze
34793 .endd
34794 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34795 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34796 take place.
34797
34798
34799
34800 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34801 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34802 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34803 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34804 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34805 .code
34806 headers add <string>
34807 headers remove <string>
34808 .endd
34809 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34810 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34811 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34812 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34813 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34814
34815 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34816 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34817 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34818 example:
34819 .code
34820 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34821 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34822 X-header-2: ...."
34823 .endd
34824 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34825 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34826 space after input continuations is ignored.
34827
34828 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34829 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34830 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34831 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34832 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34833
34834 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34835 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34836 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34837 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34838 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34839 used for all recipients of the message.
34840
34841 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34842 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34843 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34844 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34845 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34846 until the message is actually being written (see section
34847 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34848
34849 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34850 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34851 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34852 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34853 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34854 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34855 modified more than once.
34856
34857 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34858 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34859 For example:
34860 .code
34861 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34862 headers remove "Subject"
34863 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34864 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34865 .endd
34866
34867
34868
34869 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34870 .cindex "envelope from"
34871 .cindex "envelope sender"
34872 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34873 .code
34874 errors_to <some address>
34875 .endd
34876 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34877 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34878 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34879 might use
34880 .code
34881 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34882 .endd
34883 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34884 address if its delivery failed.
34885
34886
34887
34888 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34889 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34890 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34891 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34892 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34893 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34894 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34895 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34896 which implements such a filter:
34897 .code
34898 central_filter:
34899 check_local_user
34900 driver = redirect
34901 domains = +local_domains
34902 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34903 no_verify
34904 allow_filter
34905 allow_freeze
34906 .endd
34907 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34908 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34909 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34910 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34911
34912 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34913 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34914 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34915 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34916 normal way.
34917 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34918 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34919 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34920
34921
34922
34923
34924
34925
34926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34927 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34928
34929 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34930 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34931 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34932 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34933 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34934 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34935 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34936 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34937
34938 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34939 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34940 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34941 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34942 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34943
34944 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34945 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34946 loopback interface specially in any way.
34947
34948 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34949 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34950
34951
34952
34953
34954 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34955 .cindex "message" "submission"
34956 .cindex "submission mode"
34957 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34958 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34959 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34960 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34961 .code
34962 control = submission
34963 .endd
34964 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34965 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34966 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34967 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34968 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34969 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34970 .code
34971 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34972 control = submission
34973 .endd
34974 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34975 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34976 is used to separate options. For example:
34977 .code
34978 control = submission/sender_retain
34979 .endd
34980 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34981 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34982 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34983 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34984 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34985 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34986 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34987
34988 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34989 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34990 example:
34991 .code
34992 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34993 .endd
34994 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34995 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34996 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34997 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34998 .code
34999 accept authenticated = *
35000 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35001 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35002 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35003 .endd
35004 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35005 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35006 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35007 .code
35008 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35009 .endd
35010 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35011 line would be:
35012 .code
35013 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35014 .endd
35015 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35016 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35017 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35018 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35019
35020 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35021 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35022 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35023 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35024 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35025 spoof another's address.
35026
35027 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35028 .cindex "line endings"
35029 .cindex "carriage return"
35030 .cindex "linefeed"
35031 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35032 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35033 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35034 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
35035 use CRLF or just CR.
35036
35037 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
35038 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
35039 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
35040 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
35041 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
35042 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
35043 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
35044 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
35045 follows:
35046
35047 .ilist
35048 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
35049 .next
35050 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
35051 is ignored.
35052 .next
35053 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
35054 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
35055 terminator.
35056 .next
35057 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
35058 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
35059 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
35060 people trying to play silly games.
35061 .next
35062 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
35063 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
35064 line.
35065 .endlist
35066
35067
35068
35069
35070
35071 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
35072 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
35073 .cindex "address" "qualification"
35074 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
35075 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
35076 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
35077 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
35078 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
35079
35080 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
35081 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
35082 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
35083 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
35084 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
35085
35086 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
35087 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
35088 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
35089 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
35090 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
35091 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
35092 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
35093 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
35094
35095
35096
35097
35098 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
35099 .cindex "&""From""& line"
35100 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
35101 .cindex "sender" "address"
35102 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
35103 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
35104 .cindex "envelope from"
35105 .cindex "envelope sender"
35106 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35107 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
35108 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
35109 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
35110 .code
35111 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
35112 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
35113 .endd
35114 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
35115 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
35116 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
35117 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
35118 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
35119 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
35120 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
35121 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
35122 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
35123
35124 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35125 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35126 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35127 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35128 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35129 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35130 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35131
35132 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35133 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35134 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35135
35136 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35137 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35138 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35139 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35140
35141
35142
35143 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35144 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35145 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35146 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35147 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35148 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35149 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35150 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35151
35152 .blockquote
35153 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35154 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35155 .endblockquote
35156
35157 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35158 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35159 follows:
35160
35161 .ilist
35162 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35163 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35164 .next
35165 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35166 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35167 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35168 .next
35169 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35170 also removed.
35171 .next
35172 For a locally-submitted message,
35173 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35174 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35175 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35176 included in log lines in this case.
35177 .next
35178 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35179 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35180 .endlist
35181
35182
35183
35184
35185 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35186 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35187 includes the header line:
35188 .code
35189 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35190 .endd
35191
35192 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35193 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35194 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35195 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35196 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35197 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35198
35199
35200 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35201 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35202 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35203 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35204 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35205 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35206
35207 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35208 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35209 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35210 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35211 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35212 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35213 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35214 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35215 messages.
35216
35217
35218 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35219 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35220 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35221 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35222 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35223 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35224 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35225 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35226 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35227 messages.
35228
35229
35230 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35231 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35232 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
35233 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35234 .cindex "message" "submission"
35235 .cindex "submission mode"
35236 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35237 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35238
35239 .ilist
35240 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35241 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35242 .next
35243 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35244 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35245 .olist
35246 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35247 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35248 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35249 .next
35250 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35251 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35252 .next
35253 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35254 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35255 .endlist
35256 .endlist
35257
35258 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35259
35260 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35261 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35262 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35263 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35264 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35265 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35266 &%qualify_domain%&.
35267
35268 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35269 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35270 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35271 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35272
35273
35274 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35275 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35276 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35277 .cindex "message" "submission"
35278 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35279 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35280 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35281 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35282 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35283 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35284 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35285 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35286 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35287 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35288
35289
35290 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35291 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35292 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35293 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35294 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35295 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35296
35297 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35298 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35299 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35300 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35301
35302 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35303 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35304 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35305
35306
35307 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35308 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35309 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
35310 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35311 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35312 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35313 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35314 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35315 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35316 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35317 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35318 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35319
35320
35321
35322 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35323 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35324 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35325 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35326 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35327 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35328 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35329 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35330 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35331
35332
35333
35334 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35335 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35336 .cindex "message" "submission"
35337 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35338 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35339 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35340 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35341 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35342 control setting.
35343
35344 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35345 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35346 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35347 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35348 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35349 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35350 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35351 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35352 line is added to the message.
35353
35354 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35355 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35356 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35357 options true at the same time.
35358
35359 .cindex "submission mode"
35360 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35361 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35362 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35363 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35364
35365 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35366 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35367 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35368 created as follows:
35369
35370 .ilist
35371 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35372 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35373 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35374 .next
35375 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35376 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35377 .next
35378 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35379 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35380 .endlist
35381
35382 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35383 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35384 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35385 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35386
35387 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35388 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35389 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35390 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35391
35392
35393
35394 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35395 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35396 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35397 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35398 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35399 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35400 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35401 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35402 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35403
35404 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35405 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35406 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35407 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35408 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35409 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35410
35411 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35412 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35413 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35414
35415 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35416 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35417 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35418 .code
35419 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35420 X-added-second: another added header line
35421 .endd
35422 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35423
35424 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35425 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35426 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35427
35428 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35429 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35430 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35431 not part of the names. For example:
35432 .code
35433 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35434 .endd
35435
35436 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35437 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35438 Each item is separately expanded.
35439 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35440 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35441 will act as list separators.
35442
35443 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35444 items are expanded at routing time,
35445 and then associated with all addresses that are
35446 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35447 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35448 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35449
35450 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35451 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35452 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35453 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35454
35455 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35456 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35457 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35458 requirements.
35459
35460 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35461 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35462 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35463 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35464 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35465 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35466 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35467
35468 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35469 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35470 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35471 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35472
35473 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35474 the following consequences:
35475
35476 .ilist
35477 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35478 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35479 to it, at all times.
35480 .next
35481 Header lines that are added by a router's
35482 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35483 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35484 .next
35485 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35486 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35487 .next
35488 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35489 a later router or by a transport.
35490 .next
35491 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35492 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35493 .code
35494 headers_remove = subject
35495 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35496 .endd
35497 .endlist
35498
35499 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35500 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35501
35502
35503
35504
35505
35506 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35507 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35508 .cindex "constructed address"
35509 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35510 the form
35511 .display
35512 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35513 .endd
35514 For example:
35515 .code
35516 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35517 .endd
35518 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35519 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35520 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35521 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35522 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35523 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35524 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35525 there is no password file entry.
35526
35527 .cindex "RFC 2047"
35528 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35529 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35530 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35531 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35532 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35533 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35534 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35535 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35536
35537
35538
35539 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35540 .cindex "case of local parts"
35541 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35542 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35543 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35544 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35545 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35546 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35547 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35548 router option.
35549
35550 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35551 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35552 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35553 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35554 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35555 .code
35556 correct_case:
35557 driver = redirect
35558 domains = +local_domains
35559 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35560 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35561 @$domain
35562 .endd
35563 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35564 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35565 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35566 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35567 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35568
35569
35570
35571 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35572 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35573 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35574 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35575 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35576 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35577 empty components for compatibility.
35578
35579
35580
35581 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35582 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35583 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35584 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35585 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35586 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35587
35588 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35589 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35590 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35591 example, a header such as
35592 .code
35593 To: hare@teaparty
35594 .endd
35595 might get rewritten as
35596 .code
35597 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35598 .endd
35599 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35600 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35601 been routed.
35602
35603 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35604 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35605 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35606 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35607 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35608 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35609 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35610
35611
35612
35613 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35615
35616 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35617 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35618 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35619 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35620 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35621 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35622 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35623
35624 .ilist
35625 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35626 .next
35627 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35628 .next
35629 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35630 .endlist
35631
35632 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35633
35634 .ilist
35635 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35636 .next
35637 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35638 &"lmtp"&);
35639 .next
35640 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35641 transport);
35642 .next
35643 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35644 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35645 .endlist
35646
35647 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35648 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35649 used to contain the envelope information.
35650
35651
35652
35653 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35654 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35655 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35656 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35657 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35658 .cindex "EHLO"
35659 .cindex "HELO"
35660 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35661 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35662 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35663 processing is the same in both cases.
35664
35665 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35666 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35667 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35668 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35669 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35670 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35671 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35672 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35673 suppressed.
35674
35675 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35676 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35677 required for the transaction.
35678
35679 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35680 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35681 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35682 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35683 is called for verification.
35684
35685 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35686 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35687 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35688
35689 .cindex "carriage return"
35690 .cindex "linefeed"
35691 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35692 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35693 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35694 line terminator.
35695
35696 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35697 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35698 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35699 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35700 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35701 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35702 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35703 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35704 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35705
35706 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35707 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35708 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35709 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35710
35711 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35712 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35713 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35714 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35715
35716 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35717 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35718 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35719 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35720 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35721 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35722 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35723 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35724 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35725 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35726
35727 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35728 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35729
35730 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35731 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35732 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35733 square bracket of the IP address.
35734
35735
35736
35737
35738 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35739 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35740 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35741 .cindex "host" "error"
35742 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35743 message errors, and recipient errors.
35744
35745 .vlist
35746 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35747 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35748 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35749
35750 .ilist
35751 Connection refused or timed out,
35752 .next
35753 Any error response code on connection,
35754 .next
35755 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35756 .next
35757 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35758 .next
35759 I/O errors at any time,
35760 .next
35761 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35762 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35763 .endlist ilist
35764
35765 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35766 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35767 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35768 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35769 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35770 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35771 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35772 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35773
35774 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35775 .cindex "message" "error"
35776 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35777 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35778 message errors are:
35779
35780 .ilist
35781 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35782 the data,
35783 .next
35784 Timeout after MAIL,
35785 .next
35786 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35787 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35788 connection at any other time.
35789 .endlist ilist
35790
35791 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35792 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35793 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35794 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35795 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35796 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35797 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35798 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35799 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35800 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35801
35802 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35803 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35804 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35805 response to MAIL.
35806
35807 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35808 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35809 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35810 recipient errors are:
35811
35812 .ilist
35813 Any error response to RCPT,
35814 .next
35815 Timeout after RCPT.
35816 .endlist
35817
35818 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35819 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35820 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35821 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35822 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35823 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35824 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35825 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35826 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35827 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35828 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35829 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35830 the retry clock is reset.
35831
35832 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35833 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35834 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35835 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35836 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35837 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35838 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35839 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35840 recipient's retry time.
35841 .endlist
35842
35843 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35844 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35845 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35846 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35847 until the next delivery attempt.
35848
35849 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35850 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35851 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35852 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35853 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35854 is created.
35855
35856 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35857 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35858 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35859 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35860 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35861 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35862 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35863
35864 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35865 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35866 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35867 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35868 then to be treated as a host error.
35869
35870 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35871 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35872 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35873 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35874 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35875
35876
35877
35878
35879 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35880 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35881 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35882 .cindex "inetd"
35883 .cindex "daemon"
35884 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35885 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35886 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35887 .code
35888 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35889 .endd
35890 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35891 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35892 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35893 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35894 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35895 stream and exits with an error code.
35896
35897 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35898 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35899 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35900 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35901
35902 .cindex "carriage return"
35903 .cindex "linefeed"
35904 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35905 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35906 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35907 line terminator.
35908 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35909 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35910 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35911
35912 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35913 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35914 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35915 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35916 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35917 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35918 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35919 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35920
35921 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35922 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35923 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35924 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35925 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35926 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35927 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35928 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35929 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35930
35931 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35932 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35933 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35934
35935 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35936 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35937 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35938 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35939 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35940
35941 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35942 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35943 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35944 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35945 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35946 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35947 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35948
35949 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35950 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35951 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35952 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35953 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35954
35955 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35956 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35957 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35958 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35959 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35960 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35961 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35962 a delivery process.
35963
35964 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35965 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35966 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35967 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35968 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35969
35970 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35971 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35972 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35973 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35974
35975 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35976 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35977 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35978
35979
35980
35981 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35982 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35983 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35984 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35985 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35986 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35987 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35988 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35989
35990
35991 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35992 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35993 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35994 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35995 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35996 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35997 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35998 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35999 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36000 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36001 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36002
36003
36004
36005 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36006 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36007 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36008 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36009 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36010 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36011 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36012 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36013
36014 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36015 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36016 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36017 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36018 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36019 counted.
36020
36021 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36022 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36023 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36024
36025 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36026 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36027 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36028 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36029 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36030
36031
36032
36033
36034 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36035 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36036 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36037 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36038
36039 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36040 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36041 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
36042 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
36043 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
36044 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
36045 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
36046 SMTP response codes.
36047
36048 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
36049 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
36050 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
36051 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
36052 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
36053 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
36054 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
36055 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
36056 RCPT failures.
36057
36058
36059
36060 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
36061 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
36062 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
36063 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
36064 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
36065 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
36066 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
36067
36068 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
36069 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
36070 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
36071 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
36072 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
36073 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
36074 argument. For example,
36075 .code
36076 ETRN #brigadoon
36077 .endd
36078 runs the command
36079 .code
36080 exim -R brigadoon
36081 .endd
36082 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
36083 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
36084 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
36085 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
36086 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
36087
36088 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
36089 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
36090 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
36091 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
36092 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
36093 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
36094 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
36095 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
36096
36097 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
36098 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
36099 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
36100 whatever the form of its argument. For
36101 example:
36102 .code
36103 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
36104 $sender_host_address
36105 .endd
36106 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36107 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
36108 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
36109 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
36110 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
36111 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
36112 for it to change them before running the command.
36113
36114
36115
36116 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
36117 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
36118 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
36119 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
36120 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
36121 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
36122 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
36123 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
36124 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36125 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36126 runs for RCPT commands:
36127 .code
36128 accept hosts = :
36129 .endd
36130 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36131
36132
36133
36134 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36135 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36136 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
36137 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36138 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36139 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36140 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36141 envelope along with the message.
36142
36143 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36144 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36145 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36146 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36147 can be used to specify it.
36148
36149 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36150 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36151 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36152 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36153 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36154
36155 .vindex "&$host$&"
36156 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36157 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36158 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36159 router:
36160 .code
36161 begin routers
36162 route_append:
36163 driver = manualroute
36164 transport = smtp_appendfile
36165 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36166
36167 begin transports
36168 smtp_appendfile:
36169 driver = appendfile
36170 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36171 batch_max = 1000
36172 use_bsmtp
36173 user = exim
36174 .endd
36175 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36176 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36177 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36178
36179
36180
36181 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36182 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36183 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
36184 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36185 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36186 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36187 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36188 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36189 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36190 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36191
36192 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36193 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36194
36195 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36196 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36197 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36198 make some use of automatically, for example:
36199 .code
36200 554 Unexpected end of file
36201 Transaction started in line 10
36202 Error detected in line 14
36203 .endd
36204 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36205 file, for example:
36206 .code
36207 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36208 The error message was:
36209
36210 501 '>' missing at end of address
36211
36212 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36213 The error was detected in line 12.
36214 The SMTP command at fault was:
36215
36216 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36217
36218 1 previous message was successfully processed.
36219 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36220 .endd
36221 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36222 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36223 accepted.
36224 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36225 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36226
36227
36228
36229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36231
36232 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36233 "Customizing messages"
36234 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36235 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36236 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36237 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36238 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36239
36240 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36241 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36242 option. Exim also adds the line
36243 .code
36244 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36245 .endd
36246 to all warning and bounce messages,
36247
36248
36249 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36250 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36251 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36252 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36253 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36254 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36255 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36256
36257 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36258 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36259 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36260 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36261 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36262 item.
36263
36264 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36265 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36266 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36267 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36268 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36269 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36270 option, rounded to a whole number.
36271
36272 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36273
36274 .ilist
36275 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36276 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36277 .next
36278 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36279 failing addresses with their error messages.
36280 .next
36281 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36282 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36283 .next
36284 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36285 The fields exist for back-compatibility
36286 .endlist
36287
36288 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36289 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36290 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36291 .code
36292 Subject: Mail delivery failed
36293 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36294 {: returning message to sender}}
36295 ****
36296 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36297
36298 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36299 {that you sent }{sent by
36300
36301 <$sender_address>
36302
36303 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36304 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36305 ****
36306 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36307 ****
36308 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36309 ------
36310 ****
36311 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36312 only the first
36313 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36314 ****
36315 .endd
36316 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36317 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36318 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36319 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36320 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36321 text sections:
36322
36323 .ilist
36324 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36325 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36326 .next
36327 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36328 the delayed addresses.
36329 .next
36330 The third item then ends the message.
36331 .endlist
36332
36333 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36334 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36335 .code
36336 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36337 $warn_message_delay
36338 ****
36339 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36340
36341 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36342 {that you sent }{sent by
36343
36344 <$sender_address>
36345
36346 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36347 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36348
36349 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36350 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36351 The date of the message is: $h_date
36352
36353 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36354 ****
36355 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36356 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36357 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36358 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36359 the message will be returned to you.
36360 .endd
36361 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36362 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36363 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36364 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36365 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36366 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36367 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36368 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36369 handled them.
36370
36371
36372
36373
36374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36376
36377 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36378 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36379 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36380
36381
36382
36383 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36384 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36385 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36386 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36387 routing explicitly:
36388 .code
36389 send_to_smart_host:
36390 driver = manualroute
36391 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36392 transport = remote_smtp
36393 .endd
36394 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36395 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36396 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36397 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36398 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36399
36400
36401
36402
36403 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36404 .cindex "mailing lists"
36405 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36406 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36407 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36408
36409 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36410 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36411 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36412 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36413 .code
36414 lists:
36415 driver = redirect
36416 domains = lists.example
36417 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36418 forbid_pipe
36419 forbid_file
36420 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36421 no_more
36422 .endd
36423 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36424 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36425 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36426 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36427
36428 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36429 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36430 a mailing list.
36431
36432 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36433 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36434 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36435 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36436 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36437
36438 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36439 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36440 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36441 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36442 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36443 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36444 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36445 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36446 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36447
36448
36449
36450 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36451 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36452 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36453 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36454 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36455 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36456 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36457
36458 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36459 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36460 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36461 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36462 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36463
36464
36465
36466 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36467 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36468 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36469 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36470 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36471 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36472 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36473 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36474 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36475 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36476
36477 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36478 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36479 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36480 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36481 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36482 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36483 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36484 pre-existing messages.
36485
36486 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36487 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36488 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36489 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36490 one level of expansion anyway.
36491
36492
36493
36494 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36495 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36496 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36497 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36498 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36499 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36500
36501 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36502 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36503 .code
36504 lists_request:
36505 driver = redirect
36506 domains = lists.example
36507 local_part_suffix = -request
36508 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36509 no_more
36510
36511 lists_post:
36512 driver = redirect
36513 domains = lists.example
36514 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36515 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36516 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36517 forbid_pipe
36518 forbid_file
36519 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36520 no_more
36521
36522 lists_closed:
36523 driver = redirect
36524 domains = lists.example
36525 allow_fail
36526 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36527 .endd
36528 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36529 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36530 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36531 mailing list.
36532
36533 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36534 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36535 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36536 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36537 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36538 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36539 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36540 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36541 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36542
36543 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36544 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36545 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36546
36547
36548
36549
36550 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36551 .cindex "VERP"
36552 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36553 .cindex "envelope from"
36554 .cindex "envelope sender"
36555 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36556 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36557 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36558 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36559 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36560 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36561
36562 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36563 .oindex &%return_path%&
36564 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36565 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36566 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36567 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36568 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36569 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36570 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36571 .code
36572 verp_smtp:
36573 driver = smtp
36574 max_rcpt = 1
36575 return_path = \
36576 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36577 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36578 .endd
36579 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36580 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36581 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36582 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36583 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36584 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36585 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36586 rewritten as
36587 .code
36588 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36589 .endd
36590 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36591 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36592 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36593 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36594 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36595 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36596
36597 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36598 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36599 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36600 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36601 .code
36602 dnslookup:
36603 driver = dnslookup
36604 domains = ! +local_domains
36605 transport = \
36606 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36607 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36608 no_more
36609 .endd
36610 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36611 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36612 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36613 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36614 address.
36615
36616 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36617 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36618 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36619 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36620 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36621 .code
36622 verp_dnslookup:
36623 driver = dnslookup
36624 domains = ! +local_domains
36625 transport = remote_smtp
36626 errors_to = \
36627 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36628 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36629 no_more
36630 .endd
36631 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36632 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36633 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36634 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36635 them.
36636
36637 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36638 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36639 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36640 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36641 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36642 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36643 used).
36644
36645
36646
36647
36648
36649
36650 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36651 .cindex "virtual domains"
36652 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36653 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36654 meanings:
36655
36656 .ilist
36657 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36658 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36659 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36660 .next
36661 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36662 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36663 have login accounts on that host.
36664 .endlist
36665
36666 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36667 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36668 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36669 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36670 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36671 to a router of this form:
36672 .code
36673 virtual:
36674 driver = redirect
36675 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36676 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36677 no_more
36678 .endd
36679 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36680 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36681 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36682 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36683 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36684 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36685
36686 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36687 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36688 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36689 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36690
36691 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36692 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36693 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36694 .code
36695 my_domains:
36696 driver = accept
36697 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36698 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36699 transport = my_mailboxes
36700 .endd
36701 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36702 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36703 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36704 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36705 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36706 follows:
36707 .code
36708 my_mailboxes:
36709 driver = appendfile
36710 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36711 user = mail
36712 .endd
36713 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36714 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36715
36716 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36717 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36718 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36719 information about the domains.
36720
36721
36722
36723 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36724 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36725 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36726 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36727 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36728 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36729 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36730 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36731 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36732 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36733 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36734 example, consider this router:
36735 .code
36736 userforward:
36737 driver = redirect
36738 check_local_user
36739 file = $home/.forward
36740 local_part_suffix = -*
36741 local_part_suffix_optional
36742 allow_filter
36743 .endd
36744 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36745 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36746 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36747 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36748 .code
36749 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36750 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36751 endif
36752 .endd
36753 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36754 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36755 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36756 control over which suffixes are valid.
36757
36758 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36759 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36760 another MTA:
36761 .code
36762 userforward:
36763 driver = redirect
36764 check_local_user
36765 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36766 local_part_suffix = -*
36767 local_part_suffix_optional
36768 allow_filter
36769 .endd
36770 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36771 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36772 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36773 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36774 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36775
36776
36777
36778 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36779 .cindex "vacation processing"
36780 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36781 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36782 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36783 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36784 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36785
36786 .ilist
36787 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36788 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36789 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36790 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36791 .code
36792 spqr, vacation-spqr
36793 .endd
36794 .next
36795 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36796 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36797 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36798 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36799 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36800 message.
36801 .endlist
36802
36803 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36804 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36805
36806
36807
36808 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36809 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36810 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36811 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36812 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36813 each day's messages.
36814
36815 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36816 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36817 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36818 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36819
36820
36821
36822 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36823 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36824 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36825 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36826 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36827 permanently connected.
36828
36829 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36830 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36831 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36832
36833
36834 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36835 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36836 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36837 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36838 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36839 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36840 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36841 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36842
36843 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36844 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36845 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36846 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36847 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36848 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36849 if required.
36850
36851 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36852 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36853 intermittent host. For example:
36854 .code
36855 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36856 .endd
36857 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36858 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36859 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36860 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36861 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36862 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36863 immediately.
36864
36865 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36866 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36867 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36868 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36869 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36870 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36871 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36872
36873
36874
36875 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36876 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36877 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36878 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36879 delivered immediately.
36880
36881 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36882 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36883 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36884 .cindex "first pass routing"
36885 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36886 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36887 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36888 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36889 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36890 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36891 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36892 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36893 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36894 single SMTP connection.
36895
36896
36897
36898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36900
36901 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36902 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36903 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36904 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36905 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36906 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36907 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36908 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36909 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36910 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36911 messages this way.
36912
36913 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36914 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36915 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36916 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36917 email is not desirable.
36918
36919 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36920 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36921 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36922 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36923 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36924 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36925 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36926
36927 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36928 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36929 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36930 before sending a message to the smart host.
36931
36932 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36933 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36934 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36935
36936 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36937 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36938 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36939 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36940 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36941 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36942 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36943
36944 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36945 following ways:
36946
36947 .ilist
36948 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36949 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36950 .next
36951 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36952 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36953 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36954 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36955 successful, a zero return code is given.
36956 .next
36957 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36958 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36959 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36960 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36961 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36962 are.
36963 .next
36964 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36965 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36966 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36967 .next
36968 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36969 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36970 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36971 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36972 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36973 .next
36974 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36975 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36976 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36977 .next
36978 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36979 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36980 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36981 are ever generated.
36982 .next
36983 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36984 .next
36985 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36986 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36987 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36988 .endlist
36989
36990 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36991 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36992 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36993 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36994 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36995 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36996
36997
36998
36999
37000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37002
37003 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37004 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37005 .cindex "log" "types of"
37006 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37007 and the panic log:
37008
37009 .ilist
37010 .cindex "main log"
37011 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37012 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37013 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37014 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37015 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37016 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37017 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37018 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37019 .next
37020 .cindex "reject log"
37021 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37022 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37023 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37024 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37025 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37026 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37027 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37028 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37029 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37030 false.
37031 .next
37032 .cindex "panic log"
37033 .cindex "system log"
37034 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37035 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
37036 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
37037 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
37038 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
37039 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
37040 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
37041 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
37042 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
37043 .endlist
37044
37045 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
37046 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
37047 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
37048 .code
37049 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
37050 by QUIT
37051 .endd
37052 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
37053 ways of changing this:
37054
37055 .ilist
37056 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
37057 you set
37058 .code
37059 timezone = UTC
37060 .endd
37061 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
37062 .next
37063 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
37064 example:
37065 .code
37066 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
37067 .endd
37068 .endlist
37069
37070 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37071 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37072 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
37073 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
37074 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
37075 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
37076
37077
37078
37079
37080 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
37081 .cindex "log" "destination"
37082 .cindex "log" "to file"
37083 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
37084 .cindex "syslog"
37085 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
37086 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
37087 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
37088 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
37089 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
37090 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
37091 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
37092
37093 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
37094 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
37095 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
37096 references to the host name:
37097 .code
37098 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
37099 .endd
37100 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
37101 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
37102 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
37103 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
37104 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
37105 log at all.
37106
37107 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
37108 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
37109 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
37110 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
37111 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
37112 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
37113 implying the use of a default path.
37114
37115 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
37116 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
37117 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
37118 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
37119 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
37120 equivalent to the setting:
37121 .code
37122 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
37123 .endd
37124 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
37125 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37126 that is where the logs are written.
37127
37128 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37129 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37130
37131 Here are some examples of possible settings:
37132 .display
37133 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37134 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37135 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37136 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37137 .endd
37138 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37139 error is logged.
37140
37141
37142
37143 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37144 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37145 .cindex "cycling logs"
37146 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37147 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37148 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37149 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37150 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37151 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37152 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37153
37154 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37155 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37156 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37157 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37158 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37159 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37160 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37161 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37162 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37163 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37164 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37165 renamed.
37166
37167
37168
37169 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37170 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37171 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37172 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37173 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37174 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37175 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37176 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37177 .code
37178 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37179 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37180 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37181 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37182 .endd
37183 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37184 examples of names generated by the above examples:
37185 .code
37186 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37187 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37188 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37189 /var/log/exim/main.200212
37190 .endd
37191 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37192 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37193 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37194 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37195
37196 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37197 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37198 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37199 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37200 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37201 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37202 log names:
37203 .code
37204 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37205 /var/log/exim-panic.log
37206 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37207 /var/log/exim/panic
37208 .endd
37209
37210
37211 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37212 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37213 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37214 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37215 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37216 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37217 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37218 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37219 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37220 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37221 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37222 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37223 the time and host name to each line.
37224 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37225
37226 .ilist
37227 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37228 .next
37229 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37230 .next
37231 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37232 .endlist
37233
37234 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37235 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37236 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37237 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37238
37239 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37240 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37241 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37242 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37243 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37244 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37245 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37246 RFC 3164, you should set
37247 .code
37248 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37249 .endd
37250 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37251 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37252
37253 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37254 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37255 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37256 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37257 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37258 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37259 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37260 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37261 name, and pid as added by syslog:
37262 .code
37263 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37264 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37265 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37266 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37267 [5/5] mple>)
37268 .endd
37269 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37270 (LOG_NOTICE):
37271 .code
37272 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37273 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37274 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37275 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37276 [5\18] .example>)
37277 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37278 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37279 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37280 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37281 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37282 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
37283 [12\18] F From: <>
37284 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37285 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
37286 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37287 [16\18] le>
37288 [17\18] B Bcc:
37289 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37290 .endd
37291 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37292 without modification.
37293
37294 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37295 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37296 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37297 where it is.
37298
37299
37300
37301 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37302 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37303 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37304 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37305 timestamp. The flags are:
37306 .display
37307 &`<=`& message arrival
37308 &`(=`& message fakereject
37309 &`=>`& normal message delivery
37310 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
37311 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37312 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37313 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37314 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37315 .endd
37316
37317
37318 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37319 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37320 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37321 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37322 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37323 .code
37324 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37325 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37326 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37327 .endd
37328 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37329 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37330 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37331 .code
37332 R=<message id>
37333 .endd
37334 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37335
37336 .cindex "HELO"
37337 .cindex "EHLO"
37338 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37339 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37340 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37341 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37342 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37343 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37344 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37345 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37346 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37347 name in parentheses.
37348
37349 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37350 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37351 the log containing text like these examples:
37352 .code
37353 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37354 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37355 .endd
37356 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37357 on.
37358
37359 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37360 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37361 of Exim.
37362
37363 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37364 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37365 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37366 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37367 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37368 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37369 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37370 suite that was used.
37371
37372 .cindex log protocol
37373 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37374 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37375 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37376 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37377 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37378 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37379 authenticator name.
37380
37381 .cindex "size" "of message"
37382 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37383 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37384 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37385 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37386 other).
37387
37388 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37389 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37390
37391
37392
37393 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37394 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37395 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37396 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37397 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37398 to fit it on the page:
37399 .code
37400 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37401 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37402 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37403 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37404 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37405 .endd
37406 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37407 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37408 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37409 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37410 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37411
37412 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37413 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37414 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37415 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37416
37417 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37418 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37419 .display
37420 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37421 .endd
37422 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37423 parentheses afterwards.
37424
37425 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37426 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37427 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37428 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37429 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37430 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37431 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37432 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37433 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37434 TLS cipher information is still available.
37435
37436 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37437 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37438 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37439 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37440 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37441
37442 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37443 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37444
37445 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37446 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37447
37448
37449 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37450 .cindex "discarded messages"
37451 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37452 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37453 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37454 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37455 .code
37456 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37457 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37458 .endd
37459 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37460 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37461 .code
37462 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37463 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37464 .endd
37465
37466
37467 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37468 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37469 .code
37470 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37471 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37472 .endd
37473 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37474 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37475 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37476 .code
37477 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37478 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37479 .endd
37480 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37481 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37482 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37483
37484
37485
37486 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37487 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37488 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37489 following form is logged:
37490 .code
37491 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37492 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37493 .endd
37494 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37495 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37496 .code
37497 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37498 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37499 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37500 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37501 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37502 .endd
37503 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37504 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37505 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37506 flagged with &`**`&.
37507
37508
37509
37510 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37511 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37512 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37513 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37514 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37515
37516
37517
37518 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37519 A line of the form
37520 .code
37521 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37522 .endd
37523 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37524 at the end of its processing.
37525
37526
37527
37528
37529 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37530 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37531 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37532 the following table:
37533 .display
37534 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37535 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37536 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37537 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37538 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37539 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37540 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37541 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37542 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37543 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37544 &`H `& host name and IP address
37545 &`I `& local interface used
37546 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37547 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37548 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37549 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37550 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37551 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37552 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37553 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37554 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37555 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37556 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37557 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37558 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37559 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37560 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37561 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37562 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37563 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37564 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37565 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37566 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37567 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37568 .endd
37569
37570
37571 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37572 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37573 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37574
37575 .ilist
37576 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37577 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37578 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37579 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37580 during the first delivery attempt.
37581 .next
37582 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37583 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37584 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37585 .next
37586 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37587 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37588 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37589 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37590 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37591 doing.
37592 .next
37593 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37594 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37595 message:
37596 .olist
37597 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37598 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37599 .next
37600 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37601 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37602 .next
37603 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37604 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37605 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37606 .code
37607 errors_to = <>
37608 .endd
37609 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37610 .endlist olist
37611 .next
37612 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37613 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37614 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37615 .endlist ilist
37616
37617
37618
37619
37620
37621 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37622 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37623 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37624 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37625 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37626 example:
37627 .code
37628 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37629 .endd
37630 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37631 selection marked by asterisks:
37632 .display
37633 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37634 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37635 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37636 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37637 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37638 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37639 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37640 &` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37641 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37642 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37643 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37644 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37645 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37646 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37647 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37648 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37649 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37650 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37651 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37652 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37653 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37654 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37655 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37656 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37657 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37658 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37659 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37660 &` pid `& Exim process id
37661 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37662 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37663 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37664 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37665 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37666 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37667 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37668 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37669 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37670 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37671 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37672 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37673 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37674 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37675 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37676 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37677 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37678 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37679 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37680 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37681 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37682 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37683 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37684 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37685 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37686
37687 &` all `& all of the above
37688 .endd
37689 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37690 section &<<SECID99>>&
37691
37692 More details on each of these items follows:
37693
37694 .ilist
37695 .cindex "8BITMIME"
37696 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37697 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37698 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37699 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37700 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37701 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37702 .next
37703 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37704 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37705 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37706 this log selector is set.
37707 .next
37708 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37709 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37710 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37711 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37712 such users cannot access the log).
37713 .next
37714 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37715 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37716 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37717 parentheses between them.
37718 .next
37719 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37720 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37721 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37722 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37723 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37724 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37725 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37726 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37727 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37728 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37729 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37730 between the caller and Exim.
37731 .next
37732 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37733 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37734 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37735 .next
37736 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37737 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37738 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37739 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37740 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37741 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37742 .next
37743 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37744 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37745 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37746 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37747 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37748 .next
37749 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37750 .cindex "size" "of message"
37751 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37752 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37753 .next
37754 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37755 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37756 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37757 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37758 .next
37759 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37760 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37761 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37762 .next
37763 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37764 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37765 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37766 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37767 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37768 .next
37769 .cindex log dnssec
37770 .cindex dnssec logging
37771 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37772 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37773 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37774 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37775 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37776 .next
37777 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37778 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37779 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37780 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37781 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37782 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37783 .next
37784 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37785 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37786 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37787 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37788 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37789 .next
37790 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37791 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37792 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37793 client's ident port times out.
37794 .next
37795 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37796 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37797 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37798 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37799 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37800 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37801 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37802 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37803 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37804 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37805 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37806 .next
37807 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37808 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37809 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37810 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37811 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37812 on a proxied connection
37813 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37814 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37815 .next
37816 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37817 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37818 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37819 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37820 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37821 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37822 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37823 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37824 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37825 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37826 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37827 .next
37828 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37829 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37830 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37831 .next
37832 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37833 .cindex millisecond logging
37834 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37835 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37836 appended to the seconds value.
37837 .next
37838 .cindex "log" "message id"
37839 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37840 .next
37841 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37842 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37843 (submission mode) without one.
37844 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37845 .next
37846 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37847 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37848 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37849 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37850 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37851 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37852 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37853 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37854 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37855 .next
37856 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37857 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37858 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37859 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37860 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37861 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37862 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37863 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37864 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37865 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37866 .next
37867 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37868 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37869 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37870 immediately after the time and date.
37871 .next
37872 .cindex log pipelining
37873 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37874 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37875 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37876 The field is a single "L".
37877
37878 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37879 the field has a minus appended.
37880
37881 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37882 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37883 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37884 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37885 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37886
37887 .next
37888 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37889 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37890 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37891 .next
37892 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37893 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37894 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37895 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37896 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37897 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37898 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37899 message has been successfully received.
37900 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37901 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37902 .next
37903 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37904 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37905 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37906 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37907 .next
37908 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37909 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37910 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37911 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37912 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37913 .next
37914 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37915 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37916 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37917 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37918 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37919 has taken place.
37920 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37921 in the list.
37922 .next
37923 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37924 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37925 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37926 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37927 .next
37928 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37929 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37930 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37931 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37932 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37933 .next
37934 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37935 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37936 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37937 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37938 attempt.
37939 .next
37940 .cindex "log" "return path"
37941 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37942 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37943 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37944 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37945 .next
37946 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37947 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37948 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37949 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37950 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37951 .next
37952 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37953 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37954 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37955 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37956 detail is lost.
37957 .next
37958 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37959 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37960 it is too big.
37961 .next
37962 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37963 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37964 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37965 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37966 it.
37967 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37968 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37969 .next
37970 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37971 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37972 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37973 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37974 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37975 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37976 response.
37977 .next
37978 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37979 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37980 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37981 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37982 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37983 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37984 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37985 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37986 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37987 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37988
37989 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37990 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37991 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37992 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37993 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37994 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37995 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37996 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37997 .next
37998 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37999 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38000 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38001 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38002 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38003 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38004 .next
38005 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38006 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38007 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38008 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38009 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38010 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38011 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38012 already have their own log lines.
38013
38014 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38015 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38016 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38017 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38018 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38019 the same logging options.
38020
38021 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38022 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38023 .code
38024 C=EHLO,QUIT
38025 .endd
38026 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
38027 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
38028 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
38029 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
38030 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
38031 .next
38032 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
38033 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
38034 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
38035 was accepted or used.
38036 .next
38037 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
38038 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
38039 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
38040 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
38041 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
38042 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
38043 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
38044 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
38045 .next
38046 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
38047 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
38048 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
38049 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
38050 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
38051 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
38052 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
38053 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
38054 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
38055 .next
38056 .cindex "log" "subject"
38057 .cindex "subject, logging"
38058 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
38059 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
38060 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
38061 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
38062 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
38063 .next
38064 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
38065 .cindex log DANE
38066 .cindex DANE logging
38067 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
38068 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
38069 verified
38070 using a CA trust anchor,
38071 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
38072 and &`CV=no`& if not.
38073 .next
38074 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
38075 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
38076 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38077 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
38078 .next
38079 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
38080 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
38081 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38082 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
38083 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
38084 .next
38085 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
38086 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
38087 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
38088 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
38089 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
38090 .next
38091 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
38092 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
38093 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
38094 .endlist
38095
38096
38097 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
38098 .cindex "message" "log file for"
38099 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
38100 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
38101 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
38102 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
38103 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
38104 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
38105 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
38106 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
38107 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
38108 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
38109 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
38110
38111 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
38112 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
38113 &%message_logs%& option false.
38114 .ecindex IIDloggen
38115
38116
38117
38118
38119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38121
38122 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
38123 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
38124 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
38125 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38126 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38127
38128 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38129 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38130 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38131 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38132 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38133 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38134 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38135 various criteria"
38136 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38137 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38138 "extract statistics from the log"
38139 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38140 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38141 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38142 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38143 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38144 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38145 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38146 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38147 .endtable
38148
38149 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38150 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38151 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38152
38153
38154
38155
38156 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38157 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38158 .cindex "process, querying"
38159 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
38160 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38161 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38162 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38163 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38164 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38165 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38166 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38167 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38168
38169 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38170 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38171 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38172
38173
38174 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38175 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38176 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38177 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38178 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38179 options:
38180 .display
38181 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38182 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38183 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38184 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38185 .endd
38186 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38187 .code
38188 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
38189 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
38190 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38191 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
38192 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
38193 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38194 .endd
38195 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38196 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38197
38198
38199
38200 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38201 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38202 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
38203 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38204 .code
38205 exim -bpu
38206 .endd
38207 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38208 .code
38209 exim -bp
38210 .endd
38211 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38212 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38213
38214 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38215 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38216
38217 .vlist
38218 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38219 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38220 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38221 .code
38222 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38223 .endd
38224 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38225 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38226 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38227
38228 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38229 Match against the size field.
38230
38231 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38232 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38233
38234 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38235 Match messages that are older than the given time.
38236
38237 .vitem &*-z*&
38238 Match only frozen messages.
38239
38240 .vitem &*-x*&
38241 Match only non-frozen messages.
38242
38243 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38244 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38245 .endlist
38246
38247 The following options control the format of the output:
38248
38249 .vlist
38250 .vitem &*-c*&
38251 Display only the count of matching messages.
38252
38253 .vitem &*-l*&
38254 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38255 the default.
38256
38257 .vitem &*-i*&
38258 Display message ids only.
38259
38260 .vitem &*-b*&
38261 Brief format &-- one line per message.
38262
38263 .vitem &*-R*&
38264 Display messages in reverse order.
38265
38266 .vitem &*-a*&
38267 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38268 .endlist
38269
38270 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38271
38272
38273
38274 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38275 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38276 .cindex "queue" "summary"
38277 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38278 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38279 running a command such as
38280 .code
38281 exim -bp | exiqsumm
38282 .endd
38283 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38284 it, as in the following example:
38285 .code
38286 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38287 .endd
38288 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38289 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38290 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38291 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38292
38293 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38294 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38295 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38296 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38297 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38298 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38299 sender.
38300
38301 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38302 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38303 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38304 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38305 level"& addresses).
38306
38307
38308
38309
38310 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38311 "SECTextspeinf"
38312 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38313 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38314 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38315 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38316 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38317 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38318 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38319 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38320 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38321 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38322 .display
38323 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38324 .endd
38325 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38326
38327 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38328 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38329 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38330
38331 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38332 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38333 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38334 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38335 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38336
38337 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38338 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38339 regular expression.
38340
38341 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38342 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38343
38344 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38345 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38346 normally.
38347
38348 Example of &%-M%&:
38349 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38350 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38351 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38352 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38353 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38354 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38355 search term.
38356
38357 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38358 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38359 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38360 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38361 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38362
38363
38364 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38365 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38366 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38367 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38368 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38369 the &%--help%& option.
38370
38371
38372 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38373 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38374 .cindex "cycling logs"
38375 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38376 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38377 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38378 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38379 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38380 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38381 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38382 .ilist
38383 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38384 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38385 .next
38386 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38387 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38388 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38389 configuration.
38390 .endlist
38391
38392 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38393 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38394 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38395 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38396 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38397 logs are handled similarly.
38398
38399 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38400 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38401 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38402 any existing log files.
38403
38404 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38405 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38406 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38407 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38408 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38409 .code
38410 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38411 .endd
38412 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38413 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38414
38415
38416
38417 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38418 .cindex "statistics"
38419 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38420 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38421 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38422 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38423 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38424
38425 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38426 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38427 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38428 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38429 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38430 .code
38431 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38432 .endd
38433 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38434 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38435 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38436 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38437 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38438 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38439 also produced per user.
38440
38441 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38442 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38443 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38444 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38445 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38446
38447 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38448 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38449 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38450 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38451 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38452 an entirely separate message.
38453
38454 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38455 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38456 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38457 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38458 least one address that failed.
38459
38460 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38461 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38462 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38463 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38464 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38465 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38466 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38467
38468 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38469 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38470 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38471
38472 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38473 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38474 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38475 .code
38476 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38477 .endd
38478
38479 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38480 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38481 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38482 .cindex "checking access"
38483 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38484 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38485 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38486 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38487 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38488 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38489
38490 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38491 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38492 .code
38493 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38494 .endd
38495 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38496 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38497 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38498 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38499 .code
38500 Rejected:
38501 550 Relay not permitted
38502 .endd
38503 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38504 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38505 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38506 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38507 you can use:
38508 .code
38509 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38510 -f himself@there.example
38511 .endd
38512 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38513 mandatory arguments.
38514
38515 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38516 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38517 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38518
38519
38520
38521 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38522 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38523 .cindex "building DBM files"
38524 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38525 .cindex "lower casing"
38526 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38527 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38528 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38529 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38530 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38531 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38532
38533 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38534 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38535 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38536 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38537 files.
38538
38539 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38540 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38541 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38542 well.
38543
38544 .cindex "USE_DB"
38545 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38546 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38547 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38548 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38549 .code
38550 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38551 .endd
38552 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38553 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38554
38555 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38556 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38557 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38558 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38559 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38560 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38561
38562 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38563 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38564 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38565 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38566 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38567 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38568 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38569 return code is 2.
38570
38571
38572
38573
38574 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38575 .cindex "retry" "times"
38576 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38577 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38578 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38579 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38580 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38581 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38582 output. For example:
38583 .code
38584 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38585 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38586 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38587 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38588 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38589 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38590 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38591 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38592 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38593 past final cutoff time
38594 .endd
38595 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38596 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38597 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38598 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38599 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38600 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38601 run very often.
38602
38603 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38604 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38605 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38606 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38607 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38608 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38609
38610
38611
38612 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38613 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38614 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38615 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38616 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38617 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38618 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38619
38620 .ilist
38621 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38622 .next
38623 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38624 for remote hosts
38625 .next
38626 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38627 .next
38628 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38629 .next
38630 &'misc'&: other hints data
38631 .endlist
38632
38633 The &'misc'& database is used for
38634
38635 .ilist
38636 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38637 .next
38638 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38639 &(smtp)& transport)
38640 .next
38641 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38642 in a transport)
38643 .endlist
38644
38645
38646
38647 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38648 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38649 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38650 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38651 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38652 .code
38653 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38654 .endd
38655 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38656 .code
38657 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38658 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38659 .endd
38660 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38661 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38662 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38663 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38664 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38665 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38666 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38667 and a textual description of the error.
38668
38669 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38670 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38671 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38672 exceeded.
38673
38674 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38675 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38676 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38677 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38678 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38679 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38680 cross-references.
38681
38682
38683
38684 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38685 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38686 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38687 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38688 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38689 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38690 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38691 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38692 updated sufficiently often.
38693
38694 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38695 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38696 the retry database:
38697 .code
38698 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38699 .endd
38700 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38701 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38702 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38703 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38704 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38705 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38706 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38707 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38708 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38709 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38710 whenever it removes information from the database.
38711
38712 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38713 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38714 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38715 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38716 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38717
38718 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38719 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38720 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38721 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38722 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38723 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38724 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38725 tidied.
38726
38727 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38728 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38729
38730
38731
38732
38733 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38734 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38735 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38736 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38737 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38738 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38739 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38740 displayed.
38741
38742 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38743 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38744 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38745 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38746 by new data, for example:
38747 .code
38748 > 4 951102:1000
38749 .endd
38750 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38751 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38752 used as optional separators.
38753
38754
38755
38756
38757 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38758 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38759 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38760 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38761 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38762 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38763 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38764 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38765 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38766 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38767 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38768 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38769 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38770
38771 .vlist
38772 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
38773 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38774
38775 .vitem &%-flock%&
38776 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38777 supports it.
38778
38779 .vitem &%-interval%&
38780 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38781 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38782
38783 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38784 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38785
38786 .vitem &%-mbx%&
38787 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38788
38789 .vitem &%-q%&
38790 Suppress verification output.
38791
38792 .vitem &%-retries%&
38793 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38794 the lock (default 10).
38795
38796 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38797 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38798 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38799 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38800 subsequently sees.
38801
38802 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38803 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38804 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38805 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38806
38807 .vitem &%-v%&
38808 Generate verbose output.
38809 .endlist
38810
38811 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38812 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38813 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38814 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38815 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38816 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38817 more than 30 minutes old.
38818
38819 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38820 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38821 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38822 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38823 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38824 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38825
38826 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38827 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38828 suppresses all output except error messages.
38829
38830 A command such as
38831 .code
38832 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38833 .endd
38834 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38835 .display
38836 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38837 <&'some commands'&>
38838 &`End`&
38839 .endd
38840 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38841 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38842 such as
38843 .code
38844 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38845 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38846 .endd
38847 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38848 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38849 .ecindex IIDutils
38850
38851
38852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38853 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38854
38855 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38856 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38857 .cindex "X-windows"
38858 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38859 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38860 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38861 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38862 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38863 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38864 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38865 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38866
38867
38868
38869 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38870 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38871 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38872 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38873 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38874 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38875 parameters are for.
38876
38877 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38878 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38879 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38880 .code
38881 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38882 .endd
38883 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38884 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38885 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38886 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38887 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38888
38889 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38890 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38891 .code
38892 Eximon*background: gray94
38893 .endd
38894 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38895 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38896 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38897 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38898 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38899 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38900 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38901 .code
38902 xrdb -merge <<End
38903 Eximon*highlight: gray
38904 End
38905 .endd
38906 .cindex "admin user"
38907 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38908 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38909
38910 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38911 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38912 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38913 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38914 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38915
38916 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38917 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38918 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38919 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38920 different parts of the display.
38921
38922
38923
38924
38925 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38926 .cindex "stripchart"
38927 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38928 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38929 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38930 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38931 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38932 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38933 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38934 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38935 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38936
38937 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38938 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38939 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38940 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38941
38942 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38943 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38944 to a single partition.
38945
38946 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38947 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38948 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38949 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38950 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38951 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38952 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38953
38954
38955
38956
38957 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38958 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38959 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38960 .cindex "window size"
38961 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38962 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38963 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38964 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38965 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38966 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38967
38968 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38969 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38970 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38971 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38972
38973 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38974 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38975 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38976 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38977 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38978 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38979
38980 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38981 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38982 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38983
38984
38985
38986 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38987 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38988 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38989 the main log is maintained.
38990 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38991 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38992 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38993 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38994 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38995
38996 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38997 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38998 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38999 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39000 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39001 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39002 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39003 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39004 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39005 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39006 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39007
39008 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39009 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39010 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39011 It cannot go further back up the log.
39012
39013 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
39014 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
39015 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
39016 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
39017 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
39018 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
39019
39020 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
39021 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
39022 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
39023 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
39024 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
39025 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
39026
39027 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
39028 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
39029 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
39030 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
39031 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
39032 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
39033 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
39034 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
39035 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
39036 window.
39037
39038
39039
39040 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
39041 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
39042 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
39043 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
39044 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
39045 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
39046 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
39047 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
39048 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
39049 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
39050
39051 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
39052 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
39053 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
39054 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
39055 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
39056 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
39057 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
39058
39059 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
39060 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
39061 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
39062 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
39063 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
39064 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
39065 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
39066
39067 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
39068 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
39069 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
39070 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
39071
39072 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
39073 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
39074 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
39075 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
39076 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
39077 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
39078 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
39079 not shown.
39080
39081 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
39082 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
39083
39084 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
39085 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
39086 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
39087 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
39088 display is updated.
39089
39090
39091
39092 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
39093 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
39094 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
39095 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
39096 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
39097 any selected text.
39098
39099 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
39100 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
39101 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
39102 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
39103 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
39104 .code
39105 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
39106 .endd
39107 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
39108 follows:
39109
39110 .ilist
39111 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
39112 in a new text window.
39113 .next
39114 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
39115 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
39116 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
39117 .next
39118 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
39119 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
39120 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
39121 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
39122 .next
39123 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
39124 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
39125 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39126 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39127 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39128 .next
39129 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39130 that the message be frozen.
39131 .next
39132 .cindex "thawing messages"
39133 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
39134 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39135 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39136 that the message be thawed.
39137 .next
39138 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39139 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39140 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39141 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39142 .next
39143 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39144 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39145 message.
39146 .next
39147 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39148 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39149 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39150 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39151 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39152 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39153 which case no action is taken.
39154 .next
39155 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39156 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39157 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39158 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39159 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39160 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39161 case no action is taken.
39162 .next
39163 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39164 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39165 .next
39166 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39167 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39168 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39169 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39170 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39171 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39172 the address is qualified with that domain.
39173 .endlist
39174
39175 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39176 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39177 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39178 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39179 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39180 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39181 if no output is generated.
39182
39183 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39184 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39185 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39186 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39187
39188 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39189 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39190 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39191 .ecindex IIDeximon
39192
39193
39194
39195
39196
39197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39199
39200 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39201 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39202 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39203 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39204
39205 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39206 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39207 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39208 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39209 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39210 its security as compared with other MTAs.
39211
39212 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39213 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39214 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39215 as soon as possible.
39216
39217
39218 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39219 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
39220 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39221 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39222 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39223 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39224
39225 .ilist
39226 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39227 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39228 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39229 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39230 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39231 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39232
39233 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39234 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39235 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39236 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39237 .next
39238
39239 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39240 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39241 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39242 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39243 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39244 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39245 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39246 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39247 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39248 separate commands.
39249
39250 .next
39251 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39252 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39253 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39254 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39255 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39256 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39257 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39258 .next
39259 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39260 is disabled.
39261 .next
39262 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39263 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39264 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39265 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39266 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39267 .endlist
39268
39269
39270
39271 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39272 .cindex "setuid"
39273 .cindex "root privilege"
39274 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39275 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39276 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39277 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39278 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39279 is required for two things:
39280
39281 .ilist
39282 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39283 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39284 not required.
39285 .next
39286 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39287 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39288 configuration.
39289 .endlist
39290
39291 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39292 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39293 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39294 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39295 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39296 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39297 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39298 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39299
39300 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39301 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39302 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39303
39304 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39305 uid and gid in the following cases:
39306
39307 .ilist
39308 .oindex "&%-C%&"
39309 .oindex "&%-D%&"
39310 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39311 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39312 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39313 the calling process.
39314 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39315 option may not be used at all.
39316 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39317 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39318 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39319 .next
39320 .oindex "&%-be%&"
39321 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
39322 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
39323 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39324 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39325 calling process.
39326 .next
39327 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39328 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39329 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39330 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39331 testing address verification
39332 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
39333 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
39334 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39335 option).
39336 .next
39337 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39338 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39339 .endlist
39340
39341 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39342
39343 .ilist
39344 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39345 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39346 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39347 will be used during message reception.
39348 .next
39349 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39350 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39351 .next
39352 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39353 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39354 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39355 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39356 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39357 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39358 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39359 generating bounce and warning messages.
39360
39361 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39362 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39363 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39364 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39365 .next
39366 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39367 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39368 .endlist
39369
39370
39371
39372
39373 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39374 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39375 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39376 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39377 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39378 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39379 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39380 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39381 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39382 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39383 to any other uid.
39384
39385 .cindex SIGHUP
39386 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39387 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39388 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39389 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39390
39391 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39392 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39393 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39394 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39395 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39396
39397 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39398 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39399 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39400 effect.
39401
39402 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39403 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39404 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39405
39406 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39407 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39408 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39409 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39410 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39411 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39412 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39413 address this problem at this time.
39414
39415 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39416 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39417 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39418 be used in the most straightforward way.
39419
39420 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39421 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39422
39423 .ilist
39424 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39425 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39426 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39427 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39428 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39429 .next
39430 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39431 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39432 .next
39433 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39434 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39435 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39436 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39437 .next
39438 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39439 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39440
39441 .olist
39442 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39443 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39444 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39445 .next
39446 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39447 owned by the Exim user.
39448 .next
39449 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39450 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39451 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39452 .endlist olist
39453 .endlist ilist
39454
39455
39456 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39457 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39458 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39459 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39460
39461 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39462 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39463
39464
39465
39466
39467 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39468 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39469 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39470
39471
39472
39473 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39474 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39475 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39476 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39477 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39478 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39479 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39480
39481 .ilist
39482 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39483 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39484 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39485 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39486 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39487 .next
39488 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39489 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39490 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39491 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39492 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39493 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39494 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39495 .next
39496 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39497 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39498 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39499 .next
39500 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39501 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39502 .next
39503 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39504 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39505 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39506 .next
39507 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39508 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39509 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39510 of opaque strings.
39511 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39512 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39513 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39514 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39515 .endlist
39516
39517
39518
39519
39520 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39521 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39522 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39523 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39524 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39525 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39526 are some issues to be aware of:
39527
39528 .ilist
39529 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39530 .next
39531 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39532 .next
39533 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39534 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39535 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39536 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39537 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39538 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39539 data.
39540 .next
39541 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39542 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39543 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39544 .next
39545 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39546 expected to yield one result.
39547 .endlist
39548
39549
39550
39551
39552 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39553 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39554 .cindex "IP source routing"
39555 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39556 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39557 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39558 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39559
39560
39561
39562 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39563 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39564 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39565
39566
39567
39568
39569 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39570 .cindex "trusted users"
39571 .cindex "admin user"
39572 .cindex "privileged user"
39573 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39574 .cindex "user" "admin"
39575 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39576 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39577 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39578 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39579 permit a remote host to be specified.
39580
39581 .oindex "&%-f%&"
39582 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39583 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39584 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39585 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39586 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39587 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39588
39589 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39590 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39591 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39592 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39593 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39594
39595 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39596 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39597 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39598 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39599 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39600
39601 .oindex "&%-M%&"
39602 .oindex "&%-q%&"
39603 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39604 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39605 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39606 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39607 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39608 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39609
39610 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39611 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39612 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39613 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39614 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39615 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39616 files.
39617
39618 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39619 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39620 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39621 This affects most of the checking options,
39622 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39623
39624
39625 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39626 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39627 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39628 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39629 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39630 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39631
39632
39633
39634 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39635 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39636 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39637 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39638 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39639 this.
39640
39641
39642
39643 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39644 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39645 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39646 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39647 converted output.
39648
39649
39650
39651 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39652 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39653 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39654 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39655 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39656
39657
39658
39659 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39660 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39661 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39662 loading it.
39663
39664
39665 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39666 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39667 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39668 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39669 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39670 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39671 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39672
39673 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39674 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39675 string.
39676
39677
39678
39679 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39680 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39681 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39682 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39683
39684
39685
39686 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39687 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39688 enough to hold the result.
39689 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39690
39691
39692
39693
39694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39695 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39696
39697 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39698 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39699 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39700 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39701 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39702 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39703 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39704 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39705 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39706 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39707 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39708 themselves are recoverable.
39709
39710 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39711 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39712 and should not be used as such.
39713
39714 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39715 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39716 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39717
39718 .ilist
39719 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39720 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39721 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39722 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39723 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39724 .next
39725 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39726 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39727 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39728 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39729 .next
39730 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39731 .next
39732 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39733 signature.
39734 .endlist
39735 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39736
39737 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39738 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39739 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39740 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39741 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39742 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39743 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39744 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39745 attempt.
39746
39747 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39748 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39749 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39750 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39751
39752 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39753 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39754 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39755 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39756 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39757 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39758 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39759 normally the Exim user.
39760
39761 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39762 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39763 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39764 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39765 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39766 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39767 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39768 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39769
39770 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39771 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39772 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39773 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39774
39775 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39776 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39777
39778 .vlist
39779 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39780 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39781 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39782 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39783 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39784 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39785 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39786 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39787 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39788 newlines.
39789
39790 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39791 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39792 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39793 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39794 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39795 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39796
39797 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39798 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39799 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39800 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39801 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39802 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39803
39804 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39805 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39806 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39807
39808 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39809 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39810 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39811 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39812 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39813
39814 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39815 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39816 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39817 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39818 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39819
39820 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39821 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39822 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39823
39824 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39825 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39826 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39827
39828 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39829 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39830 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39831
39832 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39833 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39834 present if the number is greater than zero.
39835
39836 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39837 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39838 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39839
39840 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39841 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39842 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39843
39844 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39845 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39846 command.
39847
39848 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39849 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39850 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39851 messages.
39852
39853 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39854 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39855 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39856 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39857
39858 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39859 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39860 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39861
39862 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39863 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39864 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39865 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39866 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39867 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39868
39869 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39870 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39871 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39872 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39873 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39874
39875 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39876 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39877 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39878 generated messages.
39879
39880 .vitem &%-local%&
39881 The message is from a local sender.
39882
39883 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39884 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39885
39886 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39887 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39888 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39889 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39890
39891 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39892 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39893 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39894
39895 .vitem &%-N%&
39896 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39897 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39898 &%-N%& is assumed.
39899
39900 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39901 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39902 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39903
39904 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39905 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39906 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39907
39908 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39909 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39910 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39911
39912 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39913 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39914 rather than Unix-format.
39915 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39916 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39917
39918 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39919 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39920 certificate was verified by the server.
39921
39922 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39923 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39924 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39925
39926 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39927 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39928 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39929 certificate.
39930 .endlist
39931
39932 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39933 corresponding data is untrusted.
39934
39935 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39936 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39937 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39938 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39939 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39940 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39941 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39942 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39943 addresses are complete.
39944
39945 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39946 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39947 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39948 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39949 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39950 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39951 .code
39952 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39953 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39954 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39955 .endd
39956 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39957 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39958 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39959 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39960 example:
39961 .code
39962 4
39963 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39964 darcy@austen.fict.example
39965 rdo@foundation
39966 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39967 .endd
39968 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39969 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39970 line is of the following form:
39971 .display
39972 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39973 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39974 .endd
39975 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39976 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39977 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39978 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39979 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39980 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39981 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39982 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39983
39984
39985 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39986 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39987 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39988 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39989 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39990 following:
39991
39992 .table2 50pt
39993 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39994 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39995 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39996 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39997 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39998 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39999 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40000 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40001 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40002 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40003 .endtable
40004
40005 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40006 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40007 typical set of headers:
40008 .code
40009 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40010 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40011 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40012 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40013 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
40014 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
40015 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
40016 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40017 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
40018 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40019 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40020 .endd
40021 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
40022 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
40023 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
40024 .ecindex IIDforspo1
40025 .ecindex IIDforspo2
40026 .ecindex IIDforspo3
40027
40028 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
40029 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
40030 an ASCII newline character.
40031 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
40032 can have an alternate format.
40033 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
40034 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
40035 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
40036 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
40037 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
40038 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
40039
40040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40041 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40042
40043 .chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
40044 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
40045
40046 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
40047 .cindex "DKIM"
40048
40049 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
40050 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
40051 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
40052 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
40053
40054 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
40055 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
40056 any original DKIM signature.
40057
40058 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
40059 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40060
40061 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
40062 .olist
40063 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
40064 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
40065 (including transport filters)
40066 except cutthrough delivery.
40067 .next
40068 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
40069 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
40070 different signature contexts.
40071 .endlist
40072
40073 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
40074 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
40075 Exim's standard controls.
40076
40077 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
40078 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
40079
40080 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
40081 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
40082 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
40083 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
40084 .code
40085 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
40086 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
40087 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
40088 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
40089 .endd
40090
40091 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
40092 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
40093 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
40094 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
40095 senders).
40096
40097
40098 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
40099 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
40100
40101 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
40102 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
40103 .code
40104 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40105
40106 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40107 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40108 .endd
40109
40110 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
40111 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
40112 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
40113 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
40114 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
40115
40116 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
40117 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
40118
40119 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
40120 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
40121 After expansion, this can be a list.
40122 Each element in turn,
40123 lowercased,
40124 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
40125 while expanding the remaining signing options.
40126 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40127 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40128
40129 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40130 This sets the key selector string.
40131 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40132 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40133 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40134 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40135 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40136 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40137
40138 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40139 This sets the private key to use.
40140 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40141 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40142 The result can either
40143 .ilist
40144 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40145 .next
40146 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40147 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40148 .next
40149 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40150 the private key
40151 .next
40152 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40153 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40154 is set.
40155 .endlist
40156
40157 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40158 .code
40159 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40160 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40161 .endd
40162 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40163 for the DNS TXT record.
40164 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40165
40166 Under GnuTLS:
40167 .code
40168 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40169 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40170 .endd
40171
40172 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40173 .code
40174 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40175 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40176 .endd
40177
40178 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40179 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40180 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40181 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40182 for some transition period.
40183 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40184 for EC keys.
40185
40186 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40187 .code
40188 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40189 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40190 .endd
40191
40192 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40193 .code
40194 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40195 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40196 .endd
40197
40198 Exim also supports an alternate format
40199 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40200 of the standard, but not adopted.
40201 A future release will probably drop that support.
40202
40203 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40204 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40205 .ilist
40206 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40207 .next
40208 &`sha256`& &-- the default
40209 .next
40210 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40211 .endlist
40212
40213 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40214 .code
40215 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40216 .endd
40217
40218 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40219 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40220 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40221 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40222 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40223 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40224
40225 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40226 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40227 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40228 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40229 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40230
40231 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40232 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40233 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40234 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40235 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40236 variables here.
40237
40238 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40239 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40240 list of header names.
40241 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40242 in the message signature.
40243 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40244 whether or not each header is present in the message.
40245 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40246 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40247
40248 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40249 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40250 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40251
40252 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40253 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40254 will be signed.
40255 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40256 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40257 name will be appended.
40258
40259 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40260 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40261 If not set, no such information will be included.
40262 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40263 for the expiry tag
40264 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40265 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40266
40267 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40268
40269
40270 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40271 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40272
40273 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40274 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40275 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40276 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40277 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40278 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40279 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40280
40281 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40282 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40283 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40284
40285 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40286 of this section can be ignored.
40287
40288 The results of verification are made available to the
40289 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40290 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40291 By default, the ACL is called once for each
40292 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40293 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40294 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40295 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40296
40297 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40298 a large number of expansion variables
40299 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40300 runtime of the ACL.
40301
40302 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40303 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40304 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40305 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40306
40307 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40308 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40309 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40310 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40311 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40312 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40313 it defaults as:
40314 .code
40315 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40316 .endd
40317 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40318 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40319 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40320 .code
40321 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40322 .endd
40323 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40324 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40325 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40326 .code
40327 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40328 .endd
40329
40330 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40331 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40332
40333 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40334 (such as the From: header)
40335 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40336 and for the domain part if identities.
40337 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40338
40339 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40340 for each matching signature.
40341
40342
40343 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40344 available (from most to least important):
40345
40346
40347 .vlist
40348 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40349 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40350 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40351 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40352
40353 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40354 Within the DKIM ACL,
40355 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40356 .ilist
40357 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40358 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40359 .next
40360 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40361 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40362 .next
40363 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40364 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40365 .next
40366 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40367 .endlist
40368
40369 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40370 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40371 hash-method or key-size:
40372 .code
40373 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40374 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40375 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40376 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40377 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40378 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40379 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40380 .endd
40381
40382 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40383 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40384 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40385 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40386
40387 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40388 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40389 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40390 .ilist
40391 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40392 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40393 .next
40394 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40395 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40396 .next
40397 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40398 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40399 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40400 .next
40401 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40402 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40403 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40404 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40405 .endlist
40406
40407 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40408
40409 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40410 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40411 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40412 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40413
40414 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40415 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40416 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40417 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40418
40419 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40420 The key record selector string.
40421
40422 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40423 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40424 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40425 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40426 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40427 for EC keys.
40428
40429 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40430 .code
40431 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40432
40433 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40434 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40435 .endd
40436
40437 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40438 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40439 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40440 processing of such signatures.
40441
40442 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40443 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40444
40445 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40446 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40447
40448 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40449 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40450 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40451 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40452 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40453 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40454
40455 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40456 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40457 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40458 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40459 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40460 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40461 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40462 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40463
40464 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40465 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40466 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40467
40468 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40469 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40470 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40471 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40472 integer size comparisons against this value.
40473 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40474
40475 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40476 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40477
40478 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40479 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40480
40481 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40482 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40483
40484 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40485 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40486 in the key record.
40487
40488 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40489 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40490 in the key record.
40491
40492 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40493 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40494
40495 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40496 Number of bits in the key.
40497
40498 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40499 .code
40500 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40501 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40502 .endd
40503
40504 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40505 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40506 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40507
40508 .endlist
40509
40510 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40511
40512 .vlist
40513 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40514 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40515 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40516 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40517 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40518
40519 .code
40520 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40521 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40522 sender_domains = gmail.com
40523 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40524 dkim_status = none
40525 .endd
40526
40527 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40528 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40529
40530 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40531 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40532 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40533 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40534
40535 .code
40536 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40537 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40538 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40539 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40540 .endd
40541
40542 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40543 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40544 for more information of what they mean.
40545 .endlist
40546
40547
40548
40549
40550 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40551 .cindex SPF verification
40552
40553 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40554 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40555 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40556 the &url(http://openspf.org).
40557 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40558 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40559 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40560 . --- discussion.
40561
40562 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40563 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40564
40565 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40566 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40567 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40568 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40569 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40570
40571 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40572 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40573 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40574 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40575
40576
40577 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40578 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40579 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40580 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40581 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40582 Valid strings are:
40583 .vlist
40584 .vitem &%pass%&
40585 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40586
40587 .vitem &%fail%&
40588 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40589 domain in the envelope-from address.
40590
40591 .vitem &%softfail%&
40592 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40593 is a forgery.
40594
40595 .vitem &%none%&
40596 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40597
40598 .vitem &%neutral%&
40599 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40600 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40601 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40602
40603 .vitem &%permerror%&
40604 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40605 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40606
40607 .vitem &%temperror%&
40608 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40609 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40610 .endlist
40611
40612 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40613 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40614 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40615 short-circuit fashion.
40616
40617 Example:
40618 .code
40619 deny spf = fail
40620 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40621 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40622 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40623 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40624 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40625 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40626 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40627 ip=$sender_host_address
40628 .endd
40629
40630 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40631 variables:
40632
40633 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40634 .vlist
40635 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40636 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40637 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40638 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40639 it for logging purposes.
40640
40641 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40642 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40643 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40644 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40645 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40646 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40647
40648 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40649 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40650
40651 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40652 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40653 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40654 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40655 temperror.
40656
40657 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40658 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40659 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40660 and required in order to obtain a result.
40661
40662 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40663 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40664 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40665 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40666 .endlist
40667
40668
40669 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40670 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40671 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40672 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40673 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40674 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40675 capability.
40676 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40677 for a description of what it means.
40678 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40679
40680 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40681 of the spf one. For example:
40682
40683 .code
40684 deny spf_guess = fail
40685 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40686 .endd
40687
40688 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40689 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40690 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40691 reject message.
40692
40693 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40694 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40695
40696 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40697 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40698 &%spf_guess%& option.
40699 For example, the following:
40700
40701 .code
40702 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40703 .endd
40704
40705 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40706
40707
40708 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40709 .cindex lookup spf
40710 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40711 address as the key and an IP address
40712 (v4 or v6)
40713 as the database:
40714
40715 .code
40716 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40717 .endd
40718
40719 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40720 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40721
40722
40723
40724
40725
40726 .section DMARC SECDMARC
40727 .cindex DMARC verification
40728
40729 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40730 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40731 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40732 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40733 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40734
40735 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40736 the libopendmarc library is used.
40737
40738 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40739 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40740 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40741 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40742 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40743 This description assumes
40744 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40745 are in /usr/local/lib.
40746
40747 . subsection
40748
40749 There are three main-configuration options:
40750 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40751
40752 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40753 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40754 defines the location of a text file of valid
40755 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40756 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40757 the most current version can be downloaded
40758 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
40759 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40760 .new
40761 The default for the option is unset.
40762 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
40763 .wen
40764
40765
40766 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40767 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40768 defines the location of a file to log results
40769 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40770 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40771 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40772 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40773 directory of this file is writable by the user
40774 exim runs as.
40775 The default is unset.
40776
40777 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40778 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40779 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40780 forensic report detailing alignment failures
40781 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40782 and you have configured Exim to send them.
40783 If set, this is expanded and used for the
40784 From: header line; the address is extracted
40785 from it and used for the envelope from.
40786 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40787 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40788 envelope from.
40789
40790 . I wish we had subsections...
40791
40792 .cindex DMARC controls
40793 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40794 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40795 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40796 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40797 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40798 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
40799 .code
40800 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40801 .endd
40802 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40803 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40804 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40805 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40806 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40807 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40808 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40809 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
40810 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
40811 construction might be inadequate.
40812 .code
40813 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40814 .endd
40815 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40816 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40817 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
40818 send them.)
40819
40820 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40821 the DATA acl.
40822
40823 . subsection
40824
40825 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40826 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40827 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
40828 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40829 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40830 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40831 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40832
40833 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
40834 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40835 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40836 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40837 .display
40838 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40839 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40840 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40841 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40842 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40843 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40844 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40845 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40846 .endd
40847 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40848 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40849 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40850 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40851 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40852 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40853 fails.
40854
40855 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40856 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40857 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40858
40859 Performing the check sets up information used by the
40860 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40861
40862 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40863 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40864 expansion variables are available:
40865
40866 .vlist
40867 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
40868 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40869 .cindex DMARC result
40870 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40871 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40872 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40873 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40874 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40875
40876 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
40877 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40878 Slightly longer, human readable status.
40879
40880 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40881 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40882 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40883
40884 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40885 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40886 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40887 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40888 is any error, including no DMARC record.
40889 .endlist
40890
40891 . subsection
40892
40893 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40894 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40895 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40896 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40897 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40898 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40899 processing or failure delivery issues).
40900
40901 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40902 tools, you need to:
40903 .ilist
40904 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
40905 .next
40906 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40907 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40908 .endlist
40909
40910 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40911 .ilist
40912 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40913 .next
40914 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40915 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40916 .endlist
40917
40918 . subsection
40919
40920 Example usage:
40921 .code
40922 (RCPT ACL)
40923 warn domains = +local_domains
40924 hosts = +local_hosts
40925 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40926
40927 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40928 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40929
40930 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40931 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40932
40933 (DATA ACL)
40934 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40935 !authenticated = *
40936 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40937
40938 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40939 !authenticated = *
40940 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40941
40942 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40943 !authenticated = *
40944 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40945 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40946
40947 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40948 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40949 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40950
40951 deny dmarc_status = reject
40952 !authenticated = *
40953 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40954
40955 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40956 .endd
40957
40958
40959
40960
40961
40962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40964
40965 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40966 "Proxy support"
40967 .cindex "proxy support"
40968 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40969
40970 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40971 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40972
40973
40974 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40975 .cindex proxy inbound
40976 .cindex proxy "server side"
40977 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40978 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40979
40980 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40981 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40982 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40983 in Local/Makefile.
40984
40985 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40986 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40987
40988 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40989 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40990 to distribute load.
40991 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40992 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40993 There is no logging if a host passes or
40994 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40995 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40996
40997 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40998 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40999 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
41000 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
41001 automatically determines which version is in use.
41002
41003 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
41004 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
41005 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
41006 Exim and the proxy server.
41007
41008 The following expansion variables are usable
41009 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
41010 of the proxy):
41011 .display
41012 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
41013 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
41014 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
41015 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
41016 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
41017 .endd
41018 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
41019 there was a protocol error.
41020 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
41021 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
41022
41023 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
41024 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
41025 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
41026 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
41027 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
41028 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
41029 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
41030 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
41031 A possible solution is:
41032 .display
41033 # Set max number of connections per host
41034 LIMIT = 5
41035 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
41036 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
41037
41038 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
41039 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
41040 .endd
41041
41042
41043
41044 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
41045 .cindex proxy outbound
41046 .cindex proxy "client side"
41047 .cindex proxy SOCKS
41048 .cindex SOCKS proxy
41049 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
41050 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
41051 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
41052 Local/Makefile.
41053
41054 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
41055 on an smtp transport.
41056 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
41057 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
41058 Each proxy specifier is a list
41059 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
41060 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
41061
41062 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
41063 The list of options is in the following table:
41064 .display
41065 &'auth '& authentication method
41066 &'name '& authentication username
41067 &'pass '& authentication password
41068 &'port '& tcp port
41069 &'tmo '& connection timeout
41070 &'pri '& priority
41071 &'weight '& selection bias
41072 .endd
41073
41074 More details on each of these options follows:
41075
41076 .ilist
41077 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
41078 .cindex proxy authentication
41079 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
41080 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
41081 for access to the proxy.
41082 Default is &"none"&.
41083 .next
41084 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
41085 Default is empty.
41086 .next
41087 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
41088 Default is empty.
41089 .next
41090 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
41091 Default is 1080.
41092 .next
41093 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
41094 Default is 5.
41095 .next
41096 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
41097 higher values being tried first.
41098 The default priority is 1.
41099 .next
41100 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
41101 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
41102 weighted by this value.
41103 The default value for selection bias is 1.
41104 .endlist
41105
41106 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
41107 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
41108 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
41109
41110 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
41111 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
41112 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
41113 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
41114
41115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41117
41118 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
41119 "Internationalisation""
41120 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
41121 .cindex EAI
41122 .cindex i18n
41123 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
41124
41125 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41126 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41127 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41128
41129 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41130 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41131 requirement, upon libidn2.
41132
41133 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41134 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41135 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41136 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41137 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41138 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41139
41140 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41141 international handling for the message is enabled and
41142 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41143
41144 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41145 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41146 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41147 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41148
41149 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41150 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41151 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41152 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41153
41154 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41155 components expanded to a-label form,
41156 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41157 form of the name.
41158
41159 .cindex log protocol
41160 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41161 .cindex i18n logging
41162 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41163 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41164
41165 The following expansion operators can be used:
41166 .code
41167 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41168 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41169 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41170 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41171 .endd
41172
41173 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41174 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41175 The RCPT ACL
41176 may use the following modifier:
41177 .display
41178 control = utf8_downconvert
41179 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41180 .endd
41181 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41182 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41183 Message Submission Agent context.
41184 If a value is appended it may be:
41185 .display
41186 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41187 &`0 `& no downconversion
41188 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41189 .endd
41190
41191 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41192 is initially set to -1.
41193
41194 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41195 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41196 and it overrides any previously set value.
41197
41198
41199 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41200 Configurations supporting these should inspect
41201 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41202
41203 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41204 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41205 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41206
41207 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41208 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41209
41210
41211
41212 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41213 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41214 the following expansion operator can be used:
41215 .code
41216 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41217 .endd
41218
41219 The string is converted from the charset specified by
41220 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41221 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41222 to the
41223 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41224 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41225 (which has to be a single character)
41226 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41227 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41228
41229 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41230 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41231
41232 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41233 by many other IMAP servers.
41234
41235 Examples:
41236 .display
41237 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41238 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41239 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41240 .endd
41241
41242 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41243 must be representable in UTF-16.
41244
41245
41246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41247 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41248
41249 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41250 "Events"
41251 .cindex events
41252
41253 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41254 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41255 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41256 processing actions.
41257
41258 Most installations will never need to use Events.
41259 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41260 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41261
41262 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41263 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41264 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41265
41266 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41267 An example might look like:
41268 .cindex logging custom
41269 .code
41270 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41271 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41272 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41273 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41274 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41275 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41276 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41277 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41278 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41279 } {}}
41280 .endd
41281
41282 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41283 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41284 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41285
41286 .new
41287 The current list of events is:
41288 .wen
41289 .display
41290 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41291 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
41292 &`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41293 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41294 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41295 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41296 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41297 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41298 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41299 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41300 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41301 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41302 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41303 &`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41304 .endd
41305 New event types may be added in future.
41306
41307 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41308 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41309 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41310
41311 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41312 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41313 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41314
41315 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41316 should define the event action.
41317
41318 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41319 with the event type:
41320 .display
41321 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
41322 &`msg:defer `& error string
41323 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41324 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41325 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41326 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
41327 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41328 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41329 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41330 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41331 &`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41332 .endd
41333
41334 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41335
41336 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41337 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41338 the course of its processing:
41339 .ilist
41340 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41341 transport call
41342 .next
41343 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41344 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41345 .endlist
41346 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41347 a useful way of writing to the main log.
41348
41349 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41350 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41351 following will be forced:
41352 .display
41353 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41354 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41355 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
41356 .endd
41357 All other message types ignore the result string, and
41358 no other use is made of it.
41359
41360 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41361 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41362 the target system.
41363
41364 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41365 chain element received on the connection.
41366 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41367 loaded locally.
41368
41369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41371
41372 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41373 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41374 .cindex "adding drivers"
41375 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
41376 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41377 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41378 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41379
41380 .olist
41381 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41382 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41383 .next
41384 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41385 .display
41386 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41387 .endd
41388 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41389 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41390 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41391 .next
41392 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41393 .code
41394 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41395 .endd
41396 .next
41397 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41398 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41399 .next
41400 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41401 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41402 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41403 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41404 simple form that most lookups have.
41405 .next
41406 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41407 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41408 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41409 .next
41410 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41411 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41412 .next
41413 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41414 &_src_&.
41415 .next
41416 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41417 as for other drivers and lookups.
41418 .endlist
41419
41420 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41421 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41422 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41423 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41424 searched using a binary chop procedure.
41425
41426 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41427 the interface that is expected.
41428
41429
41430
41431
41432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41434
41435 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41436 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41437 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41438 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41439 . processors.
41440 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41441
41442 .literal xml
41443 <?sdop
41444 format="newpage"
41445 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41446 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41447 ?>
41448 .literal off
41449
41450 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
41451 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41452 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41453
41454
41455 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41456 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////